SP2552-2-15-1 UM (From Inspector 2023)
SP2552-2-15-1 UM (From Inspector 2023)
SP2552-2-15-1 UM (From Inspector 2023)
No. SP2552-2-15-1 UM
User Manual
Equipment: MacGregor Offshore Knuckle Jib Crane
Type: HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 / 100-20
This document and all information and data herein or herewith is the confidential and proprietary property of MacGregor Norway AS and is not to be used,
reproduced or disclosed in whole or in part by or to anyone without the written confirmation from MacGregor Norway AS.
© MacGregor Norway AS
www.MacGregor.com
Form-ID-Document-Frontpage-201011
User Manual for Crane
1 Introduction
Table of Contents
1. General ............................................................................................................................................1
2. Purchase Information .......................................................................................................................1
3. Contact Information ..........................................................................................................................1
4. General Security Conditions.............................................................................................................2
5. Training ............................................................................................................................................2
6. Guarantee Restrictions ....................................................................................................................2
7. HSE – Health, Safety and Environment ...........................................................................................3
7.1. Safety in Maintenance ...............................................................................................................3
7.2. Disconnection of Live Circuits ....................................................................................................3
7.3. Accidental Activation .................................................................................................................3
7.4. Electrical Supply Specification ...................................................................................................4
7.5. Replacement Parts ....................................................................................................................4
7.6. Software ....................................................................................................................................4
7.7. Observing the Installation Guidelines.........................................................................................4
7.8. Environment ..............................................................................................................................4
1 Introduction
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
1 Introduction
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
This user manual is compiled in accordance with Norwegian Standard 5820.
Operators and maintenance personnel should read and understand this manual before operating or servicing the
equipment. The owner of the equipment is responsible for ensuring that no unauthorised personnel operate or
maintain the equipment.
• SP2552-2-15-1
Note: Illustrations/photos used in the user manual may deviate from the actual delivery. Optional equipment
that may or may not be present is denoted with a star .
2. Purchase Information
Equipment: Offshore/Subsea Knuckle Jib Crane
Type: HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 / 100-20
Customer: Fujian Mawei Shipbuilding Ltd
Machine number: SP2552-2
3. Contact Information
In case of any problems, please contact (remember equipment machine number for service advice):
+47 91 68 60 00
24 hour service:
+47 91 68 97 51
1 Introduction
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 1
User Manual for Crane
http://www.macgregor-group.com/service
All use of the equipment must comply with the company security regulations.
5. Training
MacGregor Norway AS can provide tailor-made operation and maintenance courses for all MacGregor Norway
equipment.
For more information, contact our head-office in Kristiansand. We recommend all our customers to attend our
courses.
6. Guarantee Restrictions
During the warranty period, all necessary spare parts must be supplied by MacGregor Norway AS. Use of
spare parts from other suppliers violates and forfeits the warranty.
Unintended use and/or faulty/deficient maintenance of the equipment forfeits the warranty.
Removal and/or loss of equipment identification plates by customer also forfeits the warranty.
1 Introduction
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Secure the area of the maintenance operation to the degree and the extent necessary!
When replacing heavy parts and/or structural components, objects being lifted must be carefully secured to the
lifting appliances and safeguarded in order to avoid hazardous situations. Use only approved lifting equipment
of sufficient carrying capacity.
Only personnel authorised according to applicable regulations are to perform work on the electrical installation
or the equipment.
If specifications for inspection, maintenance or repair require the equipment to be voltage-free, this can be
achieved in the following ways:
• For circuits above 50 VAC / 30 VDC, switch off and lock out the main circuit breaker on the supply
side.
• For instrumentation circuits (below 50 VAC / 30 VDC), isolate the control cabinet from the main
supply.
• Open the fuses in the control cabinet, referring to the relevant (loop) drawings.
• Isolate the relevant wires / cores from the terminal block in the control cabinet.
• Follow the relevant procedures to troubleshoot or repair the equipment in question.
This may include locking our power supply, posting warning signs at relevant locations, inform other people or
organisations.
1 Introduction
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 3
User Manual for Crane
If in doubt – ASK!
7.6. Software
The software delivered with the system is programmed by MacGregor Norway AS, and is vital for safe and
dependable operation of the equipment.
Only qualified personnel from MacGregor Norway AS may alter or modify system software.
The software supplied with the system has unique reference numbers kept on file at MacGregor Norway AS. If
software modifications are detected in any system this will void any warranty responsibility with respect to the
safe and normal operation of the equipment. Consult MacGregor Norway AS prior to making any changes in the
software.
Use the attached Software Change Request formula whenever requiring a change in the application software.
7.8. Environment
Environmental considerations should be kept in mind when disposing of any part of the equipment delivered by
MacGregor Norway AS.
1 Introduction
4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2 Main Data
Table of Contents
1. General ............................................................................................................................................1
2. Regulation and Design Criteria ........................................................................................................1
3. Main Winch ......................................................................................................................................2
4. Electro .............................................................................................................................................2
5. Hydraulic ..........................................................................................................................................2
6. Miscellaneous ..................................................................................................................................3
7. Additional Deliveries.........................................................................................................................3
2 Main Data
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
2 Main Data
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
Project ID 2552-2
Customer Fujian Mawei Shipbuilding Ltd.
Crane type HMC 2201
Size LKO 120-18 / 100-20
Current vessel name CSS Accomodation Support Vessel
Yard build number MW610-2
Ship owner MAC Offshore
Contract delivery terms DAP Mawei Shipyard, Incoterms 2010
FAT site RCI Taichang
Commissioning site Mawei Shipyard
Dynamic factor and derating: Derating procedures are to be applied to lifts where the dynamic factor exceeds
the limit.
Subsea capacity: Net subsea lift capacity is reduced by the weight of the submerged wire and increased by the
buoyancy of the submerged load. Hydrodynamic loads are to be calculated and factored into the lift.
2 Main Data
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 1
User Manual for Crane
3. Main Winch
Main winch SWL (t) 12
Winch spooling device No
Wire diameter (mm) 28
Wire type Galvanized, non rotating
Wire MBL (kN) 782
Wire weight dry (kg/m) 3
Wire weight in seawater (kg/m) 3
Drum diameter, PCD layer 1 (mm) 651
Drum width (mm) 718
Drum barrel No lebus
Hook travel (m) 100
Drum capacity (m) 150
Wirelength included (m) 150
Lifting speed 1 (ton, m/min) 0-12 ton, 0-30m/min
Hook included Yes
Weight of hook (kg) 500
Automatic pay out function Yes
Manual pay out function Yes
AT top tension, case 1 (t) Fixed setting CT ship to ship
4. Electro
Main supply 3x440V/60Hz
Main electro motor 1 1x215kW(S6-40%) S-D
Emergency supply 3x440V/60Hz
Main motor enclosure IP 56
SPM nipples in electro motor Yes
Oil cooler motors 1x3,5kW(S1-100%) DOL
Circulation/Feeding motor 1x3,8kW(S1-100%) DOL
CJC motor 1x0,5kW(S1-100%) DOL
Emergency HPU motor 1x20kW(S1-100%) DOL
Camera at winches Yes
Slipring / drag chain type El.supply
Extra sliprings for customer signals 6
Cabin type 2500
Right/Left mounted Left
Extra communication Yes
Remote diagnostic Yes
5. Hydraulic
Main jib topping speed Approx 60 sec
Knuckle jib topping speed Approx 50 sec
Slew sector 360 degrees unlimited
Slew speed 0-1,0RPM
2 Main Data
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6. Miscellaneous
Crane lubrication system Manual
Winch lubrication system Manual
Surface treatment Jotun Spec (similar as International System 1
Top layer color RAL 9010 White
7. Additional Deliveries
Additional delivery 1 Cordless radio remote control (AO2.2)
Additional delivery 2 Remote start stop box (AO3.1)
Additional delivery 3 ABS Certification (AO14.2)
2 Main Data
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 3
User Manual for Crane
3 Technical Description
Table of Contents
1. General ............................................................................................................................................3
2. Main Components ............................................................................................................................3
2.1. Pedestal ....................................................................................................................................3
2.2. Crane King ................................................................................................................................3
2.3. Jib System .................................................................................................................................3
2.4. Jib Cylinders ..............................................................................................................................3
2.5. Slew Gear and Slew Bearing .....................................................................................................4
2.6. Automatic Lubrication ................................................................................................................4
3. Hydraulic System .............................................................................................................................5
3.1. Hydraulic Oil Tank .....................................................................................................................5
3.2. Hydraulic Filter System ..............................................................................................................5
3.3. Oil Cooler ..................................................................................................................................5
3.4. Main Control Valve Including Pilot Valves ..................................................................................6
4. Winch System ..................................................................................................................................7
4.1. Hydraulic Winch Unit .................................................................................................................7
4.2. Auto Tension System ................................................................................................................7
4.3. Manual Overload Protection System (MOPS) ............................................................................8
4.4. Automatic Overload Protection System (AOPS) ........................................................................9
5. Electrical System .............................................................................................................................1
5.1. Starter Cabinet – ES400 ............................................................................................................2
5.2. Operator Panel – OP105 ...........................................................................................................3
5.3. Electric Motor and Slip Rings .....................................................................................................4
6. Control System ................................................................................................................................5
6.1. Control Cabinet – CC100...........................................................................................................6
6.2. Radio Remote Console – RCC97.1 ...........................................................................................6
6.3. Load Derating ............................................................................................................................7
6.4. Operator Cabin ..........................................................................................................................7
7. Emergency Operation System .........................................................................................................7
8. Safety Features................................................................................................................................8
8.1. Crane Control System ...............................................................................................................8
8.2. Emergency Stop ........................................................................................................................8
8.3. Overload Protection ...................................................................................................................8
8.4. Luffing Cylinder Limits ...............................................................................................................8
8.4.1. End Stop .............................................................................................................................8
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
The crane is designed for offshore / subsea operation on open deck of offshore vessel and for efficient and
accurate handling of general cargo at max 20 metres working radius with single fall.
The hydraulic power unit (HPU), comprising the electromotor with an axial mounted hydraulic gear pump sits
outside, on the platform, at the rear of the crane king.
The crane is operated either from the platform or from a portable radio remote control unit. All selected
equipment is chosen and installed to ensure the lowest possible emission of sound and good access for service
and repair.
The crane is delivered top coat painted and fully tested, adjusted and ready for installation onboard vessel by
welding to substructure and connection of electric power supply.
2. Main Components
2.1. Pedestal
The crane pedestal (also called the foundation) acts as a structural base for the crane system and is designed for
welding to a suitable deck structure.
A door or access-hatch for inspection/service is provided in the pedestal structure. For cranes which require
electricity above the slew bearing, a slip-ring system is installed in the pedestal to transfer power to the relevant
connection boxes and cabinets in the moving king.
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3. Hydraulic System
The main motor/ pump assembly is vertically mounted outside the crane king. The electric motor and the pump
is connected through a bell house including flex coupling. The flexible coupling also compensates for axial,
radial and angular shaft misalignments.
The electric motor operates at a constant speed and is equipped with heating element and thermistor.
The hydraulic pump is of axial piston pump type with variable displacement designed for an open hydraulic
circuit. Since the pump operates at a constant speed the flow is proportional to the displacement. By adjusting
the angle of the swash plate it is possible to infinitely vary the flow. Maximum operating pressure for the pump
is 350 bar. The control device that is mounted on the pump is a combination of pressure control and flow
control. The flow control part of the controller is activated when the crane is operated in normal mode. Normal
mode means when the normal crane functions are used (jib up/down, slew cw / ccw, winch up/down). In this
mode the “target” for the pump is to keep the pressure drop across the main control valve constant. When this
pressure drop increases the pump flow will decrease and when the pressure drop decreases the pump flow will
increase.
The pressure controller limits the pump outlet pressure. That means when the outlet pressure exceeds the
pump’s pre-set pressure, the flow decreases.
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 5
User Manual for Crane
The inlet section houses two different pressure control valves. One is a direct operated pressure relief valve. The
upstream side of this valve is connected to the common oil supply line and the downstream side is connected to
the common return line. This limits the maximum pressure in the system if an unintentionally pressure build-up
should occur.
The smallest valve in the inlet section is a direct operated pressure-reducing valve. The upstream side of the
valve is connected to the common oil supply line. The valve reduces the pressure down to approx 30 bar
independent of the oil supply pressure. The reducing valve feeds oil to the pilot valves via the external port
“LP”.
Each working module contains the same type of main components. Pilot pressure relief valves are fitted for
limiting the pressure in the port that have maximum pressure, such as jib up, knuckle jib out etc. These valves
are preset to correct pressure level with ref. to SWL.
The main spool inside each working module directs the oil from the oil supply line to the actual working port
and from the actual working port to the return line. The position of the spool is controlled by hydraulic pressure
acting on the cross section area at the end of the spool. The opposite side of the spool is then connected to drain.
The spool is spring centred, which means that when the pressures on both sides of the spool are zero, the spool
is centred by means of two springs, one at each end of the spool. In this position the oil supply port is closed.
In each working module there is a pressure compensator fitted and this is mounted in the oil supply line
upstream the main spool. The purpose of this valve is to always keep a constant pressure drop across the main
spool. This means that the oil flow to an individual function is independent of the load pressure of this function
and that the oil flow to one function is independent of the load pressure of other functions. The result of these
features is good regulation ability of the standard crane functions.
Each working module is equipped with two pilot valves that are used to control the position of the main spools
in the main control valve. The pilot valve is a proportional electric operated pressure-reducing valve. All pilot
valves for the crane functions such as slew, main jib, knuckle jib and winch is via the control system, connected
to the joysticks located at the operator chair in the crane cabin. When one of the joysticks is taken out of neutral
position a pilot pressure is applied to one side of the spool and the other side is connected to drain by means of
the actual pilot valve.
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
4. Winch System
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 7
User Manual for Crane
• 2 Accumulators
• The MOPS/Emergency Pay Out Block
• Proportional Pressure Relief Valve
Since the emergency release system must work even if a power loss should occur, the hydraulic energy is taken
from two bladder accumulators mounted close to the MOPS /Emergency Pay Out Block. The nominal volume
of each accumulator is 50 liters and they are connected to the ACC1, ACC2 ports on the block.
The MOPS/Emergency Pay Out Block contains different valves which are connected by internal drillings in the
block. The main components included in the valve block are listed below:
The 3/2 way electrically operated pilot valve is a directional poppet valve. The “P” port is connected to the
bladder accumulators mentioned above and the “T” port is routed to the external drain port “CTD”. The “A”
port is connected to the pilot valve on the 2/2 way pilot operated directional valve and also the 4/2 hydraulic
operated pilot valve.
The 2/2 way hydraulic operated directional valve is a cartridge valve and it consists of a main stage including a
valve cone, a bushing and a valve cover. On top of the cover there is a hydraulic operated 3/2 way pilot spool
valve with NG6 mounting pattern. The 2/2 way directional valve is mounted in the same line as from the B ports
on the winch motor block to the B port on the on the main control valve inside the rotating crane king. The 2/2
way hydraulic operated directional valve is used to close the connection between the “Lowering” port on the
hydraulic motor and the working section in the main control valve when the Emergency release system is
activated. In this mode the valve prevents oil to flow to the reservoir via the spool in the main control valve
(The A- and B ports are connected to the T port when the spool is in neutral position). The 2/2 way valve is
normally open i.e. when there is no pilot pressure available the main cone is open.
When the MOPS button in the crane cabin is activated, the 3/2 way electric operated pilot valve is activated and
opens. The emergency release functions will now activate in the following manner:
Oil from the two bladder accumulators will flow through a pressure reducing valve (40 bars) to the 2/2 way
hydraulic operated directional valve and it will close as described above. The accumulators will also ensure
sufficient oil flow to disengage the brakes on the winch and avoid cavitation on the winch motor when the load
is lowered.
In addition to this the 4/2 hydraulic operated pilot valve, also of NG6 design, will pressurize the Pil2 port on the
motor valve block on the winch and “dump” the pressure setting of the pilot operated pressure relief valve
mounted between the “Winch Up” port on the motor and the load control valve in the motor valve block. The
pressure setting of the valve is then determined via the pilot port, MX. This line is routed to an electrical
proportional pressure relief valve which in the event of MOPS activation is commanded fully open. This means
that the pressure in the MX line is zero. If the load pressure is higher than the 40 bars given from the pressure
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 9
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
5. Electrical System
The structure of crane’s electrical system is shown below. It is also enclosed in this manual in chapter 8.
CRANE SYSTEM
Utility Consumers
Customer com.
Custom er com . signals
10 pc. -Air condition unit
Intercom / ROV etc. Coax
Coax (Option) -Cabin heater
Coax
-Flood light
Ethernet, CAT5
8 pc. -Auxilliary devices
Ethernet, CAT5 -VHF radio / UHF
Ethernet CAT5E (4pc) 5 pc. -Winch camera MW
For Rem . Diagnostics
Em.stop/24V supply -AOPS and MOPS
Em.stop &
Em.stop 4 pc.
24V supply
Profibus DP
-MRU1 A,B,IE PE
Remote IO Control
Crane Control System
+CC100
L2
Crane Utility Supply
3x230VAC+PE/60Hz - 30kW L1
PE -M10
Heat Circulation Pump Motor
Therm M 3x690VAC / 60Hz
DOL
3 ~ 3.8kW/4.9A (S1-100%)
Heat -M20
Oil Cooler Motor
Therm 3x690VAC/60Hz
3,5kW/3.6A (S1-100% duty)
DOL
-M11 Radio Remote Consol
CJC Filter
DOL M 3x690VAC / 60Hz
3 ~ 0.5kW (S1-100%) T ransmitter
I(n) = 0.7A
Radio Remote Consol
+RCC97.1
L3
Crane Main Supply II -M02
L2 Heat Main Pum p M otor II
3x690VAC + PE / 60 Hz Therm M 3x690VAC/60Hz
200 kW (S1-100%)
L1
S/D
S/D
3 ~ 184kW (S1-100%)
L3 -M01
Heat M ain Pump Motor I
Therm M 3x690VAC/60Hz
L2
Crane Main Supply I S/D
S/D
3 ~ 184kW (S1-100%)
3x690VAC + PE / 60 Hz L1 Control
200 kW (S1-100%)
PE
PE Starter Cabinet
+ES400
+JB450
/251.E6 -M31
Emergency Supply
DOL Emergency motor
3x690VAC + PE / 60 Hz M 3x690VAC/60Hz
20 kW (S1-100%) +ES404 Heat 3 ~ 20kW (S1-100%)
Emergency
Drive Panel
Em ergency supply controlsystem
230VAC 2kW 60Hz +CC200 +OP206
STARTER CABINET
-ES400
-P21
=CRANE KING
-S01
-H14 =CRANE KING -S02
=CRANE KING
=CRANE KING
-HS117
3 Technical Description
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
+OP105 +OP105
Control Panel Control Panel
Front Sideways
MAP MAP
LAMP LAMP
MIC PA MIC PA
UHF UHF
VHF/UHF Selector
UHF Toggle Switch VHF
Radio/CD/MP3 Radio/CD/MP3
Spare
-PB2 -HS100
-UA102
LOW OFF HI ROOF WIPER
WASHER
PUMP 1 FRONT WIPER OFF ON
Spare
-PB3 -HS112 -HS114
LOW OFF HI LOW OFF HI
WASHER
PUMP 2 LEFT WIPER RIGHT WIPER
Spare
-PB4 -HS111 -HS113
-HS104
TEMPERATURE SWITCH
=CRANE CABIN
Emergency Release
Main Winch
SOCKET DOUBLE
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 3
User Manual for Crane
Below left: Typical layout of slip rings sitting inside at the upper part
of the crane pedestal.
Below right: Typical layout of the electromotor and the hydraulic
pump barely visible under the deck grid, connected to the electromotor
shaft.
3 Technical Description
4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6. Control System
The control system is based on an industrial-grade PLC that
communicates with other system components on the winch,
in the HPU, king and other parts of the crane. Crane motions
are controlled by means of joysticks mounted on consoles
on the operator’s seat in the cabin. Joystick movements send
signals to the PLC, which processes them and sends the
appropriate control signals to system components. Safety
functions such as MOPS and emergency stops are hardwired
into the electrical circuitry with dual/parallel contacts.
Full system information is available in real time, and all relevant parameters are logged to provide history for
documentation of normal operation and abnormal events. Redundancy is built into many points in the system
through the use of dual sensors.
The control system receives a important information from the following heavy-duty marine-grade field sensors:
The crane is equipped with audible and visual alarms according to DnV class requirements. It also has a camera
(RC101) for main winch monitoring.
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 5
User Manual for Crane
Remote access: A dedicated router in CC-100 is programmed with predefined IP addresses for remote access to
the control system. A standard router has 16 preset addresses – 10 for use by system components, 3 for DHCP
provision for mobile computers and similar devices and 3 for the router itself. The customer’s network must
have Internet access to IP-address 80.239.94.33 (MacGregor Norway AS). To be able to connect, the customer’s
firewall must have the following ports available:
• UDP 500
• UDP 4500
• ESP
• AHP
3 Technical Description
6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Note: Derating is done only from the operator terminal and always before any offshore operation.
A set of Load Derating Table diagrams is found in chapter 9; describing alternative SWL for working conditions
other than the base case conditions (offshore and other specific conditions etc).
In order to operate, emergency ship power must be available, and the jumper cable must be connected. This
cable is only for emergency operation.
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 7
User Manual for Crane
8. Safety Features
The following safety features are included in the design of most advanced MacGregor cranes.
3 Technical Description
8 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
• Maintaining the speed of the hydraulic function at a constant value independent of load.
• Holding operating pressure in the event of sudden pressure loss. This stops and locks the function in the
case of a hydraulic hose or pipe failure.
Such load holding valves are used for slew gear (double load holding valve holds the slewing position against
loads from either side), the winch, and the luffing cylinders (piston side to hold the jib up).
In addition to the normal power supply, MOPS is connected in series to two 12V batteries, giving backup
electrical power. If no pumps are running, a backup accumulator will also provide hydraulic pressure for valve
activation and brake disengagement on the winch.
The MOPS system is designed to be functional for at least five minutes running only on batteries. Ref. EN-
13852, the MOPS shall be able to be activated three times in a row as a minimum.
Note: For cranes with a personnel lift (formerly called man-riding) function, the MOPS system is automatically
deactivated when in personnel lift mode.
• Accumulators.
• 3/2 way electrically operated pilot valve.
• Pressure relief valve.
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 9
User Manual for Crane
The system is only operational if at least one main pump is assigned to the main winch, and for safety purposes,
when the hook is not positioned over the vessel/platform.
If AOPS is activated, oil flow to the winch is set to maximum lowering, causing immediate winch pay-out.
Note: As with MOPS, for cranes with a personnel lift function, the AOPS system is automatically deactivated
when in personnel lift mode.
• Mechanical hook-stop.
• Electronic hook-stop.
The encoders provide 4096 pulses to the PLC for every revolution of the winch. Since the number of pulses for
one winch revolution is constant, the PLC must calculate actual wire length taking into account how many wire
layers have come off the drum.
3 Technical Description
10 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 11
User Manual for Crane
Blank Page.
3 Technical Description
12 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3 Technical Description
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 13
User Manual for Crane
Blank Page.
3 Technical Description
14 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
1. Introduction
The purpose of this procedure is to:
1. Ensure that all components are handled / lifted in a safe and correct way to avoid any injury or damage
to personnel or equipment.
2. Ensure up to 2 years’ storage with no deterioration in function and/or quality that could reduce the
working performance or service life of the unit.
3. Ensure that installation and initial start up are performed in a safe and correct way.
3. Crane Preservation
See separate document: T0011 – Handling, Preservation & Storage Procedures page 3.
• Deck structure must be free from cracks, rust, oil and other elements that could inhibit bolting/welding
of the pedestal to the sub-foundation.
• The crane is delivered as agreed.
• Be sure that no dust or other contaminants enter the hydraulic system.
• Be sure that the vessel’s foundation sub-structure is dimensioned to bear the weight of the specific
crane and the forces it will exert.
5. Initial Start-up
It is important to check that valves and controls are in the correct position before attempting to start the crane.
As a final check before starting, check the rotation of the electric motors. Motors must rotate in a clockwise
direction as seen from the motor’s fan end. If a motor rotates in the wrong direction, swap two phases and check
again for clockwise rotation.
The main HPU motors are bolted just below the slew bearing on the underside of the king bottom plate. Access
is through a door in the pedestal.
A hydraulic pump must not be allowed to run in the wrong direction for any length of time, as this will
reduce the service life of the pump.
Upon completion of the initial test run, check the oil level in the oil tank, and top up if necessary.
The first time the system is started there may be air in the system. Run the power pack for a couple of minutes at
low pressure. The winch and the slew will automatically vent air from the system when operated.
This is done by lowering and raising the full length of wire a minimum of three times while maintaining a
tension equivalent to 10%-20% SWL.
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
PROJECT DOCUMENT
This document and all information and data herein or herewith is the confidential and proprietary property of
MacGregor Norway AS and is not to be used, reproduced or disclosed in whole or in part by or to anyone without
the written confirmation from MacGregor Norway AS.
© MacGregor Norway AS
www.macgregor-group.com
Equipment:
Offshore Products
- -
- MacGregor Norway AS
Andøyfaret 15, N-4623 Kristiansand
NORWAY
1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................. 3
1.1 References ...................................................................................................................................3
3 LIFTING ................................................................................................................. 3
3.1 Safety Note ...................................................................................................................................3
4 TRANSPORT ........................................................................................................ 4
4.1 Packing .........................................................................................................................................4
5 STORAGE ............................................................................................................. 5
5.1 Preparation ...................................................................................................................................5
6 PRESERVATION .................................................................................................. 6
6.1 Inspection of equipment on Receipt .........................................................................................6
1 GENERAL
The purpose of this procedure is to ensure proper storage, safe lifting and transport of
MacGregor Norway Offshore Products
1.1 References
HM Doc. No. Doc. Title
SPxxx-XXXX-GXX [300T Main….]
SPxxx-XXXX-…. [Spooling….]
SPxxx- XXX-…… [Control…..]
2 PRECEDING ACTIVITIES
2.1 Preparation
The following actions shall be done prior to lifting and transport operations of MacGregor
Norway products. A “Tilt Watch” may be placed on the items to check if the transport and
lifting has been done in a proper way.
• Wire rope to be fully spooled onto the drum with tension. The free end to be
fastened properly.
• Wooden pads (4 off) are to be fitted underneath the feet of the foundations on
small parts without transport cradle.
• Ensure that all movable parts are properly fastened to prevent them from any
uncontrolled movements.
• Ensure that end of interface electric cables and hydraulic hoses are disconnected
and their loose end are fastened and protected properly. Make sure that all ends
are marked properly to avoid any problems during reconnection of the
equipment.
• The opened hydraulic connections to be protected against impurity with caps.
• Lifting and handling of the equipment to be prepared according to relevant lifting
drawing.
• Length and capacity of loose lifting gear to be in accordance to relevant lifting
drawing.
• Loose lifting gear to be inspected for defects.
• Loose lifting gear certificates to be present.
3 LIFTING
4 TRANSPORT
The equipment may be transported by ship or truck to final destination.
For more detailed information about overall dimension weights and COG locations
individually for each unit, refer to section 3 in this document and/or corresponding GA
drawing, transport drawing, and or relevant packing list.
4.1 Packing
Belonging equipment to the product may be packed in standard 20` container and on
deck of transport vessel. Preparations described in 2.1 shall be performed. Make sure
there remains no loose component in the container. All the modules shall be properly
strapped to container.
Smaller items may be packed in VCI bags for transport
4.2 Unpacking
The unpacking shall be done short time prior to installation. If unpacking is done earlier,
follow instruction given in section 5.
Check that equipment has not moved inside container, and there are no damages or
elements missing before unloading. If any damages are found, take pictures when
equipment still is inside container, or on transport vessel. Carefully loosen the securing of
each element.
Unpacking from open top container is done by using lifting sets/sling mounting on the
equipment. Follow lifting instructions given in section 3. Fork truck is used for unpacking
equipment without lifting sets.
5 STORAGE
5.1 Preparation
• Prepare sufficient area for storing: The equipment shall be stored in areas free of
contamination from welding, grinding or other activity containing hot metal
particles.
• It is recommended to choose sheltered place, if storing the equipment outdoors.
• All the disconnected interface electrical and hydraulic joints are to be protected, no
loose items left.
• Carbon steel surfaces which are not painted to be preserved as described in
attached tables of preservative
• Touch up painting if paint has been damaged.
• If the equipment is contaminated by salt, dirt or particles which may damage the
equipment, the equipment shall be washed with fresh water prior to storage.
5.2 Storage
The product and loose components should be stored in their natural position. They should
rest on wooden pads to isolate the equipment from the ground. Unpainted/exposed steel
shall rest on a rubber layer with wooden pads below. The equipment cannot be stacked
up on top of each other. The equipment is to be protected during storing, and also after
installation onboard against dust, damages, humidity, painting etc. (see chapter 6)
NOTE:
If the equipment is stored for more than three months, the standard periodic maintenance
activities (lubrication) are to be done to the equipment according to the maintenance
schedule. For details refer to corresponding documents. Re-preservation is solely the
responsibility of the buyer or the buyers appointed as described in chapter 6.7 Project
Cycle for Preservation.
Title: Handling Preservation & Storage Procedure
Proj.No.:
Doc.No.: T0011
6 PRESERVATION
Preservation work in all stages of the project may involve usage of solvent that may be
harmful to human. Personal performing this type of work, should be wearing personal
protection equipment.
When purchasing preservatives, data sheet must be required as a part of the delivery.
These sheets must be received and correct action taken according to listing on data sheet
before preservation can be carried out.
All yellowcromated materials, as well as valve spindles are covered with Densotape to
avoid corrosion.
Shafts on rotating equipments, which are not locked, shall be rotated 1 ¼ turn in the
rotation direction to avoid brinelling of the bearing. Make sure that new shaft positions
vary from one turn to the other.
Connect heaters to all motors that are specified in the check record to be heated. Check
the heaters to be effective after power hook up by using an Ampere meter, or hand feel
the temperature outside the motor.
HM has topped up all gearboxes with gear oil. Vertical gear box with the pinion facing
down, are topped when they are in operation as well as during storage. These gearboxes
are filled with oil and can go right into operation provided that the storage time is limited.
Horizontal gearboxes are also topped with oil. Horizontal gearboxes must be drained to
correct level prior to use of the boxes. However, heavy-duty gearboxes have been
drained for gear oil, and the gear oil is replaced with preservation oil to specified
level. See check record for correct oil and level. Gear boxes topped with oil shall be
marked with labels as shown in chapter 6.6.
All air bottles or accumulators are put under pressure using dried Nitrogen. The pressure
is normally between 2 and 3 bars. Inspect air bottles or accumulators for positive Nitrogen
pressure. If the pressure is below 1.5 bars, re-pressurize with Nitrogen of dew point –
30deg.
All electrical and electric boxes or cabinets exposed to humidity shall be protected with
desiccants inside. Place a sticker on the outside of the cabinet showing the date when the
desiccant was put in.
Title: Handling Preservation & Storage Procedure
Proj.No.:
Doc.No.: T0011
Shafts on electrical motors and the mechanical seal at the front bearing shall be protected
with grease of type described in preservation record.
All non terminated cable ends shall be fitted with shrinking shroud.
All space heaters on motors, generators, panels etc. shall be energized for storage.
Paint system in
3 3 All painting to be undamaged. If not, repair painting
HM…….
Tectyl506/
4 3 Chain linkages which can be exposed to rust to be protected
CortecVpCI369
Tectyl506
5 3 Stainless steel sign to be protected
Decordyn 350
HDG Bolt or
6 3 Open holes unused treaded opening in carbon steel to be sealed of
plastic plug
Texaco
7 3 Door / Hatch hinges to be greased
Multifak EP2
Comments:
Comments:
Inspect internals for corrosion and moisture – if so, dry up and repair, add
3 3
desiccant and ensure tight sealing’s
All spare cable entrances in panels and boxes plugged. If not vertical installed
4 3
with drain plug down – seal drain plug.
5 3 Open nipples and glands in panels and junction boxes to be sealed off.
Comments:
Paint system in
3 3 All painting to be undamaged. If not, repair painting
HM…….
Tectyl506/
4 3 Chain linkages which can be exposed to rust to be protected
Cotec369
Tectyl506
5 3 Stainless steel sign to be protected
Decordyn 350
Texaco
7 3 Door / hatch hinges to be greased
Multifak EP2
Tectyl506 on bolt
9 3 Bondura Bolts, for assembly use Kluberpaste 46 MR 401 ends and creviced
area.
Check air bottles or accumulators for Nitrogen pressure. Pressure between 1,5
2 3
to3 barg or VCI protection. See list of preservatives
3 3 Gear box topped up with specified gear oil according to list of preservative.
Open end nozzles plugged or capped properly. Nozzle face coated with Tectyl 506
5 3
preservatives. Flange protected with flange protectors. Decordyn 350
Densotape
6 3 Extended cylinder rods coated with preservative an protected with wood
Wood
Shafts on rotating equipment, wich are not locked, shall be rotated 1 ¼ turn in
8 3 rotating direction. New shafts pos. from one turn to another. Bearings with
lub.oil, check oil level before turning.
Comments:
All cabinets, panels and boxes exposed to humidity protected with desiccant.
3 3
Replace desiccant if necessary.
Inspect internals for corrosion and moisture – if so, dry up and repair, add
4 3
desiccant and ensure tight sealing’s
All spare cable entrances in panels and boxes plugged. If not vertical installed
5 3
with drain plug down – seal drain plug.
6 3 Open nipples and glands in panels and junction boxes to be sealed off.
Comments:
Inspect the space heater is effective using an ampere meter or handfeel the
12 1
unit. Ensure that indication light on temp heating distribution panel is working
For space heaters that are not temporarily energized, measure insulation
13 3 resistance phase to phase and phase to earth. Attached form EP 02 to be filled
in.
14 3 Batteries for PLC and CPU fully charged and isolated from consumer.
17 3 Cabin to be heated.
18
3 Cabin AC Unit to be protected by a tarpaulin
Comments:
Paint system in
3 3 All painting to be undamaged. If not, repair painting
HM…….
Tectyl506/
4 3 Chain linkages which can be exposed to rust to be protected
Cotec369
Tectyl506
5 3 Stainless steel sign to be protected
Decordyn 350
HDG Bolt or
6 3 Open holes unused treaded opening in carbon steel to be sealed of
plastic plug
Tectyl506 on
7 3 Bondura Bolts, For assembly use Kluberpaste46 MR401 bolt ends and
creviced area.
Rando oil
8 1 Cylinders shall be full of hydraulic oil
HD46
Texaco
10 3 Nylatron sliding pads (crane booms)
Multifak EP2
Texaco
11 3 Wire sheaves to be turned 1 ¼ turn and greased ( central lub. system )
Multifak EP2
Comments:
Check air bottles or accumulators for Nitrogen pressure. Pressure between 1,5
1 3
to3 barg or VCI protection. See list of preservatives
Open end nozzles plugged or capped properly. Nozzle face coated with Tectyl 506
3 3
preservatives. Flange protected with flange protectors. Decordyn 350
Densotape
4 3 Extended cylinder rods coated with preservative an protected with wood
Wood
Comments:
All cabinets, panels and boxes exposed to humidity protected with desiccant.
3 3
Replace desiccant if necessary.
Inspect internals for corrosion and moisture – if so, dry up and repair, add
4 3
desiccant and ensure tight sealing’s
All spare cable entrances in panels and boxes plugged. If not vertical installed
5 3
with drain plug down – seal drain plug.
6 3 Open nipples and glands in panels and junction boxes to be sealed off.
Comments:
Inspect the space heater is effective using an ampere meter or handfeel the
11 3
unit. Ensure that indication light on temp heating distribution panel is working
For space heaters that are not temporarily energized, measure insulation
12 3 resistance phase to phase and phase to earth. Attached form EP 02 to be filled
in.
Comments:
Paint system in
3 3 All painting to be undamaged. If not, repair painting
HM…….
Tectyl506/
4 3 Chain linkages which can be exposed to rust to be protected
Cotec369
Tectyl506
5 3 Stainless steel sign to be protected
Decordyn 350
Comments:
Open end nozzles plugged or capped properly. Nozzle face coated with Tectyl 506
3 3
preservatives. Flange protected with flange protectors. Decordyn 350
Densotape
4 3 Extended cylinder rods coated with preservative an protected with wood
Wood
Comments:
All cabinets, panels and boxes exposed to humidity protected with desiccant.
3 3
Replace desiccant if necessary.
Inspect internals for corrosion and moisture – if so, dry up and repair, add
4 3
desiccant and ensure tight sealing’s
All spare cable entrances in panels and boxes plugged. If not vertical installed
5 3
with drain plug down – seal drain plug.
6 3 Open nipples and glands in panels and junction boxes to be sealed off.
Comments:
Comments:
6.3 De – Preservation
Effort has been made to minimize the need of de-preservation. Preservatives may be left
on the products when going into operation provided that these will contribute to extended
life of the product and not harmful to the product in any way.
The preparation checking and functional activities must be performed in the same phase,
but the operational activities may be performed in a later phase than the functional
activities depending on installation completion.
If commissioning is performed during multiples phases, the equipment shall be preserved
when functional activities are completed. Subsequently, de-preservation must be
performed prior to commissioning operational activities.
MAINTENANCE
Signature Date
PRESERVATION
CARRIED OUT
HM PROJECTNO.: _____________
SERIAL NO.:__________________
INTERVALS:__________________
DATE_________ SIGN_________
Title.:
Proj.No.:
Doc.No.:
Date________ Sign._________
Title.:
Proj.No.:
Doc.No.:
1. Decordyn 350
Exposed/Machined carbon steel 2. Tectyl 122A with overlap towards
painted surfaces
Other accepted products:
Cortec VpCI 368HB
1. Bridon Brilube 70
Wire 2. Cortec VpCI368 on dry wire
3. Wire grease outside
Wires are pre-greased.
Cabin AC unit Protect outside unit from rain and dust with a
tarpaulin.
De-preservation where
Required in Procedure
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
Table of Contents
1. Safety ..............................................................................................................................................1
1.1. Safety features ..........................................................................................................................1
1.2. Safety Instructions .....................................................................................................................3
1.3. General Handling Considerations ..............................................................................................4
1.3.1. Weather and Sea State .......................................................................................................4
1.3.2. Derating ..............................................................................................................................4
1.3.3. Parking................................................................................................................................4
1.3.4. Welding ...............................................................................................................................4
2. Modes of Operation .........................................................................................................................5
2.1. Normal.......................................................................................................................................5
2.2. Constant Tension (CT) ..............................................................................................................5
3. Crane Controls Overview .................................................................................................................6
3.1. General .....................................................................................................................................6
3.2. Cabin Equipment .......................................................................................................................7
3.2.1. Operating Panel OP-105 .....................................................................................................7
3.2.2. Operator Panel OP-103 (Chair Left Armrest).......................................................................8
3.2.3. Operator Panel OP-104 (Chair Right Armrest) ....................................................................8
3.2.4. Control Cabinet CC-100 ......................................................................................................9
3.2.5. Control Screen ....................................................................................................................9
4. Crane System Start and Stop.........................................................................................................17
4.1. Pre-Start Preparations .............................................................................................................17
4.1.1. Planning ............................................................................................................................17
4.1.2. Equipment Check ..............................................................................................................17
4.1.3. Control System On / Off Switch .........................................................................................17
4.1.4. System Checks (In / From Cabin) .....................................................................................18
4.1.5. Check HPU Status ............................................................................................................18
4.2. Normal Start ............................................................................................................................19
4.2.1. Motor Start-Up ..................................................................................................................19
4.2.2. Cold Weather ....................................................................................................................19
4.2.3. After Start..........................................................................................................................19
4.3. Normal Shutdown ....................................................................................................................20
4.4. HPU Control ............................................................................................................................20
4.4.1. General .............................................................................................................................20
4.4.2. Local / Remote Pump Control ...........................................................................................20
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 3
User Manual for Crane
1. Safety
1.1. Safety features
General The equipment delivered by MacGregor Norway AS under this contract has been
designed in accordance with current HSE regulations and standards.
Emergency stop An emergency stop button is located on the right-hand operating panel on the
operator’s seat inside the cabin. Pressing this button cuts off the crane’s hydraulic
pressure. At least one emergency stop button is also located inside the king.
Spring-centred control All control levers, both two-way and joystick type, are spring-centred. When released,
levers they all return to centre, and whatever motion is active stops.
Overload protection All crane motions are protected against overload by hydraulic relief valves and by the
control system. If a particular motion is attempted which exceeds the crane’s design
capabilities, the relevant relief valve for the particular motion will feed the hydraulic
oil back into the hydraulic oil tank, preventing the motion.
Hook stop systems There are two hook stop systems. The software hook stop is based on wire payout
information from rotational encoders on the winch drums and implemented by the
PLC software. The hardware hook stop is based on a switching device suspended
from the tip of the knuckle jib. When the hook touches this device, twin switches send
a double signal to the control system, which stops the winch before the hook is pulled
into the sheave.
Luffing cylinder The jib luffing cylinders are fitted with mechanical stroke limiters which allow luffing
limitation to take place at full speed.
Load holding valves The main jib luffing cylinders are fitted with pilot-operated load-holding valves.
These valves are connected directly to the cylinder ports and have a dual function:
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 1
User Manual for Crane
Failsafe brakes The winch and slew gearboxes all have failsafe, oil-bath, multidisc hydraulic brakes. In
case of hydraulic pressure loss due to hose/pipe failure, the brake actuates automatically
and halts further motion.
Aircraft warning Red aircraft warning lights are mounted atop the main winch and the main jib outer end
lights to mark the crane during conditions of darkness.
Emergency If the main system power should fail, the winch and other crane functions may be
power supplied by the emergency power system which provides a direct connection to the
ship’s power supply. The AHC system will not be available for operation in emergency
mode, however.
Load / Radius A jib angle sensor system provides data to the control system for calculating the
control system working radius. Load cells in sheave hubs on the knuckle jib register the actual load
suspended from the crane. When a lift is close to the allowable radius/capacity, a
warning is displayed on the operator screen. When the maximum permissible radius is
exceeded, the control system halts jib out movement. The only manoeuvre then allowed
by the control system is movement towards a shorter radius.
Tugger The crane operator must ensure that ANY and ALL operations in which a tugger winch
Winches physically holds the main hook away from the whip winch working area are under
precise control. The tugger winch must always be in constant tension mode. This will
allow the tugger winch to pay out wire if the load on the main hook increases. This may
be due to movement of the crane or accidental movement of the main winch. If there is
a power failure or the crane has been switched off, the tugger winch must be reset to
constant tension mode. MacGregor Norway AS also recommends the use of a “weak-
link” connecting sling equivalent to the tugger winch SWL with an extra safety sling
instead of connecting the tugger hook directly to the main hook.
AOPS is inaccessible when the jib tip is over deck, and is automatically made accessible
when the jib tip is over water.
If the wire is caught on another vessel or the seabed and the crane and/or vessel is
disabled, there is a risk of exposing the crane to higher loads than it is designed for as
the vessel drifts. Should this occur, the operator can activate the MOPS by pressing the
yellow button for the appropriate winch on operating panel OP-104 (next to right
joystick). The system will then pay out wire while maintaining a retaining force of
approx. 10-20% of maximum rated winch capacity.
5 Operation
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Risk of collision Pay attention to the risk of collision with the superstructure when slewing and jibbing.
Auto Tension with Never activate Auto Tension Mode while a load is hanging from the hook. This can put
load in the hook the load into free fall and cause major damage to vessel or other structure.
Lifting gear Never use lifting gear with cracks deformations etc. that can reduce the original
strength. All lifting gear must also have the required lifting capacity for the actual load.
Always pay Respect the alarms and information given on the screen.
attention to the
crane control system
Override Mode Do not operate the crane in override mode unless the situation requires this. Override
mode supersedes all interlocks of crane
Operator To operate the crane, the operator must be familiar with the crane and crane user
manual. The crane operator must also fulfil the requirements given by the vessels flag
authorities.
Single wire parts The crane must never be operated if the information on the screen is not correct
compared to actual block in use.
Wire tension – Operational restriction on main winch, please refer to Annex B - "Safety Bulletin 2010-
retrieval operations SB03".
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 3
User Manual for Crane
A crane can operate under a wide range of conditions, but a few key parameters are critical to operational
planning. These include wind speed and direction, heave (wave height and period), list and trim conditions,
offlead angles and the type of lift (i.e. internal, external or ship-to-ship – also treated as an environmental
factor).
Obviously, where relative movements are concerned (external and ship-to-ship lifts), sea state and weather are
important factors that must be taken into account in all planning and operations.
1.3.2. Derating
Operators and users of MacGregor HMC offshore cranes need to understand the basics of crane load limitations
under the different operating modes to avoid putting too much strain on the crane under varying conditions.
Incorrect crane operation can lead to dangerous situations, damage to equipment or to the vessel, and serious
personal injury or worse.
A crane always has its own individual ratings, which describe exactly what capacity the crane can lift at a given
radius under given conditions. As the radius increases or as conditions deteriorate, the allowed rating decreases;
this is referred to as derating. Load diagrams apply to internal, subsea (external) and ship-to-ship lifting
situations.
1.3.3. Parking
The crane must be properly parked after use: knuckle jib folded in, main jib down, slew angle at park and both
knuckle jib and hook(s) in their cradles, if present. This achieves three important purposes:
1. With the cylinder rods fully retracted, their bare metal surfaces are protected from the corrosive marine
environment.
2. Releasing system pressure eliminates strain on system components and extends the life of seals on
cylinders, valves and connections.
3. Securing idle equipment is an important safety measure on board a ship.
1.3.4. Welding
Sensitive electronic components are easily damaged by the stray electrical charges that welding currents can
produce. Therefore, if any electric welding is to be done on the crane, the control system must first be isolated
by turning off the main control system circuit-breaker, F15, located in ES400 in the king.
5 Operation
4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2. Modes of Operation
2.1. Normal
Normal crane operation allows the crane operator to carry out most lifting operations with the crane such as
slewing, luffing, ordinary lifting and lowering with any winch, and parking.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 5
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Cabin ventilation The operator cabin is equipped with two heaters and an air conditioner. The heaters
are located under the operator chair and are controlled by an on/off switch located
on the control panel on the left wall. Temperature is thermostat-controlled.
The air conditioning unit is located on the rear wall of the cabin and has individual
controls for cooling and fan speed on the front of the unit.
Radio w/ CD player The operator cabin is equipped with an RDS radio/CD player and a set of speakers
mounted on the side walls on either side of the operator.
VHF/UHF radio The operator cabin is equipped with a VHF radio and a UHF radio mounted on the
wall panel. The top switch on the right joystick is used for push to talk (PTT), and a
switch below the radios is used to select which radio to operate.
Window wiper and The left, right, front (central) and rooftop windows are fitted with a wiper/washer
washer system. The window wiper and washer switches are located on the wall mounted
utility panel at the operators left side.
Window wipers and The front top window, front bottom window, roof window and both side windows of
washers the cabin are all equipped with wipers and washers.
Cabin heater These switches control the cabin heating and defrosting.
Radio/CD player Stereo system with speakers on left and right walls
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 7
User Manual for Crane
Four-way joystick The spring-centred four-way joystick with thumb wheel and front switches controls
the crane slew and main jib luffing functions.
FUNCTION COMMENTS
Joystick X- • Crane slew Clock Wise (CW)
positive
Joystick X- • Crane slew Counter Clock Wise
negative (CCW).
Joystick Y- • Main jib down
positive
Joystick Y- • Main jib up
negative
Front switch • Alarm Acknowledge
Front switch • Front washer
Front switch • Front wiper
Thumb wheel • Tugger 1 in/out, tension +/-
MOPS Main winch The MOPS Main winch button has a cover to protect it from being pressed
accidentally. Lift cover to operate. Push once to activate MOPS mode, and once more
(Manual Overload to deactivate. More information in the Main Winch section.
protection system)
Four-way joystick The four-way spring-centred joystick with thumb wheel and front switches controls
the main/whip winches and knuckle jib functions.
5 Operation
8 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
FUNCTION COMMENTS
Joystick X-positive • Crane knuckle jib out
Joystick X-negative • Crane knuckle jib in
Joystick Y-positive • Winch down
Joystick Y-negative • Winch up
Front switch • Signal horn
Front switch • Main/whip winch selection
Front switch • PTT (UHF/VHF)
Thumb wheel • Tugger 1 in/out, tension +/-
Note: To prevent accidents, always set in ‘Off’ position when leaving the operator
chair or when the crane is not being operated!
Emergency stop The ES button locks in stop position when activated. To release turn the button CCW.
button
When this switch is turned Off, the emergency stop loop is de-energized, meaning that no pumps or crane
functions can be activated. This switch is always turned off to ensure that the crane cannot be operated while
service is being performed. System off is also indicated by an alarm on the control screen. This switch may be
locked in the Off position.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 9
User Manual for Crane
Main functions
1. Alarm Banner (always on top) displays the last incoming alarm. This alarm is acknowledged on the
alarm screen or by pressing the yellow top switch on the left joystick. Described in further detail in the
alarm section.
2. Alarm Status Banner (always on top) displays the alarm status for different groups. Described in further
detail in alarm section.
3. Equipment and Functions Status Banner (always on top) displays the status of equipment and functions
by using different colours. Described in more detail below.
4. Field displaying the name of the active screen
5. Time and date field
6. Load indicator:
o Green area: Load range for the selected crane derating. This range can change according to
mode, wave-height and dynamic factor.
o Yellow area: Dynamic forces are acceptable. This range can change according to mode, wave-
height and dynamic factor.
o Red area: Load exceeds 100% of maximum SWL for Internal Hs=0 in current mode
7. Menu button (menu presented next page).
8. Relative Knuckle Jib Angle Information. Press Rel. Knuckle Jib button for pop-up dialog box (ill. Next
page).
1 3 5
4 2
5 Operation
10 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Bringing up displays
The following screens are defined and can be selected by touching the MENU button at the
bottom and selecting the desired screen from the menu (shown at right):
• Previous
• Setup
• Alarm
• Misc
• MW Lineup
• HPU
• Trend
• Main
The menu also has a Previous button at the top which will return the previous screen.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 11
User Manual for Crane
The items in the equipment and function status banner are presented here.
5 Operation
12 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Examples of screen objects are ‘bar graphs’. All bar graphs in the front screen application have the same design
and share the same basic functionality. Other examples are numeric output fields etc.
Common functionality improves recognition, accelerates the learning curve and simplifies the application. It is
very important that the user is familiar with the different properties of the screen objects.
General buttons
Buttons in the HMI screen application are activated by touching them on the touch screen. Some buttons, when
touched, will produce a pop-up dialogue that prompts the user for input. The various pop-up dialogues will now
be presented in brief.
Background is The associated function is active (the Main Winch mode-selection buttons are typical
Blinking examples). After pressing Confirm, but before AHC is ready, the button blinks.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 13
User Manual for Crane
Bar Graphs
Bar graphs are a vital part of the front screen application. These are used to show system
parameters both in analogue and numeric format.
The bar graphs used in the HMI screen application have a set of features associated with
them.
Bar graph scaling enables the operator to adjust the scale to suit the values expected in the
coming operation, or to zoom in to specific signal ranges. Touch the bar graph that is to be
adjusted. A pop-up dialogue with several options is displayed on the screen. Use the
selections to set a new maximum or minimum, for example, and then close the pop-up.
The bar graph will now show the new settings.
A max/min marker function is included to help visualise the range of a signal. When this
function is active, two light blue lines are used to continuously show the lowest and
highest value shown by the bar graph. For example, if this mode is active and the highest
value ever shown is 7.0, the “high” marker is next to the 7.0 point on the scale. If the bar
graph value exceeds this value, for example to 8.0, the “high” marker is pushed up to the
8.0 point. Note that the low/high markers for all bar graphs can be reset by touching the
Set Markers button on the bar graph pop-up that appears when the bar graph is touched.
A reference marker function is included as a help to the user. When this function is active,
a yellow line is “frozen” on the screen to display a reference that the user can adjust as
needed. This feature is useful for observing variations.
Numeric output fields are used to display any real time value. The
output field states the name of the signal and the unit of measure.
All output fields have a light grey background and black numbers.
Input fields
Numeric input fields are used to enter new values. The input field consists of the name of the signal, and the unit
of measure, if relevant.
All input fields have a white background and black text/numbers. After touching the white area, a pop-up
dialogue appears in which the user enters the appropriate input.
Status indicators
5 Operation
14 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Radio buttons
Click inside the circle beside the item to be selected. If the selection is approved by
the control system, a black dot is showed inside the circle indicating that the selection
has been carried out.
Valve objects
Two types of valves are used in the HMI screen application: valves which the operator can open/close directly,
and valves which the operator cannot open/close (operated by the control system).
When the operator touches a valve object with direct control capabilities, a pop-up dialogue will appear
prompting to confirm a start or stop command.
The colour coding below is used to show the various modes of operation for all valve objects with direct control
functionality.
Steady white fill The valve has been closed by the PLC
Flashing white and green Flashes while the valve is closing or opening
Steady green fill The valve has been opened by the PLC
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 15
User Manual for Crane
Pump objects
The pumps are presented with colour codes indicating pump status.
Filter objects
The various filters are presented on the front screen with colour coding indicating filter status.
5 Operation
16 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
• Check that lifting gear / loose gear is in good order and approved for the purpose by a visual inspection
of equipment and certificates.
• Visually inspect crane, wires, wire sheaves, machine room with pumps, hoses, oil tank level and valves
(visible leaks/defects).
• Check that emergency stop buttons in king are not activated.
• Check that the crane is fit for the operation and rigged for the job in question: winch selection, reeving,
hook height above deck, working radius etc.
• Communication with bridge
Warning: If the key is in OFF position, always check whether any service operations are being performed
on the crane before switching ON and starting up.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 17
User Manual for Crane
Check that the Ctrl Enable switch on OP-104 (right operating panel) is Off.
5 Operation
18 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
• Check that oil level and temperature are acceptable, that all colour codes on the HPU screen are normal
(green motors, grey filters), and there are no critical alarms on the alarm banner.
• Pay attention to the crane control system and respect the warnings and alarms it gives.
• Is communication with the slinger / banksman satisfactory?
• Is communication with the bridge in order?
Once the HPU has started and system checks are complete, the crane is ready for operation.
The Ctrl Enable switch on OP-103 (left operating panel) remains Off if any mode is to be selected or derating
performed. Always turn this switch off before leaving (or entering) the operator’s seat.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 19
User Manual for Crane
Park crane Park crane before initiating shutdown: knuckle jib folded in, main jib down, slew
angle at park and both knuckle jib and hook(s) in their cradles, if present.
Controls on/off Check that the Ctrl On/Off switch on operating panel OP-104 (right) is turned OFF.
Shut down The main pumps can now be stopped by touching the motor symbols on the HPU
screen to select them, and then touching the Stop button in the motor pop-up to stop
them.
The circulation pump will continue to run 5 minutes after the last main pump has
stopped. The circulation pump will stop automatically if it is set in “Auto” mode. The
CJC filter pump is left to run continually, even when the crane is not in use.
To return pump control to the control system, the local/remote switches on the starter panel in the king must be
set to Remote, indicated in the control system by a grey frame around the motor symbols.
4.4.3. Sensors
Level and temperature sensors and switches on the oil reservoir send information to the control system.
Pressure sensor switches on all system filters send signals to the control system when clogged.
Analogue indications are given in the king (thermometer, sight glass, warning lights).
5 Operation
20 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
8
5
6
2 10
9
The following table below lists the main functions on this screen.
No. Description
1 Main pump status (1-4)
2 Circulation pump status
3 Filter symbol (red when clogged)
4 Pressure reading main pressure
5 Oil Temperature
6 Oil Tank Level in %
7 High temp alarm lamp
8 High and low level indication lamps and bar graph
9 Buttons for choosing the HPU, main winch or whip winch lineup screens
10 CJC filter pump status
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 21
User Manual for Crane
These screens display information about the valves in the hydraulic control system as well as various pressure
readings. They also provide oil cooler fan motor control.
The buttons along the bottom right provide easy access between the three HPU system screens.
Analogue Sensors
5 Operation
22 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Filter Status
All hydraulic system filters have built-in pressure switches that signal the PLC when the filter is clogged. When
a pressure switch is activated, an alarm is generated in the control system and displayed on the HMI screen, as
described in earlier chapters.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 23
User Manual for Crane
Mode Description
Manual Manual mode is set by touching MAN in the Oil cooler motor operation pop-up. This must be done
for each cooler. Each cooler can then be started and stopped by touching the OFF and ON buttons.
Note: The oil cooler will not start automatically when in manual mode, which may lead to
overheating, especially during AHC operations.
Automatic Automatic mode is set by touching AUTO in the Oil cooler motor operation pop-up. When automatic
(recommended) mode is selected, the coolers start at the following temperatures:
Cooler 1: > 45 degrees C
Cooler 2: > 50 degrees C
Cooler 3: > 55 degrees C
Cooler 4: > 60 degrees C
Cooler 5: > 65 degrees C
5 Operation
24 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
All motor/pump units are started from the operator’s touch-screen in the cabin. Check that the HPU is running at
an idle pressure of approx. 40 bar. Check that the circulation pump has started automatically. Make sure that the
oil coolers are set Auto to maintain proper temperature control during operation.
Note: When planning to operate more than one crane function at a time, ALL pumps must be running.
Loads are always lifted off the deck by using the winch. Any of the main jib, knuckle jib and slew functions
may then be used once the crane is carrying the load.
During crane operations, relevant information and controls are found in the Main screen on the operator’s
terminal. All items on these screens will be briefly presented in the sections on the winch, the details on pop-ups
and so on will be presented in subsequent sections as their functions are presented.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 25
User Manual for Crane
A rotational encoder is installed on the main winch for keeping track of hook position and wire payout. The
encoder registers nothing but the length of wire paid out. Since the hook position follows the jib tip, and the jib
tip’s position varies with the main and knuckle jib angles without affecting wire payout, the control system PLC
must continuously use real-time crane geometry parameters to calculate the hook’s true position.
The main winch has two upper hook stops and one lower hook stop
The upper (software) hook stop is activated by the control system when the calculated hook position is less than
the initialized zero meters. When upper hook stop is reached, the knuckle jib in and main jib down movements
stop.
The lower hook stop (end stop) is activated by the control system when three turns are left on the winch drum.
Payout stops, preventing the entire length of wire from being run out. An alarm is given when the calculated
wire payout is less than 50 metres from the end stop.
It is recommended that a verification of this function is included in the crane operator’s daily check list.
A dual bridge load cell fitted to the upper sheave hub on the knuckle jib measures the main winch load. The
load can be monitored on the HMI display in the cabin. Refer to MacGregor Hydramarine AS load charts for an
overview of crane derating according to radius and sea state.
Maximum Load
The maximum permissible load for the current crane derating and radius is displayed inside the dial on the main
screen.
An alarm is generated on the control screen and the cabin buzzer is activated when 90 % of max load is reached.
At 100 % of maximum load the horn outside the cabin will sound and an alarm will be generated on the operator
display.
When the load reaches 100% of allowed maximum load, the main- and knuckle jib will only be allowed to
move to a smaller radius.
Crane Radius
The radius is the calculated distance from jib tip to centre of crane king. Crane radius is calculated from the
main jib angle and knuckle jib angle registered by the jib angle encoders.
5 Operation
26 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Interlocks
Derating
Derating comprises a range of parameters in specific situations, and is dealt with in the following section.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 27
User Manual for Crane
Modes
This is the process called derating, which implements a reduction in crane capacity reflecting the higher
dynamic forces acting on the crane and load under certain conditions.
The Significant Wave Height input box is used in Ship To Ship and Ship to Ship Connected modes for
derating the crane according to the sea state.
Dynamic factor
In Subsea Lift mode, a hydrodynamic analysis based on the specific geometry of a load must be performed to
obtain the dynamic factor for each specific subsea lift.
5 Operation
28 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
When the main winch has been selected on the operator’s control terminal, the Main Winch Screen appears on
the display:
11
12
10
8 9
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 29
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
30 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
This pop-up gives the operator information on various pressure measurements and status items relevant to other
crane functions.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 31
User Manual for Crane
5.5. Slew
The left joystick’s x-axis (left control panel OP-103) controls crane slew. Pushing the joystick left slews the
crane to the left (counter clockwise), and pushing the joystick right slews the crane to the right (clockwise).
Centring the joystick as the crane is slewing will cause the control system to ramp down the slew speed to zero,
bringing crane slew to a smooth, controlled stop.
The displayed slew angle range is from zero to 360 degrees, where zero indicates the crane pointing straight
forward relative to the vessel. Angle value increases in right (clockwise) direction. Crane slew is unlimited in
both directions.
Interlocks
The position of the main jib is measured by an angle sensor, with the angle increasing as the jib moves up. Zero
degrees is when the main jib is at its lower end stop. Main jib angle is displayed on the operator’s terminal.
Main jib down movement is stopped if the active winch’s hook stop is reached (indicated by alarms). The active
winch’s wire must then be paid out in order to continue the main jib’s down movement.
Interlocks
5 Operation
32 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
The position of the knuckle jib is measured by an angle sensor, with the angle increasing as the jib swings out.
The angle of the knuckle jib is relative to the main jib. Zero degree is when the knuckle jib is perpendicular to
the main jib. Knuckle jib angle is displayed on the operator’s terminal.
Knuckle jib in movement is stopped if the active winch’s hook stop is reached (indicated by alarms). The active
winch’s wire must then be paid out in order to continue the knuckle jib’s in movement.
Knuckle jib out movement is stopped if the maximum hook load is exceeded.
Interlocks
• Main winch Hook load > 100% of max allowed load and increasing radius
• End stop reached
• Knuckle jib angle encoder error.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 33
User Manual for Crane
6. Derating
6.1. Derating overview
To prevent peak loads and dynamic forces from exceeding a crane’s design limits, it is necessary to restrict hook
load and operating radius in heavy seas (high significant wave height). A calm sea creates little need for
regulating maximum allowed hook load, and a crane can operate at full rated capacity. But rough seas and a
swaying crane subject the crane to considerable dynamic forces, and capacity must be reduced through a
procedure called derating. Each crane is supplied with its own load/derating curves which roughly indicate load
limits relative to radius in defined operating modes:
• Ship to Ship lift – This applies to a pickup or landing point defined by another vessel which is moving
independently. The derated capacity is based on an increase in the dynamic amplification factor
resulting from the higher relative velocities of the jib tip and the other vessel.
• OnBoard / OffBoard – This applies to a pickup or landing point defined inside the vessel, or to
shallow water always in conditions that heave is less than 0.5m.
• Higher forces acting on the crane as a result of increased crane base motion.
• Very high peak loads caused by high relative motion between the jib tip and the sea surface or the load
at rest.
If derating is required, the operator must open the Crane Rating pop-up and select the appropriate lifting mode
and enter the wave height (or dynamic factor). The control system then imposes reduced load/radius limits
automatically. But the load charts are based on analysis of normal operating practices and relevant standards,
and cannot cover all possible crane manoeuvres. The operator is therefore still responsible for careful
assessment, planning and execution of each lift and for a correct response to unforeseen situations.
5 Operation
34 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 35
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
36 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
7. Emergency Procedures
7.1. Emergency Stop
When activated: All HPU pumps will shut down and all crane functions will stop. All valves are de-energized.
Note: An emergency stop will not de-energize all components in the system, and the control system will still be
powered up.
Emergency stop buttons Turn emergency stop button counter clockwise to release.
must be reset Check emergency stop buttons in king (2) and in cabin (1).
Execute start procedure Resetting the emergency stop button will not start the system.
from HMI touch-screen
AOPS is inaccessible when the jib tip is over deck, and is automatically made accessible when the jib tip is over
water.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 37
User Manual for Crane
When the MOPS button is pressed, the winch will pay out wire while the system maintains a retaining force of
approximately 10-20% of maximum rated winch capacity. MOPS works independently of the control system
and is powered by batteries.
Both emergency release functions are inaccessible to winches operating in personnel-lift mode.
When needed, the motor is connected to the ship’s normal or emergency power system by means of a jumper
cable and started from the emergency starter panel on cabinet ES-404 inside the king.
In the event of HPU or power failure, the crane can be operated from the cabin in the normal way using the
control system. If the control system has failed, the crane is operated from the emergency control unit stored
inside the king.
5 Operation
38 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
8. Alarms
8.1. Responsibility of the User
The alarm system is a vital part of the operator’s ability to understand the overall situation, safety information
and environment at all times. Every effort has been made to implement a safe and simple system that presents
all alarms, but which helps the important ones stand out rather than blend in with the range of other alarm
messages.
The alarm system will only work as intended if the user has set it up to give the expected response.
It is important that the crane operator inform other users whenever alarms are acknowledged but not corrected,
or whenever the alarm buzzer is silenced (for trouble-shooting for example), whenever such actions may present
a safety hazard or affect trouble-shooting.
• A new alarm is always displayed in the alarm banner in the top menu bar and in the alarm list. Alarms
are automatically associated with an alarm group for sorting and grouping
• All defined alarms require operator acknowledgement
• If an alarm is acknowledged and the alarm condition resolved, the alarm message will automatically be
removed from the display
• If an alarm condition is resolved (returned alarm), but the alarm is not acknowledged, the alarm
message will turn green and remain showing until acknowledged by the operator
When an inappropriate condition exists for a preset amount of time, an alarm is generated in the PLC CPU and
stored in temporary memory. The HMI continuously reads the memory, grouping and sorting alarms according
to the crane systems (main winch, whip winch etc.) The HMI time-stamps the alarms and displays any new
alarm in both the alarm banner and in the alarms list (the most recent unacknowledged alarm is always
displayed on the alarm banner).
The alarm display will be continuously updated with new incoming and returned alarms. All alarms are logged
for two weeks within the control system (newer systems).
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 39
User Manual for Crane
• A red frame around the shortcut button indicates an active (standing) alarm within the alarm group
• A blinking red frame indicates a new (and not acknowledged) alarm within the alarm group
Clicking on an alarm group shortcut will open the alarms page with the alarms for that group sorted by date and
time.
Note that the Status Banner is further described in other parts of the user manual.
8.3.3. General
Alarms are sorted by date and time according to when they were read by the operator terminal system. They are
always displayed with the most recent on top. Thus, as alarms are acknowledged, the display goes backward
through the list (newest to oldest).
The user may acknowledge alarms with the dedicated Alarm Acknowledge button in the left joystick, or via the
buttons on the alarms screen.
To list all alarms, the operator can call up a separate alarms screen via the alarm button on the main menu. On
the alarms screen, the alarms list presents alarms according to the alarm query setting. The most recent alarm is
always shown on top. Alarms are displayed in rows with alarm information in columns as follows:
• "Date" is when the alarm was received and stamped by the control system
• "Time" is the time the alarm was received and stamped by the control system
• "Priority" shows alarm priority - however this feature is irrelevant to crane operation
• "Group" defines the alarm group the alarm is associated with. Groups are as follows:
HPU Hydraulic power unit alarms
CR Crane alarms
MW Main winch alarms
AHC Active heave compensation alarms
MISC Miscellaneous alarms
• "Name" is the actual name used by the control system for the alarm. This will usually correspond to the
tag name used by the PLC
• "Comment" shows the alarm description
• "Value" shows the status of the alarm when it was received
5 Operation
40 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
The alarm status screen shown above is accessed by pressing "Alarm" from the "Menu" button.
• Alarm Status: the current alarm situation is displayed. Only non-acknowledged alarms (whether they
are standing or returned) are listed. Alarms are sorted by time
• Alarm History: all alarms (since the last HMI reboot) for the selected group are displayed. The list is
sorted by time
The active display mode is shown in the upper left corner of the alarm display. Alarm status is the default view.
The "New Query" button allows the operator to filter alarms in greater detail. This function is described in
greater detail later in this section.
The "Long Term History" button allows access to a list of all alarms from the past 2 weeks (can be filtered by
date/time, but not sorted) as seen in the following image.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 41
User Manual for Crane
This screen shows the alarm history displayed in "Long Term History" mode. Here, the operator is able to
display alarms from the following periods:
• Last 15 minutes
• Last hour
• Last day
• Last week
• Last 2 weeks
5 Operation
42 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
From the alarm display, alarms can be acknowledged individually or by groups. To acknowledge an alarm, click
on the alarm in the display. Press and hold on the touch screen, and repeat to select several alarms. Click “Ack
Selected” to acknowledge the selected alarm/s, or click “Ack ALL” to acknowledge all alarms in the alarm
group.
The alarm system is divided into simple, intuitive alarm groups. Each of these groups typically pertains to a
part or aspect of the crane. Each alarm group may consist of further subgroups which are available by selecting
and performing a new alarm query. The alarm display shows alarms for selected alarm groups according to the
last alarm query.
• Click on the group symbol in the status banner. The alarm status display will appear with an alarm
query for the selected group
• In the alarm status display a new alarm query can be selected with the “New Query” button. A menu for
the query selection will appear
Click on “Alarm Query” to bring up the alarm query popup which will appear over the lower buttons in the
alarm display.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 43
User Manual for Crane
The following list presents the main operational alarms of the system. The alarms are presented with Tag info,
alarm text, alarm group and alarm description.
General system
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
2.0 CR_EmergencySto Emergency Stop CR Any emergency stop activated
p Activated
2.1 CR_EmergencySto Emergency stop CR Emergency stop activated –ES400
p_S0 on/off
2.2 CR_EmergencySto Emergency stop CR Emergency stop activated –ES404
p_S04 on/off
2.3 CR_ServiceMode Emergency Stop - CR Service mode switch activated – crane lock out
Service Mode
2.4 CR_IntLockOverrid Interlock Override CR Interlock button override – all interlocks disabled
e_STA
2.5 CR_JS_Right_X_E Joystick Right - CR Error with joystick directional switch or
RR Switch Error X Axis potentiometer. Calibration needed.
2.6 CR_JS_Right_Y_E Joystick Right - CR Error with joystick directional switch or
RR Switch Error Y Axis potentiometer. Calibration needed.
2.7 CR_JS_Right_ERR Right Joystick error - COM Right Joystick - Profibus communication error
DP19
2.8 CR_JS_Left_X_ER Joystick Left - CR Error with joystick directional switch or
R Switch Error X Axis potentiometer. Calibration needed.
5 Operation
44 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
2.18 CR_MOPS_Battery MOPS Battery NOT CR MOPS Battery NOT ready
_Fault2 ready
2.19 CR_MOPS_Battery MOPS Battery < CR MOPS Battery < 85% charged
_LOW 85% charged
2.20 MISC_RollAngle_ Roll Angle High MISC MRU roll ≥ 6,0 degree.
H
2.21 MISC_MRU_ERR MRU - Signal Error MISC MRU error – analog outputs from MRU not OK.
2.22 IC300_ERR CC-300 - Remote IO COM CC-300 – Profibus communication error
Error - DP3
2.23 IC400_ERR ES-400 - Remote IO COM ES-400 - Profibus communication error
Error - DP4
2.24 Encoder_MW_ERR Main Winch Encoder COM Main Winch Encoder - Profibus communication
IO Error - DP11 error
2.25 Encoder_MJ_A_ER Main Jib Encoder A COM Main Jib Encoder A Profibus communication error
R IO Error - DP13
2.26 Encoder_MJ_B_ER Main Jib Encoder B COM Main Jib Encoder B - Profibus communication error
R IO Error - DP14
2.27 Encoder_WW_ER Whip Winch Encoder COM Whip Winch Encoder - Profibus communication
R IO Error - DP12 error
2.28 Encoder_KJ_A_ER Knuckle Jib Encoder COM Knuckle Jib Encoder - Profibus communication
R A IO Error - DP16 error
2.29 Encoder_KJ_B_ER Knuckle Jib Encoder COM Knuckle Jib Encoder - Profibus communication
R B IO Error - DP17 error
2.30 Encoder_Slew_ER Slew Encoder IO COM Slew Encoder - Profibus communication error
R Error - DP10
2.31 Encoder_WW_Spo Whip Winch COM Whip Winc Spooling Encoder - Profibus
olPos_ERR Spooling Encoder IO communication error
Error - DP15
2.32 CR_OverloadM55 Grease Pump M55 CR Grease Pump M55 for crane functions is overloaded
overloaded and not moving
2.33 CR_GreasePumpM Grease Pump M55 CR Grease pump for crane functions disabled.
55Disabled disabled
2.34 CR_OverloadM56 Grease Pump M56 CR Grease Pump M56 for Main Winch is overloaded
overloaded and not moving
2.35 CR_GreasePumpM Grease Pump M56 CR Grease pump for Main Winch disabled.
56Disabled disabled
2.36 CR_LubeMon1NoF No grease flow - CR No grease flow detected by the lubrication monitor 1
lowM55 Lubrication Monitor on –M55
1 on -M55
2.37 CR_LubeMon2NoF No grease flow - CR No grease flow detected by the lubrication monitor 2
lowM55 Lubrication Monitor on –M55
2 on -M55
2.38 CR_LubeMon3NoF No grease flow - CR No grease flow detected by the lubrication monitor3
lowM56 Lubrication Monitor on –M56
3 on -M56
2.39 Software_ERR Software error CR Error in PLC software
2.40 Module_ERR I/O-Access error CR PLC I/O access error
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 45
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
3.0 HPU_TankLevel_ERR HPU Reservoir Level HPU Cable break or faulty sensor.
- Signal Error
3.1 HPU_Tank1LevelSwitc Oil Tank 1 Level HPU HPU oil level sensor fault. Cable break or faulty
h_ERR Switch - Sensor Fault sensor.
3.2 HPU_TankLevel_L HPU Reservoir Level HPU HPU oil tank level less than 55 %
- Low Alarm
3.3 HPU_TankLevel_LL HPU Reservoir Level HPU HPU oil tank level less than 50 %
- Low Low Alarm
3.4 HPU_TankLevel_H HPU Reservoir Level HPU HPU oil tank level above 95 %
- High Alarm
3.5 HPU_TankLevel_HH HPU Reservoir Level HPU HPU oil tank level above 100 %
- High High Alarm
3.6 HPU_Tank1TempSwitc Oil Tank 1 HPU HPU oil temperature sensor fault. Cable break or
h_ERR Temperature Switch - faulty sensor.
Sensor Fault
3.7 HPU_TankTemp_H HPU Tank HPU HPU reservoir - high temperature
Temperature - High
Alarm
3.8 HPU_TankTemp_HH HPU Tank HPU HPU reservoir - high high temperature
Temperature - High
High Alarm
3.9 HPU_MP1_TRP HPU M1 - Main HPU Motor start/stop tripped
Pump 1 - Tripped
3.10 HPU_MP2_TRP HPU M2 - Main HPU Motor start/stop tripped
Pump 2 - Tripped
3.11 HPU_MP3_TRP HPU M3 - Main HPU Motor start/stop tripped
Pump 3 - Tripped
3.12 HPU_MP4_TRP HPU M4 - Main HPU Motor start/stop tripped
Pump 4 - Tripped
3.13 HPU_CircPump_TRP HPU M10 - Circ HPU Motor start/stop tripped
Pump - Tripped
3.14 HPU_CJCPump_TRP HPU M11 - CJC HPU Motor start/stop tripped
Pump - Tripped
3.15 HPU_Cooler1_TRP HPU M20 - Cooler 1 HPU Motor start/stop tripped
- Tripped
3.16 HPU_Cooler2_TRP HPU M21 - Cooler 2 HPU Motor start/stop tripped
- Tripped
3.17 HPU_Cooler3_TRP HPU M22 - Cooler 3 HPU Motor start/stop tripped
- Tripped
3.18 HPU_Cooler4_TRP HPU M23 - Cooler 4 HPU Motor start/stop tripped
- Tripped
3.19 HPU_Cooler5_TRP HPU M24 - Cooler 5 HPU Motor start/stop tripped
- Tripped
3.20 HPU_Cooler6_TRP HPU M25 - Cooler 6 HPU Motor start/stop tripped
- Tripped
3.21 HPU_Cooler7_TRP HPU M26 - Cooler 7 HPU Motor start/stop tripped
- Tripped
3.22 HPU_EmPump_TRP Emergency Pump HPU Motor start/stop tripped
M31 tripped
3.23 HPU_CoolingFan_TRP HPU M61 - Cooling HPU Motor start/stop tripped
Fan - Tripped
5 Operation
46 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
3.24 HPU_MP1_PowerMissi Main Pump 1 - HPU Main motors, power missing. Check supply and
ng Power Missing fuses.
3.25 HPU_MP2_PowerMissi Main Pump 2 - HPU Main motors, power missing. Check supply and
ng Power Missing fuses.
3.26 HPU_MP3_PowerMissi Main Pump 3 - HPU Main motors, power missing. Check supply and
ng Power Missing fuses.
3.27 HPU_MP4_PowerMissi Main Pump 4 - HPU Main motors, power missing. Check supply and
ng Power Missing fuses.
3.28 HPU_Circ_PowerMissi Circulation Pump - HPU Circulation Pump power missing. Check supply
ng Power Missing and fuses.
3.29 HPU_CJC_PowerMissi CJC Pumps - Power HPU CJC Pump power missing. Check supply and
ng Missing fuses.
3.30 HPU_Cooler1_PowerMi Cooler 1 - Power HPU Cooler motor power missing. Check supply and
ssing Missing fuses.
3.31 HPU_Cooler2_PowerMi Cooler 2 - Power HPU Cooler motor power missing. Check supply and
ssing Missing fuses.
3.32 HPU_Cooler3_PowerMi Cooler 3 - Power HPU Cooler motor power missing. Check supply and
ssing Missing fuses.
3.33 HPU_Cooler4_PowerMi Cooler 4 - Power HPU Cooler motor power missing. Check supply and
ssing Missing fuses.
3.34 HPU_Cooler5_PowerMi Cooler 5 - Power HPU Cooler motor power missing. Check supply and
ssing Missing fuses.
3.35 HPU_Cooler6_PowerMi Cooler 6 - Power HPU Cooler motor power missing. Check supply and
ssing Missing fuses.
3.36 HPU_Cooler7_PowerMi Cooler 7 - Power HPU Cooler motor power missing. Check supply and
ssing Missing fuses.
3.37 HPU_DrainFilter Main pump drain HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
filter pressure switch
3.38 HPU_WinchDrainFilter Winch motor Drain HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
Filter
3.39 HPU_ReturnFilter1 Return filter 1 HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.40 HPU_ReturnFilter2 Return filter 2 HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.41 HPU_ReturnFilter3 Return filter 3 HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.42 HPU_ReturnFilter4 Return filter 4 HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.43 HPU_CJCFilter CJC Filter pressure HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
switch
3.44 HPU_MainFilter1A Main filter 1A HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.45 HPU_MainFilter1B Main filter 1B HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.46 HPU_MainFilter2 Main filter 2 pressure HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
switch
3.47 HPU_MainFilter2 Main filter 2 pressure HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
switch
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 47
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
3.48 HPU_MainFilter3 Main filter 3 pressure HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
switch
3.49 HPU_MainFilter3B Main filter 3B HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.50 HPU_MainFilter4 Main filter 4 pressure HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
switch
3.51 HPU_MainFilter4B Main filter 4B HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.52 HPU_KingDrainFilter Slew / Tugger Drain HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
Filter
3.53 HPU_OilRecoveryFilter Oil Recovery Filter HPU Clogged oil filter. Replace filter element.
pressure switch
3.54 HPU_DrainTankLevel_ Level switch oil drain HPU Oil leakage detected in drain tank/king.
H tank
3.55 HPU_MainPress_L Main Pressure - Low HPU Main pressure below 50 bar.
Alarm
3.56 HPU_MainPress_H Main Pressure - High HPU Main pressure above 350 bar.
Alarm
3.57 HPU_EmPump_RUN Emergency Pump HPU Emergency pump running.
M31
3.58 HPU_LS_Press_A_ERR LS pressure A HPU Cable break or faulty sensor.
(PT219A) - Sensor
Fault
3.59 HPU_LS_Press_B_ERR LS pressure B - HPU Cable break or faulty sensor.
Sensor Fault
3.60 HPU_LS_Press_DEV LS pressure - HPU Deviation between sensor A and B.
Deviation Error
3.61 CR_PowerReqM1_Faile Power request for M1 HPU Request sent from crane to ship’s PMS but no
d failed confirmation within 90 seconds.
3.62 CR_PowerReqM2_Faile Power request for M2 HPU Request sent from crane to ship’s PMS but no
d failed confirmation within 90 seconds.
3.63 CR_PowerReqM3_Faile Power request for M3 HPU Request sent from crane to ship’s PMS but no
d failed confirmation within 90 seconds.
3.64 CR_PowerReqM4_Faile Power request for M4 HPU Request sent from crane to ship’s PMS but no
d failed confirmation within 90 seconds.
3.65 HPU_MainPress_ERR Main Pressure - HPU Cable break or faulty sensor.
Signal Error
3.66 HPU_AuxSupEarthFault Aux Supply (230V) - HPU Earth fault detected on 230V supply to control
Earth Fault system.
3.67 HPU_MainSup1EarthFa Main Supply 1 (A) - HPU Earth fault detected on 690V main supply 1.
ult Earth Fault
3.68 HPU_MainSup2EarthFa Main Supply 2 (B) - HPU Earth fault detected on 690V main supply 2.
ult Earth Fault
3.69 HPU_MainSup3EarthFa Main Supply 3 (C) - HPU Earth fault detected on 690V main supply 3.
ult Earth Fault
3.70 HPU_MainSup4EarthFa Main Supply 4 (D) - HPU Earth fault detected on 690V main supply 4.
ult Earth Fault
3.71 HPU_TankTemp_ERR HPU Tank HPU Cable break or faulty temperature sensor.
Temperature - Signal (TT201)
Error
5 Operation
48 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
3.72 HPU_TankTemp_L HPU Tank HPU HPU tank temperature below 10 degrees Celsius.
Temperature Too Main pumps start inhibited to prevent damage.
Low To Start Main
Pumps
Slew system
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
4.0 CR_SlewAccuPress_ Slew accu. pressure - CR Cable break or faulty sensor.
ERR Sensor Fault
4.1 CR_SlewPosDeviatio Slew Position CR Measured slew position deviates from preset slew
n Deviation position
Jib system
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
5.0 CR_MainJibMoving_ Main Jib Moving CR Main jib moving without joystick command.
ERR Error
5.1 CR_MJ_Enc_DEV Main Jib Encoders - CR Deviation between sensor A and B.
Deviation Error
5.2 CR_KJ_Enc_DEV Knuckle Jib Encoders CR Deviation between sensor A and B.
- Deviation Error
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 49
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
6.0 WW_Load_H Whip Winch Load > WW Whip winch load > 90% of allowed load.
90%
6.1 WW_Load_HH Whip Winch Load > WW Whip winch load > 110% of allowed load.
110%
6.2 WW_Load_HHH Whip Winch Load > WW Whip winch load > 125% of allowed load.
125%
6.3 WW_LoadCell_DEV Whip Winch Load WW Deviation between WW load cell channels.
Cell - Deviation
Error
6.4 WW_AOPS_ERR Whip Winch AOPS - WW AOPS disabled due to deviation between WW load
Disabled Due To cell channels.
Sensor Fault
6.5 WW_AOPS Whip Winch AOPS - WW WW AOPS activated by control system.
Active
6.6 WW_MOPS Whip Winch MOPS - WW WW MOPS activated by operator.
Active
6.7 WW_HookStop Whip Winch Hook WW WW hook stop activated either by mechanical hook
Stop stop sensor or by the hook position measurement.
6.8 WW_MechanicalHoo Whip Winch WW WW hook stop activated by mechanical hook stop
kStop Mechanical Hook sensors.
Stop
6.9 WW_HookPos_H Whip Winch Position WW WW hook position close to lower hook stop (end
High stop).
6.10 WW_LowerHookSto Whip Winch Lower WW WW lower hook stop active (end stop).
p Hook Stop
6.13 WW_PersonnelLift_ Load Too High To WW Load too high to activate personnel lift.
NAvail Activate Personnel
Lift
6.14 WW_BrakeOff WW Brake Off - WW Whip winch brake off without joystick command.
Alarm
6.16 WW_AHC_PosDev_ WW AHC Position AHC Position deviation more than 0.5 meters of hook
H Deviation High relative to the seabed in AHC.
6.17 WW_AHC_PosDev_ WW AHC Position AHC Position deviation more than 1.5 meters of hook
HH Deviation High High relative to the seabed in AHC.
5 Operation
50 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
6.18 WW_MOPS_AccuPr Whipline Winch AHC Cable break or faulty sensor.
ess_ERR MOPS Accumulator
Pressure - Signal
Error
6.19 WW_AHC_ControlV WW AHC Control AHC Deviation between commanded and read signal.
alve_DEV Valve Deviation
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 51
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
7.0 MW_Load_H Main Winch Load > MW Main winch load > 90% of allowed load.
90%
7.1 MW_Load_HH Main Winch Load > MW Main winch load > 110% of allowed load.
110%
7.2 MW_Load_HHH Main Winch Load > MW Main winch load > 125% of allowed load.
125%
7.3 MW_LoadCell_DEV Main Winch Load MW Deviation between MW load cell channels.
Cell - Deviation Error
7.6 MW_AOPS_ERR Main Winch AOPS - MW AOPS disabled due to deviation between MW load
Disabled Due To cell channels.
Sensor Fault
7.10 MW_MechanicalHoo Main Winch MW MW hook stop activated by the mechanical hook
kStop Mechanical Hook stop sensors
Stop
7.11 MW_HookPos_H Main Winch Position MW MW hook position close to lower hook stop (end
High stop).
7.12 MW_LowerHookSto Main Winch Lower MW MW lower hook stop active (end stop).
p Hook Stop
7.13 MW_HookStop_ER Main Winch Hook MW Only signal from one of the proximity switches in
R Stop - Sensor Fault the mechanical hook stop sensor.
7.14 MW_Speed_H Main Winch Speed - MW MW hook speed higher than specified.
High Alarm
52 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
Alarm
7.16 MW_MOPS_AccuPr Main Winch MOPS MW MW MOPS accumulator pressure 2 LOW.
ess2_L Accumulator
Pressure 2- Low
Alarm
7.17 MW_PersonnelLift_ Personnel Lift active MW MW personnel lift activated by key switch.
Active (Recovery Mode)
7.18 MW_PersonnelLift_ Wrong mode or Load MW Wrong mode or Load too high to activate personnel
NAvail Too High To lift.
Activate Personnel
Lift
7.19 MW_BrakeOff Main Winch Brake MW MW brake off without joystick command.
OFF Alarm
7.20 AHC_WrongMode AHC - Wrong Mode AHC Load too high for AHC/AT High Speed Mode.
According To Load Switch to AHC/AT Normal Mode.
7.21 AHC_HeaveVelocity Heave Velocity > 2,0 AHC True heave velocity in crane tip higher than 2 m/s or
_H m/s (120 m/min) 1m/s in double part.
7.22 AHC_PosDev_H AHC Position AHC AHC position deviation. More than 0,5 meters
Deviation High deviation between hook and set point relative to the
seabed.
7.23 AHC_PosDev_HH AHC Position AHC AHC position deviation. More than 1,5 meters
Deviation High High deviation between hook and set point relative to the
seabed.
7.24 MW_AHC_ControlV Main AHC Control AHC Deviation between commanded and read signal.
alve1_DEV Valve 1 - Deviation
Error
7.25 MW_AHC_ControlV Main AHC Control AHC Deviation between commanded and read signal.
alve2_DEV Valve 2 - Deviation
Error
7.26 MW_AHC_ControlV Main AHC Control AHC Deviation between commanded and read signal.
alve3_DEV Valve 3 - Deviation
Error
7.27 MW_AHC_ControlV Main AHC Control AHC Deviation between commanded and read signal.
alve4_DEV Valve 4 - Deviation
Error
7.28 MW_MOPS_AccuPr Main Winch MOPS AHC Cable break or faulty sensor.
ess1_ERR Accumulator
Pressure 1 - Signal
Error
7.29 MW_MOPS_AccuPr Main Winch MOPS AHC Cable break or faulty sensor.
ess2_ERR Accumulator
Pressure 2 - Signal
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 53
User Manual for Crane
Item TAG info (HMI) Alarm text (HMI) Group Alarm description
(HMI)
Error
7.30 MW_BrakePress1_E Main Winch Brake MW Cable break or faulty sensor.
RR Pressure 1 - Signal
Error
7.31 MW_BrakePress2_E Main Winch Brake MW Cable break or faulty sensor.
RR Pressure 2 - Signal
Error
7.32 MW_DoublePartDet Main Winch Double MW Double part sensor active but mode not selected.
Part Detected (not
selected)
7.33 MW_DoublePartSel Main Winch Double MW Double part selected but not detected by double part
Part Selected (not proximity switch.
detected)
7.34 MW_MotorDisp1_D Main Winch Motor MW Deviation between commanded and read signal.
EV Disp. 1 - Deviation
Error
7.35 MW_MotorDisp2_D Main Winch Motor MW Deviation between commanded and read signal.
EV Disp. 2 - Deviation
Error
7.36 MW_MotorDispPres Main Winch Motor MW Deviation between sensor A and B.
s_DEV Disp. Pressure
Sensors - Deviation
+CC100
7.37 MW_MotorDispPres Main Winch Motor MW Cable break or faulty sensor.
s1_ERR Disp. Pressure 1 -
Signal Error
7.38 MW_MotorDispPres Main Winch Motor MW Cable break or faulty sensor.
s2_ERR Disp. Pressure 2 -
Signal Error
7.39 MW_AHC_Stopped AHC stop condition AHC AHC stop conditions:
active on Main Emergency stop active, NOT MW On selected, no
Winch main pumps running, MOPS/AOPS active, hook
pos < 5 meters, AHC deviation > 1,5 meters, MRU
error or load cell sensor error (only in AT).
AHC/AT has to be enabled to generate this alarm.
7.40 AHC_MW_ModeSpe AHC Main Winch Speed too high for normal AHC/AT mode. Select
ed_H Mode – High Speed High Speed Mode.
7.41 AHC_MainPress_L AHC - Main Pressure MW Main pressure below 220 bar.
Low
7.42 MW_OutsideWorkin Main Winch outside MW Main Winch outside working area
gArea working area
5 Operation
54 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
The Trend display can show both real time and historical data, and can show up to 6 simultaneous plots.
2
1
Display functions
The large trend chart (1) shows historical or real-time trends colour-coded for the various parameters that may
be displayed.
To select a parameter for display, click inside the trend chart. The Historical Trend Setup popup now opens
(next page, bottom), displaying a list of parameters and a range of fields for defining the chart.
The left side of the chart shows the chart’s vertical scale (2) (in either metric or oilfield units), and the top shows
the time scale.
At the bottom of the display, trend-related controls enable the user to set range, zoom and other chart properties.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 55
User Manual for Crane
Mode It is possible to show both real-time data and historical data. The historical data is
stored in the computer for 28 days.
While in real time, the right side of the trend is always ‘now’. In historic mode, the
right side of the trend is not necessarily ‘now’.
Pan time Pan time is only available in Historical Mode. It is used to pan forward or backward in
time to display the desired time period.
Vertical range The vertical scale (2) is actually a bar graph showing the magnitude of the selected
parameter. The colour of the scale lines indicates which parameter it applies to.
Horizontal range The standard horizontal range is 30 minutes, but this can be changed with the “Zoom
Time” buttons.
Zoom Time (Zoom The horizontal scale is adjusted using the “Zoom Time” buttons. This is a real-time
horizontal) trend factor that can be scaled from one second up to approximately 20 hours.
5 Operation
56 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2 5
1. Information button to access a screen showing details regarding the Profibus network.
2. Information button to access a screen showing details regarding Digital Inputs and Outputs to the PLC
system.
3. Information button to access a screen showing details regarding Analogue Inputs and Outputs to the
PLC system.
4. Radio buttons used for globally changing the units between Metric and Oilfield. (If implemented – this
may be an option)
5. Button for setting and resetting the Main Interlock override function. When activated, the button turns
yellow, and the IntLock Override icon in the status banner at the top of the screen is activated.
Note: When interlock override is active, all safety features in the crane and control system are
deactivated. We recommend that a report is prepared stating the reason for activating this function each
time it is used.
6. Counter for the Interlock override, increases by one each time the override function is activated.
7. Buttons for turning jib floodlights and other lights on. These buttons turn yellow when the lights are on.
8. Activation button for operating the remote control. Button will turn yellow while remote control is
active.
9. Hour counter
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 57
User Manual for Crane
If a node on the network is not communicating with the PLC, this is indicated by a red light. When the node is
“healthy” and connected, the light is green.
5 Operation
58 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
The menu is password protected, so only authorized personel can enter the menu. Password is 1000.
1. Radio buttons for selecting which of each set of dual sensors is used as system reference. Analogue
information fields to the right display reference and realtime values.
2. Menu buttons to access encoder, lubrication and joystick calibration, setup and reset screens.
3. Button for shutting down front screen HMI software application.
4. Button for reinitializing I/O values.
5. Button for starting uninitiated I/O conversations.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 59
User Manual for Crane
It is of utmost importance to follow the directions below when resetting encoders or position measuring devices.
Incorrect position settings can cause serious damage or personal injury. The interlock override may be used if
neccesary to reach the required reset position.
With the device in the desired position, press the relevant S button on the encoder reset screen (below) to reset
the device’s “null point”.
Encoder Instructions
Main winch position Place hook in desired upper position (about 1.5 metres from sheaves), knuckle jib
fully in, main jib fully down, when resetting main winch position encoder.
Whip winch position Place hook in desired upper position (about 1.5 meter from sheaves), knuckle jib
fully in, main jib fully down, when resetting whip winch position encoder.
Slew angle The crane must be parked, with the knuckle jib resting in the parking cradle.
Knuckle Jib angle The knuckle jib encoders are to be reset with the knuckle jib folded all the way in.
Main Jib angle The main jib encoders are to be reset with the main jib lowered completely.
5 Operation
60 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2 3
1. Indicators for whether or not the direction switches for the joystick axes are active.
2. Potentiometer X axis force reading.
3. Potentiometer Y axis force reading.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 61
User Manual for Crane
14. Troubleshooting
Although the Control System is designed for a long and trouble-free service life, problems may occur with the
equipment.
Trouble-shooting then becomes necessary. Technicians must have drawings, descriptions and component data
sheets as their primary aids. These will normally be sufficient for 90% of the problems occurring on systems
that have been operative for some time.
By experience, the PLC system, software and input/output modules are very rarely the cause of failure!
Note that all software changes should be done subsequent to filling out a Software Change Request form
(contact MacGregor service for request form). This is required to ensure that all parties have an updated base of
system features, as well as to ensure that the built-in safety and functions are not jeopardised.
For detailed information on the components used, refer to the component data sheet section of this manual.
5 Operation
62 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
What to do Select “Setup” from the menu sidebar on the touch screen terminal. The setup menu is
password protected.
Password: 1000.
Press S next to Slew Angle sensor, then R (Reset) in the Slew Angle popup.\
Comments The AOPS system will not be operational if the crane slew angle is not initialised.
What to do Select Setup from the menu sidebar on the touch-screen terminal. The Setup menu is
password-protected.
Password: 1000.
Park the crane and run the main winch hook to the correct hook-stop position relative
to the jib tip.
Press S next to Main/Whip Winch Hook Position, then R (Reset) in the popup.
Comments It is not possible to run the hook past the position set when the winch was last
initialised. To set a new “final hook-stop” the PLC has to be restarted.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 63
User Manual for Crane
What to do Select Setup from the menu sidebar on the touch-screen terminal. This menu is
password protected.
Password: 1000.
Lower the Main Jib until it reaches its mechanical end stop.
Comments An incorrect setting on this encoder will affect hook load calculations, winch position
calculations and the AOPS system.
What to do Select Setup from the menu sidebar on the touch-screen terminal. This menu is
password protected.
Password: 1000.
Retract the knuckle jib until it reaches its mechanical end stop.
Comments An incorrect setting on this encoder will affect hook load calculations, winch position
calculations and the AOPS system.
5 Operation
64 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
LED Meaning
SF DC5V FRCE RUN STOP
D D D D D CPU power supply missing
D L X D L CPU is in STOP mode
Start the CPU
L L X D L CPU is in STOP mode as result of error
X L X D F CPU requesting memory reset
(0,5Hz)
X L X D F CPU executing memory reset
(2Hz)
X L X F L CPU is in startup mode
(2 Hz)
X L X F L CPU was halted by a programmed break point
(0,5Hz
L L X X X Hardware or software error
X X L X X User enabled the force function
X X F X X Node flashing test was activated
(2 Hz)
F F F F F CPU has an internal system error.
Proceed is as follows:
Set mode selector switch to STOP
Perform POWER ON/OFF
Read diagnostics buffer, see STEP 7
Contact your local SIEMENS partner
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 65
User Manual for Crane
LED Meaning
SF 5VDC BF BF1 BF2
5 Operation
66 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 67
User Manual for Crane
Fault Description
SF Some i/o modules have the ability to indicate group-error.
Remedy: check fuses and/or replace module (when power is switched off).
5 Operation
68 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Fault Description
SF Some i/o modules have the ability to indicate group-error.
Remedy: check fuses and/or replace module (when power is switched off).
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 69
User Manual for Crane
5 Operation
70 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
17.4. PLCs
PLC modules may only be replaced by modules with the exact same part number. The part number is printed on
the lower left corner of the module front. If another PLC module is to be used, it may only be replaced by
qualified MacGregor Marine Service personnel.
Note that all accumulated data is stored in the Micro Memory Card on the PLC module so no data will be lost.
This may include data such as motor run time, wire usage and similar integrated information.
1. Hook the new module of the same type on and swivel it downward.
2. Screw the module on.
3. Connect all connectors.
4. Set the PLC mode switch to STOP.
5. Insert the micro memory card.
6. Set the power supply module’s Standby switch up (output voltages at rated values).
7. Set the PLC mode switch to RUN.
8. Close the cover.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 71
User Manual for Crane
1. You cannot replace analogue and digital modules while in RUN mode. Therefore, switch the Standby
switch on the power supply down.
2. Loosen the front connector’s mounting screw and pull it off.
3. Loosen the module mounting screw.
4. Swivel the module out.
Before fitting the front connector, you must remove (break off) the front part of the coding key, because this
part is already fitted in the wired front connector.
If, for example, you insert a front connector for a digital module in an analogue module, the module may be
damaged.
Modules are only to be operated with their complete front connector-coding key.
1. For analogue modules make sure that the measurement type-coding key on the side of the new module
matches that of the old module. If in doubt refer to the loop diagrams for further information.
2. Hook the new module of the same type on at the appropriate slot and swivel it downward.
3. Screw the module on with the mounting screw.
4. Fit the front connector.
5. Switch the power supply Standby switch up.
6. After fitting, each programmable module will be reinitialised by the PLC with parameters.
1. Set the power supply Standby switch down and switch off all load power supplies for the module.
2. Loosen the front connector screw and pull it off.
3. Remove the labels from the front connector and insert them into the new front connector.
4. Wire the new front connector.
5. Insert the front connector in the module.
6. Screw the front connector on.
7. Switch on the load voltage and set the power supply Standby switch up.
5 Operation
72 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Winches with AHC/AT mode, and winches with Constant Tension (CT) mode and >1000
metres of hook travel are also fitted with mechanical hook stops.
5 Operation
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 73
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
5 Operation
74 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
EMERGENCY Project: SP2552-2.
OPERATION Page 1 of 2.
PROCEDURE PART 1:
1. Main power supply Normal operation. Emergency operation from cabin with
(440 V), FAULT emergency pump.
2. PLC &230 Voltage
supply, RUNNING/OK
A. CONNECT THE MAIN
EMERGENCY POWER
SUPPLY CABLE
Jumper cable to be
connected to RED
Socket in cabinet
ECC1.
B. CONTROL CABINET
ES400
Switch to emergency
mode on.
C. OPEN SUCTION
VALVE FOR
EMERGENCY PUMP
( MH 03.2)
IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT
THIS VALVE IS OPEN, AT ALL
TIME.
D. OPEN EMERGENCY
PUMP “SUPPLY”
SHUT OFF VALVE FOR
EMERGENCY
OPERATION OF
CRANE FUNCTIONS
( MH60)
E. OPEN EMERGENCY
PUMP “LS” SHUT OFF
VALVE FOR
EMERGENCY
OPERATION OF
CRANE FUNCTIONS
( MH63.2 )
H. START EMERGENCY
PUMP FROM
OPERATOR SCREEN.
Operate crane from
cabin.
EMERGENCY OPERATION Project: SP2552-2.
PROCEDURE PART 2: Page 1 of 2.
1. Main power supply (440 V), Normal operation. Emergency operation with emergency
FAULT panel and pump.
2. PLC &230 Voltage supply,
FAULT
A. CONNECT THE MAIN
EMERGENCY POWER SUPPLY
CABLE
Jumper cable to be connected to
RED Socket in cabinet ECC1.
CONNECT EMERGENCY PANEL OP-
206 CABLE
A. ACTIVATE EMERGENCY
PANEL
6 Maintenance
Table of Contents
1. General Maintenance Instructions ....................................................................................................1
2. General Inspection Instructions ........................................................................................................2
3. Periodic Maintenance.......................................................................................................................4
3.1. Interpreting the Periodic Maintenance Program Matrix ..............................................................5
3.2. Maintenance Program ...............................................................................................................6
4. MOPS Function Test ......................................................................................................................15
5. Annexes .........................................................................................................................................16
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 1
User Manual for Crane
• Prevent accidents and maintain safe operation of your MacGregor equipment through inspections and
operator training.
• Avoid unnecessary interruptions in up-time.
• Ensure peak efficiency throughout your crane's long life.
• Address potential problems before they become more costly or inconvenient.
• Reduce overhead costs associated with parts, lubricants and tools.
• Reduce downtime by scheduling when production will not be interrupted.
In addition to the periodic maintenance program, it is recommended to perform daily / pre-start inspections:
• Visual check for hydraulic oil leaks on the crane, both internal and external.
• Visual check of the hydraulic reservoir fluid level.
• Visual check of the oil coolers.
• Visual check of the aircraft warning light as required.
• Visual check of the crane hook latch.
• Visual check of wire sheaves and spooling.
• Visual check of wire rope for evident deterioration and damage or improper reeving.
• Visually check for loose, missing or corroded bolts, pins, keepers or locking wire.
• Visually check loose gear to be used, such as slings, sling hooks and shackles.
• Ensure the correct load-rating chart for the configuration in use is visible to the crane operator.
• Perform a “walk-around” visual examination of the crane structure to ensure that no damage exists.
• Visually check that the crane can rotate freely in its working area.
• Verify mechanical hook function.
• Check control system alarm log.
• Lubricate components and correct deficiencies as required based on the results of these inspections.
National and recertification requirements by classification bodies like: DnV, Lloyds Register of Shipping,
Germanischer Lloyd, Bureau Veritas and American Bureau of Shipping include yearly and five yearly safety
inspections and retesting. These inspections have to be made by the original equipment manufacturer (OEM) or
OEM certified service companies.
Inspections on your advanced MacGregor Active Heave Compensated Offshore Cranes produce neutral reports
on equipment condition and provide recommendations for necessary actions when required. The main purpose
of an inspection is to assess and maintain the condition of the equipment. Our experience and high standards of
design and manufacturing of your advanced crane is the basis for all inspections.
A proactive approach can help to avoid catastrophic breakdowns, downtime and off hire situations. MacGregor,
the original equipment manufacturer (OEM), have the resources of personnel that provide the skill and
experience necessary to guide a proactive approach, helping you as our customer to focus on and to predict the
most effective maintenance needs.
6 Maintenance
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
The inspection of advanced cranes rely on equipment specific inspection programs, where MacGregor advanced
cranes are looked at not only with respect to mandatory standards but also to specified technical and operational
requirements.
The final inspection report is a document that complies with industrial and mandatory requirements. The full
report includes two documents; an ”Inspection summary report” which is a evaluation of the overall equipment
condition in terms of safety and operation, based on what the inspection reveals, and the second document is a
”Service report” in which you will get recommendations for actions and spare parts when needed.
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 3
User Manual for Crane
3. Periodic Maintenance
Maintenance of the crane is organized in different time intervals. The intervals are specified as follows:
• xx Weeks: xxW
• xx Months: xxM
• xx Years: xxY
• xx Hours: xxH (operating hours)
Examples:
• 3 months interval: 3M
• 2 years interval : 2Y
• 1 Week interval: 1W
• 2 months / 200 hours: 2 M / 200 h
Maintenance Log
During the warranty period, either the enclosed maintenance log or the
vessel’s own maintenance log should be used to document crane
maintenance, as this will be called upon should a warranty issue occur.
All necessary inspection points are identified in the periodic maintenance program tables.
As a general recommendation all hydraulic motor bearings should be replaced after 15000 operating hours.
To prevent corrosion of the main and knuckle jib cylinder rods, the crane should not be parked with the cylinder
rods left exposed.
In longer periods of inactivity, to avoid shortening of the main and knuckle jib cylinder’s service life, repeatedly
extend and retract the cylinders to maintain internal lubrication and tightness.
6 Maintenance
4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Where referred to, please find the applicable annex in section 6.6 – Annexes.
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 5
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 6
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 7
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
8 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 9
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
10 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 11
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
12 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 13
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance
14 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
The MOPS controls are located in the operator cabin as indicated in the picture to the right (yellow buttons with
safety guard).
Safety measures:
Observe:
6 Maintenance
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 15
User Manual for Crane
5. Annexes
The following annexes are provided at the end of this chapter:
6 Maintenance
16 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Annex A -
Lubrication Standard Specifications (LSS)
6 Maintenance - Annex A
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS A1
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex A
A2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-01 nipples.doc 02 / 28.04.09 1 of 1
Specification no. :
LSS-01
Lubrication equipment:
GREASE NIPPLES IN GENERAL
General Instruction:
Comments / notes :
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-02 wire.doc 03 / 28.04.09 1 of 1
Specification no. :
LSS- 02
Lubrication equipment:
DIN 51502
ISO 6743-09
Comments / notes :
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-03 slew gear BRE.doc 03 / 28.04.09 1 of 3
Specification no. :
LSS- 03 BRE
Lubrication equipment:
Comments / notes :
Lubricating Instruction:
General
- All gears for vertical mounting: completely fill with oil.
Check the table next page for correct plug positions. For vertical mounting an
header oil tank can be supplied.
Continuous working temperature must not exceed 90° C.
OIL CHANGES.
Oil intervals may be modified, depending on actual operating conditions. During
oil change, we recommend that the inside of the gear case is flushed out with
flushing fluid recommended by lubricant manufacturer. Oil should be changed
when hot to prevent build up of sludge deposit. It is advisable to check oil level at
least once per month. If more than 10 % of total oil capacity has to be added,
check for oil leaks. Do not mix oils of different types even of the same make.
Never mix mineral and synthetic oils. Pay attention to oil and gear temperature
during oil change, to avoid the risk of scalding. Be conscious of the pollution
hazard due to the oil.
The main bearing (nearest to the output pinion) from the series
065/150/250/400 and 600 is grease lubricated. Take care to fill the bearing
compartment with grease before starting. This is done by pumping grease into the
grease-nipple until the grease comes out of the main bearing which is protected by a
so called “NILOS” ring. Grease should be completely exchanged every 1000
hours or six months, whatever occurs first.
Lubricating Instruction:
Specification no. :
LSS- 04 BRE
Lubrication equipment:
Comments / notes :
Lubricating Instruction:
General
Check the table next page for correct plug positions. Check oil filling carefully in all cases.
Extension pipes may be installed to facilitate checking of oil level.
Continuous working temperature must not exceed 90° C.
OIL CHANGES.
Oil intervals may be modified, depending on actual operating conditions. During oil
change, we recommend that the inside of the gear case is flushed out with flushing fluid
recommended by lubricant manufacturer. Oil should be changed when hot to prevent
build up of sludge deposit. It is advisable to check oil level at least once per month. If
more than 10 % of total oil capacity has to be added, check for oil leaks. Do not mix oils
of different types even of the same make. Never mix mineral and synthetic oils. Pay
attention to oil and gear temperature during oil change, to avoid the risk of scalding. Be
conscious of the pollution hazard due to the oil.
The main bearing (nearest to the output pinion) from the series 065/150/250/400 and 600
is grease lubricated. Take care to fill the bearing compartment with grease before
starting. This is done by pumping grease into the grease-nipple until the grease comes
out of the main bearing which is protected by a so called “NILOS” ring. Grease should be
completely exchanged every 1000 hours or six months, whatever occurs first.
Lubricating Instruction:
NOTE:
• The gearbox filling/breather port is fitted with a pressure relief breather valve. Inspect and
replace if necessary before refitting.
• The gear section lower plugs are equipped with magnetic tips. At oil change intervals check
for metal particles. Thoroughly clean plug before refitting.
• Each individual gear housing will be slightly rotated compared to each other due to the
eccentric mounting. Therefore indentify the plug nearest to the gear centreline when checking
oil levels in the chambers.
• After removing centreline plug for oil level checks and no oil is visible through port, make a
simple dipstick from a plastic strip or equal to verify oil level.
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGregor Hydramarine
products.
Specification no. :
General Lubrication Specification Gear oil: General Lubrication Specification Brake oil:
Comments / notes :
-
Maintenance system for MacGregor Hydramarine
products.
Lubricating Instruction:
General
Check the next pages for plug positions.
Continuous working temperature must not exceed 90° C.
OIL CHANGES.
• Oil intervals may be modified, depending on actual operating conditions. During oil
change, we recommend that the inside of the gear case is flushed out with flushing
fluid recommended by lubricant manufacturer. Oil should be changed when hot to
prevent build up of sludge deposit. It is advisable to check oil level at least once per
month. If more than 10 % of total oil capacity has to be added, check for oil leaks. Do
not mix oils of different types even of the same make. Never mix mineral and synthetic
oils. Pay attention to oil and gear temperature during oil change, to avoid the risk of
scalding. Be conscious of the oil pollution hazard.
• The gear section oil plugs are equipped with magnetic tips. At oil change intervals
check for metal particles. Thoroughly clean plug before refitting.
Specification no. :
LSS- 05
Lubrication equipment:
Comments / notes :
**) For low temperature operation below ÷20 °C, special arctic oil is
recommended. Please contact relevant supplier for exact specification.
Ex.:
Statoil: HYDRAULIC OIL 131 For temp >÷40 °C < +65 °C
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-08 Drive 05 / 30.04.2009 1 of 1
pinion.doc
Specification no. :
LSS-08
Lubrication equipment:
General Instruction:
Use a brush to apply grease to all tooth flanks of pinions and gear ring.
For location of pinions, refer to the lubrication chart for the product in
question.
Typical properties:
Consistency: NLGI 2
Recommended temperatures: –30→110 °C (for Kluberplex AG 11-462)
Recommended temperatures: –3→150 °C (for Omega 73)
Recommended temperatures: –10→60 °C (for Texclad 2)
Comments / notes:
* : Not to be used in automatic grease pump system
The colour of AG 11-462 is white. Omega73 and Texclad 2 is black
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-11 Heavy duty 01 / 29.04.2009 1 of 1
grease.doc
Specification no. :
LSS-11
Lubricating equipment:
General Instruction:
Typical properties:
Method
Soap type: Calcium
Consistency: 2 NLGI
Oil type: Mineral
Base oil viscosity at 40 °C: 1300 mm²/s ISO 12058*
Base oil viscosity at 100 °C: 106 mm²/s ISO 12058*
Recommended temperatures: –20→120 °C
Long polymer (“tacky”) additives: Yes
Extreme pressure (EP) additives: Yes
Solid lubricants: No
*) Base oil viscosity applies to the final mixed oil including long polymer additives.
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-20 Winch with gear 03 / 29.04.2009 1 of 2
rim.doc
Specification no. :
LSS-20
Lubrication equipment:
General Instruction:
The winch has the following main components which need lubrication:
• A set of gearboxes
• Main bearings
• Wire rope
Comments / notes :
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-20 Winch with gear 03 / 29.04.2009 2 of 2
rim.doc
Lubrication Instruction:
Specification no. :
LSS-21
Lubrication equipment:
General Instruction:
• Bearing
(winch with one gearbox only)
• Wire rope
Comments / notes :
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-21 HM Winch 01 / 29.11.2006 2 of 2
without gear rim.doc
Lubrication Instruction:
Specification no:
LSS- 22
Lubrication equipment:
ELECTRIC MOTORS
50 / 60 Hz
General Instruction:
On Lønne motors the bearings should be relubricated every 3 years. This is due to ageing and
irrespective of operation hours. Motors operating under special conditions, such as frequent
operation at maximum speed (n max), heavy vibration, sudden load changes and frequent
reversing operation, the relubrication should be performed at a considerably shorter interval than
at the intervals stated below.
Supplie Manufactu Type Delivery Temp (0C) Mount. Interval Type / Amount Notes Notes
r rer with Ambient / Pos. (h) comp.
grease bearing for vert.
mount.
Lønne Marelli B5M355L Yes 20/50 Vertical 8000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
4 V36 30/60 (V3/V6) 4000 N3 increased by 15 bearing / greasing
45/80 First time greasing deg C, regreasing intervals are noted on a
2000
200 gr. interval halved plate on the motors
55/90 1000
Relubrication 50
gr.
Lønne MEZ 14BG1802 Yes 40 Vertical 4000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
80 V36 50 (V3/V6) 2000 N3 increased by 10K, bearing / greasing
regreasing interval intervals are noted on a
60 1000
Relubrication 20- halved plate on the motors with
30 gr. 40C and in standard
horizontally mounting
Lønne MEZ 14BG315 Yes 40 Vertical 3000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
V36 50 (V3/V6) 1500 N3 increased by 10K, bearing / greasing
60 regreasing interval intervals are noted on a
750
Relubrication 30 - halved plate on the motors with
40C and in standard
40 gr.
horizontally mounting
ABB ABB M3BP355 Yes 25 Vertical 2000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
V36 40 (V3/V6) 1000 N3 increased by 15 bearing / greasing
Relubrication 70 deg C, regreasing intervals are noted on a
gr. interval halved plate on the motors
Lønne MEZ 7AA/BA Yes 40 Vertical 4000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature
160 V36 50 (V3/V6) 2000 N3 increased by 10K,
60 1000 Relubrication 20- regreasing interval
30 gr. halved
Tp HUALI Y3- Yes 40 Horizo 4000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information
nordic 280M2-4 ntal N3 increased by 10- reg.bearing/greasing
15 deg.c, interval are noted on a
Relubrication 30- regreasing interval plate on the motor with
40 gr. halved. 40c and in standard
horiz.mount.
Comments / notes :
Only relubricate bearings when the motor has a speed of at least n >300 rpm.
Lubrication intervals are compensated for vertical mounting.
Smaller electrical motors normally have closed bearings. Relubrication may not
be required.
User Manual for Crane
1. General
The crane is fitted with an automatic lubrication system .The purpose of lubrication is to promote longer service
life for the equipment. The advantage of a automatic lubrication system is that it releases “a little grease
frequently”, as opposed to “too much grease infrequently”, which is often the case with manual lubrication.
2. System Overview
The system will efficiently provide lubrication for all bearings on king/main jib and knuckle jib. Grease is
stored in two container/pump units, and pumped/distributed out via several distribution blocks to each
individual lubrication point on the jib assembly among others. See picture 2 for typical installation of
container/pump unit.
The system itself is fairly simple and comprises a pump with a lubricant reservoir. The pump has 1-3 outlets,
which lead to progressive distributors (”distribution blocks”). These have one inlet port and several outlet ports.
The grease is distributed from the progressive distributor to the various lubrication points or to a new
distribution block on the crane. These distribution blocks are mechanical blocks that have been designed
according to the desired dosage. See pump unit M55 and M56 in Drawing, Vol. 2: 2.10 Lubrication Charts.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS B1
User Manual for Crane
In order for the adjustable element to receive the correct dose of lubricant, it is also important to set the pump
sequence. The adjustment screws are located behind a red cap at the front of the pump where the one set screw
is for setting the number of pump revolutions and the other is for setting the frequency of pump actuation. If the
pump setting is 30 revolutions and 30 minutes it means that the pump shall run 30 revolutions every 30 minutes
the pump has current.
The crane automatic lubrication system will also provide lubrication for the main winch bearings and main
winch drive pinions/gear wheel.
Safety valve.
(Do not cover)
Pump elements
6 Maintenance - Annex B
B2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
If the pump has no integrated timer / logics, it is controlled by the crane’s PLC.
Typical setup see picture 3. If the alarm is released frequently and no grease are released through the safety
valve, set Overload Time Before Alarm higher than 7 sec. The alarm can also be released when the Lubrication
monitor are mounted away from the pump unit.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS B3
User Manual for Crane
• Blockage in the progressive distributor due to a jammed slide/piston in an element can occur because of
contamination in the lubricant or because the element has been under counter pressure and unused for a
long time.
Action: Disconnect the outlet connections, start the pump and observe if lubricant is released trough the
safety valve. If not: replace the progressive distributor. If lubricant is released: replace the connectors
and check the next distributor or the element.
• High counter pressure due to long tubes/hoses. Install a check valve on the pump element outlet.
• Breakage/damage of a tube/hose. Lubricant leaking on a damaged hose or a pipe can occur without
realising the alarm. In consequence one or more lubricant points are not receiving lubricant. Inspect the
hoses regularly (3M).
7. Lubricant
It is important that the grease is pump-able in the system, even at low temperatures. The system has been
designed to use NLGI class 2 grease.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
B4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
filling socket
for grease coupling box
filling press
Filling the pump units (See Picture 4.) demands a high cleanliness level. Avoid any particles. Even the
slightest dirt can block the piston in the distributor blocks.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS B5
User Manual for Crane
10003724 M 06 LL NUT 10
6 Maintenance - Annex B
B6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
The automatic lubrication system (if applicable) delivers lubrication to nearly all critical rotation points.
Most of the manual lubrication points serve preservation purposes and not lubrication of a rotation bolt. Use
LSS-01. See Manual Lubrication Grease Nipples Chart in Vol. 2 of the user manual.
2. Preservation Points
According to the Periodic Maintenance Program (“preservation points”) lubricate the following points:
6 Maintenance - Annex C
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS C1
User Manual for Crane
3. Rotation Points
According to the Periodic Maintenance Program (“rotation points”) lubricate the following points:
Lubrication of hinges
Lubricate door hinges and other non critical lubrication points.
6 Maintenance - Annex C
C2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. Lift Wires
1.1. General
MacGregor HM offshore cranes uses the following
wire rope type(s):
1.2. Inspection
In order to keep wire ropes in a good working condition, routine inspections and periodic maintenance is
necessary. On wire ropes frequently used in AHC operations, particular attention must be paid at the areas
where they pass over a wire sheave as the wire rope strands have a tendency to open slightly and thus making it
possible for the inspector to get a better view of the wire rope core.
As a minimum, the wire ropes should be inspected monthly. However, lift wires in continuous service should
be observed during normal operation and visually inspected on a weekly basis.
The purpose of the inspection is to reveal dryness, abrasion, internal/external corrosion, core or strand
protrusion/distortion, wire breaks, wear, kinks etc. before the wire rope becomes unsafe to work with (see
illustrations on the following page of unwanted situations).
Note: Any deterioration leading to a suspected loss of original rope strength should be carefully examined and
the Discard criteria provided in ISO 4309 applied in determining whether to remove the rope from service.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS D1
User Manual for Crane
Wire protrusion.
External corrosion.
Kinked wire.
Local increase in rope diameter due to core distortion.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
D2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1.3. Lubrication
Over time, the factory lubrication of the wire ropes will wear off due to the environment and usage. Periodic
maintenance is therefore a necessity.
Manual lubrication with the aid of brushes, rags, gloves, or by other means is costly, risky, and ineffective. The
lubricant forms a film on the surface which water vapour can penetrate, thus becoming trapped. Temperature
changes cause condensation and rust then begins to form from the inside. This will lead to severe corrosion
which promotes premature fatigue failures in the wires and strands.
A high pressure wire lubrication system (e.g. Masto lubrication system) will be able to maintain good
lubrication of the wire rope, penetrating through to its core which is absolutely necessary to keep friction low
and corrosion away.
How often the wire ropes need to be re-lubricated depends on the environment in which the wire ropes operate
along with the usage and the result of the routine inspections. Generally, if the wire rope show signs of dryness,
lubrication should be initiated, ideally before. As a minimum, check every 3 month if the wire rope show signs
of lubrication deterioration.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS D3
User Manual for Crane
2. Lifting Hooks
2.1. Inspection
Every 4 years, the hook and hook nut are to be dismantled, inspected and retested (proof loaded). Particular
attention to be paid to the following:
• Wear in hook, centre pin, becket and threads in hook and nut.
• Play in sheave bushes or bearings.
• Spacer bolts, nuts and lynch pins.
• Check for cracks in welds.
• Condition of safety catch and grease nipples.
• Wear to holes in side plates and becket.
2.2. Lubrication
Lubrication of the hooks is normally to be done once a week (each week for frequently used hooks/blocks,
monthly for infrequently used equipment or each time it is used). Refer to the periodic maintenance table.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
D4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
4. Hazards
• Avoid skin contact with hydraulic oils by use of gloves.
• Be wary of any cuts that may be caused by running a hand carelessly across damaged wire. Use gloves.
• Ensure winch has been stopped before inspecting wire.
• When laying down the double part block on its side for lubrication, ensure the block is completely
secure as there can be a risk of it falling over.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS D5
User Manual for Crane
1. General
Inspection and replacement intervals should be done according to chapter 6.2 Periodic Maintenance.
Hydraulic hose manufacturers estimate that 80% of hose failures are attributable to external physical damage
through pulling, kinking, crushing or abrasion of the hose.
Hydraulic hose can and will age whether it is in normal service conditions or unused in storage. Hose failure is
not an indication of poor product performance, but rather natural degradation. After a while a hydraulic hose
will show sign of wear that include cracking, blisters and bubbles.
The operating conditions that a correctly installed hydraulic hose is subjected to will ultimately determine its
service life. Extremes in temperature, e.g. high daytime operating temperatures and very cold conditions when
the machine is standing at night, accelerates aging of the hose's rubber tube and cover.
• Environmental conditions.
• Ultraviolet light.
• Salt water.
• Air pollutants.
• Extreme temperatures.
• Ozone.
• Chemicals.
• Electricity.
• Abrasion damage.
6 Maintenance - Annex E
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS E1
User Manual for Crane
Abrasion caused by hoses rubbing against each other or surrounding surfaces is the most common type of
damage. Replace the hoses and avoid new abrasion and external damage, ensure all clamps are kept secure, pay
careful attention to routing whenever a replacement hose is installed and if necessary, apply inexpensive
polyethylene spiral wrap, zip tie, sleeves and guards to protect hydraulic hoses from abrasion (see photo below).
6 Maintenance - Annex E
E2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2. Replacement
MacGregor recommend to replace hoses at the following intervals:
Replacement of denso tape on hose connections after reinstallation is recommended to avoid corrosion.
Installation of a replaced hose at less than the minimum recommended bend radius may significantly reduce the
lifetime of the hose (see illustrations below). Particular attention must be given to prevent sharp bends at the
hose connection to the fitting (photo above).
Proper physical installation of the hose assembly requires a correctly installed port connection ensuring that no
twist or torque is transferred to the hose when the fittings are being tightened.
Bending a hydraulic hose in more than one plane results in twisting of its wire reinforcement. A twist of five
degrees can reduce the service life of a high-pressure hydraulic hose by as much as 70% and a seven degree
twist can result in a 90% reduction in service life.
6 Maintenance - Annex E
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS E3
User Manual for Crane
4. Hazards
• Ensure both the system and the specific damaged hose are devoid of pressure before attempting any
replacement. Removing hoses or tampering with damaged hoses while the system is under pressure can
result in a high pressure release of hydraulic oil.
• Clean the maintenance area before and after maintenance to avoid slippery surfaces and any
contamination.
• Remember to dispose of any damaged or unusable components in the correct manner, by taking them to
a recycling center that deals with the components in question.
6 Maintenance - Annex E
E4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
1.1. Before Disassembly
Prior to replacement of the hydraulic filters (for action intervals,
see section 6.2 - "Periodic Maintenance Program"), it is important
to make sure that the oil level in the tank is below the return filters
mounted on the tank top. These filters have contamination
retainers which might contain some particles. Lower the level in
the tank by lifting the main jib and the knuckle jib. This action
must be taken to reduce the risk of mixing unfiltered “dirty” oil
with the clean oil in the tank.
Then, shut down the HPU for at least 15 minutes. This will release
the pressure and drain oil to the tank. When applicable, press the
emergency (local) stop button.
Make sure you have the correct filters and sealings. MacGregor Return filter with
recommends to replace the O-rings each time the filters are replaced. contamination retainer(circled)
Most of the filters are located on the HPU (inside the king). However, they can also be placed outside on the
king platform or mounted on the winches. Normally, all filters (apart from the air breathers and emergency
supply filter) have clogged filter indicators (lights) and an alarm indication in the crane control system.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F1
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2. Breather Filters
Breather filters prevent contamination from the surroundings from entering
the system in connection with fluctuations of the oil level in the tank (tank
breathing).
Some filters are delivered as one unit but most commend are filters with
separate elements.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F3
User Manual for Crane
3. Offline Filter
Offline oil filtration systems with integrated circulating pumps are
ideal for controlling oil contamination levels for particles, water
and degradation products (oxidation resin/sludge, varnish). The
filters are normally mounted at the bottom of the tank and
circulates the oil in the tank.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Stop the CJC filter Close valve on the oil Close valve on the oil Automatic air vent: No Open oil drain valve.
pump inlet filter outlet action Drain according to
Air vent screw: Open environmental
screw precautions
When the filter housing Lift off the filter housing Unscrew the spring nut Remove the spring and Remove the used filter
is drained, unscrew the the spring guide inserts. Depose of
top nut according to regulations
Clean the filter bottom Put the new CJC filter Insert type B, BLA or Mount the spring guide Tighten the spring nut Replace both O-rings Replace O-ring for the Tighten the top nut with Automatic air vent: No Be aware that oil
inserts in place BLAT, use insert guide carefully - make sure by hand until contact top nut a torque of 90Nm action. spillage is a serious
between the filter there is no contact with spring guide. Then Air vent screw: Replace safety risk - keep clean!
elements between the O-ring and tighten the spring nut 4 usit ring for air vent
the thread turns per filter insert screw, and tighten with
torque of 10 Nm
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F5
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
4. Return Filters
These filters are normally low pressure filters.
The location are typically at the top of the
tank, but they can also be mounted as in-line
filters outside on the king platform or on the
winch itself.
1. Moisten the sealing surfaces and thread on the cover plate and housing, as well as the O-ring on the
cover plate and element, with clean operating fluid.
2. When fitting a new element, check that the designation corresponds to that of the old element.
3. Fit the contamination retainer onto the new or cleaned filter element by turning clockwise (only for type
1.0).
4. Place the filter element(s) carefully onto the element location spigot.
5. Screw on the cover plate fully. Then unscrew by one quarter-turn.
6. Screw in the oil drain screw(s); tighten the vent screw(s).
7. Switch on the hydraulic system and vent filter at an appropriate point in the system.
8. Check the filter for leakage.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F7
User Manual for Crane
Drain valve
4.3. Hazards
• Avoid skin exposure to hydraulic oil.
• Clean area before and after maintenance to
avoid slippery surfaces or contamination.
• Dispose of old filter appropriately by taking it to a recycling centre.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F8 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
5. Pressure Filters
High-pressure filters are installed after the pumps and other prime movers to protect critical hydraulic
components such as cylinders, motors and valves.
1. Close the inlet and the outlet valve (if present). Ref. Hydraulic flow diagram.
2. Remove oil drain plug at the bottom of the bowl, collect oil in a container.
3. Unscrew bowl. (Collect fluid in a suitable container and dispose of it in accordance with environmental
regulations).
4. Remove filter element from element location spigot (examine surface of element for dirt residue and
larger particles; these can indicate damage to the components).
5. Clean bowl by using white sprite or similar.
6. Examine filter, especially sealing surfaces and threads, for mechanical damage.
7. Replace O–rings.
1. Moisten thread and sealing surfaces on the filter bowl and head, as well as the O–ring on the bowl and
element if necessary, with clean operating fluid.
2. When fitting a new element, check that the designation corresponds to that of the old element.
3. Place filter element carefully onto the element location spigot.
4. Screw in filter bowl fully.
5. Screw in oil drain plug.
6. Unscrew filter bowl by one quarter–turn.
7. IMPORTANT: Open Inlet and outlet valve
8. Clean/dry the outside of the filter bowl. After start-up of the hydraulic system again, check for any
leaks.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F9
User Manual for Crane
5.3. Hazards
• Clean area before and after maintenance to avoid slippery surfaces or contamination.
• Ensure valves are closed and system depressurised before performing any maintenance. If valves are
opened while the system is pressurised, high pressure hydraulic oil will be released.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
6. Drain Filters
The drain filters are normally located at the top of the tank, but can also be mounted outside on the platform or
on the winches. Three different drain filter types can occur:
1. Loosen cover plate bolts, turn and 1. Moisten sealing surfaces and thread on
remove the cover plate. the cover plate and housing, as well as
2. Remove filter element carefully from the O-rings on the cover plate and
element spigot. Examine element element, with clean hydraulic fluid.
surface for dirt residue and larger 2. When fitting a new element, check that
particles; these can indicate damage to the designation corresponds to that of the
the system components. old element.
3. Remove contamination retainer (if 3. Fit the contamination retainer (if present)
present) by turning anti-clockwise onto the new filter element by turning it
(bayonet fitting). clockwise.
4. Clean cover plate, housing and 4. Place filter element(s) carefully onto the
contamination retainer; pay particular element location spigot.
attention to the threads. 5. Re-fit cover plate and tighten cover plate
5. Examine filter, especially sealing bolts.
surfaces and thread, for mechanical 6. Switch on hydraulic system and Check
damage. filter for leakage.
6. Replace O-rings.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F11
User Manual for Crane
6.3. Hazards
• Avoid skin exposure to hydraulic oil.
• Clean area before and after maintenance to
avoid slippery surfaces or contamination.
• Dispose of old filter appropriately by taking it to a recycling centre.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
1. Verify that the HPU is not running. 1. Use clean hydraulic fluid to moisten
2. Close the inlet valves to the sealing surfaces and threads on the cover
replenishment pumps, normally located plate and housing, as well as the O-rings
on the tank wall. on the cover plate and element.
3. Close the outlet valve (if present). 2. When fitting a new element, check that
the designation corresponds to that of the
4. Open the air bleed plug on the top of the old element.
filter to make it easier to drain the oil.
3. Place filters element(s) carefully onto the
5. Drain the replenishment pump filters element location spigot.
with the valves at the bottom of the filter
houses. 4. Screw on cover plate fully and then
unscrew by one quarter-turn.
6. Unscrew top covers.
5. Close the drain valve and air bleed plug.
7. Remove filter element(s) from element
spigot. Examine element surface for dirt 6. IMPORTANT: Open the inlet and outlet
residue and larger particles; these can valves.
indicate damage to system components.
8. Clean cover plate and housing; pay Vent the filters:
particular attention to the threads.
1. Start the HPU and let the replenishment
9. Examine filter, especially sealing pump run for one minute.
surfaces and threads, for mechanical
2. Stop the HPU
damage.
3. Release carefully air bleed plug on top of
10. Replace O-rings and check seals.
the replenishment filter and bleed of all
air.
4. Close the air plug when the oil is floating
and no more air is bleeding.
5. Clean up, start HPU and check filters for
leakages
Replenishment filters
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F13
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
1. General
According to section 6.2 - "Periodic
Maintenance", the health of the hydraulic oil
in the system needs to be tested at a regular
basis. This is to be done by taking an oil
sample from the reservoir.
2. Bottle Cleanliness
Because of the extreme oil cleanliness levels, even the slightest dirt originating in a sample bottle can have an
adverse effect on the precision of the particle count. It is common to represent bottle contamination levels as the
number of particles greater than ten microns per millilitre (0.01 mm).
6 Maintenance - Annex G
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS G1
User Manual for Crane
3. How to Sample
1. The system should have normal operating temperature and flow conditions when taking an oil sample.
MacGregor recommends to operate the system for at least 30 minutes with actuators cycling prior to
talking samples. (If not possible to sample when the equipment is operating, sample as soon as safely
possible after shutdown to prevent the settling of contaminants).
2. Open the sampling valve and let at least one litre pass the ball valve tube. Collect the flushed fluid in a
container.
3. Use a 100 % clean standard analysis bottle (typical 500 ml) provided by a bottle supplier. Open the
sample bottle cap, taking care not to contaminate. Hold the cap in hand or place on a clean surface, face
down.
4. Fill the sample bottle about halfway, cap and shake well to flush the internal surface. Discard the fluid.
5. Fill the sample bottle again until the fluid level is about 1 cm (½”) from the top.
6. Cap the bottle immediately and then close the sampling valve.
7. Label the sample bottle with sample details, fill out the sample form and enclose both in the supplied
plastic container for transport.
4. Visual Analysis
Looking and smelling at hydraulic fluid is the simplest way to determine the fluid's condition. Clean fluid is
amber in color. A milky, dark, or otherwise abnormal color may indicate the presence of one or more
contaminants. A milky appearance implies contamination by water. If the fluid looks milky, take immediate
action to avoid severe damage to your hydraulic system.
A marked change in the smell of the hydraulic fluid can indicate a chemical breakdown. If a distinct change in
the smell of hydraulic fluid is detected, have it chemically analyzed by a commercial lab.
5. Type of Analysis
A minimum recommendation from MacGregor is to perform a particle and water analysis every 6 months,
whether you are conducting onsite particle counting, or relying on a commercial lab. A full oil analysis are
recommending to be done once a year. The analysis may include particle counter, water content, viscosity,
oxidation, iron, silicon and copper content.
6 Maintenance - Annex G
G2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
7. Hazards
• Avoid skin exposure to hydraulic oil. If exposed wash area with water and soap.
• Clean area before and after sample to avoid slippery surfaces or contamination of sample.
• Ensure bottle top of sample is secure.
6 Maintenance - Annex G
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS G3
User Manual for Crane
Blank Page.
6 Maintenance - Annex G
G4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
Instructions for pre-charging of both bladder and piston accumulators via an accumulator test and filling kit is
provided in this section. When checking or re-charging accumulator pressure, the test and filling kit provided by
MacGregor Norway AS must be used.
Note: When the accumulator is installed in a system, reduce the system pressure to 0.
12T Winch
WH-11.1, 12.1, 13.1, 14.1, 11.2, 12.2, 13.2, SP2552-2-L-XA-005 50 bar
14.2
Slew System
SH11, 12, 13, 14 SP2552-2-L-XA-004 6 bar
6 Maintenance - Annex I
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS I1
User Manual for Crane
2. Charging Procedures
2.1. Bladder Accumulator
• Attach the hexagonal connector (1) to the nitrogen bottle.
• Remove the gas valve protective caps from the accumulator. Secure the swivel connector (2) on the gas
valve and tighten sufficiently to prevent gas leakage. (Use adapter (5) on the accumulator for
installation of swivel connector on gas valve). Screw the bar handle (3) in a clockwise direction to open
the accumulator gas valve.
2 1
• Slowly open the nitrogen bottle valve until the expanding bladder closes the poppet valve. Check this
closure prior to charging to desired pressure.
• Close the nitrogen bottle valve. Wait for 5 minutes, before checking the pre-charge pressure. To lower
the pressure, open the air bleed valve (4).
• The Pre-charge pressure will drop slightly when the compressed gas cools off. Therefore, pre-charge to
20% above required pressure.
• Screw the bar handle (3) in a counter clockwise direction to close the gas valve. Use the air bleed valve
(4) to expel all gas from the pre-charging assembly. Remove the swivel connector (2) . (Remove the
adapter (5) if this has been used). Carefully test the gas connections for leakage by applying soapy
water or using leak detector in and around the gas valve area when the pre-charging is complete.
• Fit the gas valve protective caps.
• Remove the hexagonal connector (1) from the nitrogen bottle.
• Check the pre-charge after one, two and three weeks to ensure that no leakage has occurred. Further
pre-charge checks should be made every six months.
6 Maintenance - Annex I
I2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Note: Use nitrogen only! Compressed air and oxygen involve risk of explosion!
6 Maintenance - Annex I
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS I3
User Manual for Crane
2.4. Hazards
• Filling accumulators involves dealing with pressurised nitrogen which if handled incorrectly can result
in explosion. Experience personnel recommended.
• Check for damaged hoses, as working with damaged hoses can lead to release of pressurised gas.
• Ensure hose connections are secure.
6 Maintenance - Annex I
I4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
• Bolt inspection critical areas: Elongation, threads, cracks and tension.
• Inspect all slew ring bolts / nuts (bolts / nuts in place): 1 M / 500 H
• Perform “knock-test” of all slew ring bolts: 6 M / 500 H
• Initial re-tensioning of all bolts: 1 M after crane delivery
• Periodic re-tensioning of all bolts: 6 M / 500 H
• Removal and examination of individual bolts: 20 % of bolts annually*
* 20% of the bolts shall be removed and examined. The first 20% shall be taken in the most loaded sector of the
crane. If any significant defects are found during this examination another 20% are drawn. If any of this second
set is found to be defective then all bolts shall be drawn. If the first 20% are found to be acceptable the bolts can
be re-used and the next 20 % can be drawn the following year.
When refitting, all bolts shall be tensioned according to: HM doc. No: T0001.
1.1. Knock-Test
It is recommended to use a ball peen hammer and do a “knock test” on each bolt. In the event that a nut should
have become loose, the lack of tension in the bolt will generate a different sound during the knock test as
compared to the fully tensioned bolts. Loose nuts indicate that bolt must be re-tensioned according to HM doc.
no: T0001.
Note: At the 6’th month interval, the knock-test and re-tensioning can be performed every other time.
T0001 – Tightening Torques & Bolt Tensioning Forces: See the following pages.
6 Maintenance - Annex K
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS K1
User Manual for Crane
3. Hazards
• A safety harness is recommended if a ladder or lift is being used for re-tensioning.
6 Maintenance - Annex K
K2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
TECHNICAL REQUIREMENTS
This document and all information and data herein or herewith is the confidential and proprietary property of
MacGregor Norway AS and is not to be used, reproduced or disclosed in whole or in part by or to anyone without
the written confirmation from MacGregor Norway AS.
© MacGregor Norway AS
T0001 - 5
T:\Technical Requirements\
Title: BOLT SELECTION / TIGHTENING TORQUES / BOLT TENSIONING FORCES
Doc. No.: T0001
1 Applicability
The bolt selection in this document refers to how to select bolts and bolt quality in general
applications (e.g. winch assembly, gearbox assembly, etc.) and special applications (e.g. slew
ring bolts and nuts)
The tightening torques in this document applies to critical bolts specifically identified by the
drawing, technical specification/requirement or other document. See section 3.
The bolt tensioning forces (hydraulic tensioning) apply to all crane slewing ring bolts with
thread diameter M33 or larger. See section 4.
The tightening torques (section 3) are valid for standard, full-section, uncoated carbon steel (not
stainless) fasteners lubricated with anti-seize compound, such as Loctite 8009. These tightening torques
are also generally used for hot dip zinc coated fasteners, although such fasteners would require a
somewhat higher torque to achieve maximum clamping force. Source: Tingstad table T-18, lower left-
hand section.
2 Bolt/nut Selection
Selection of bolts/nuts for different assemblies and applications is normally done according to
material specification list on the relevant assembly drawing. Here the bolt size, type and quality
and number are specified. In addition to this, all bolts shall conform with and be tested in
accordance with a recognised standard e.g. pertinent part of ISO 898.
In general bolts are to be delivered according to DNV “Standard for certification of lifting
appliances Oct 2008, Ch. 2, Sec. 2, D400
Bolt connections are normally divided into three different groups; secondary, primary and
essential.
1. Secondary bolts are bolts in platforms, stairs, ladders, railings, installation of cabins and
cabinets etc. Bolts in this category are to be delivered with 2.2 works certificate and it is
T:\Technical Requirements\ Page 2 of 5
Title: BOLT SELECTION / TIGHTENING TORQUES / BOLT TENSIONING FORCES
Doc. No.: T0001
no requirement to charpy tests. Bolts smaller than M12 to be stainless steel A4 quality.
Bolts from M12 and up to be hot dip galvanised 8.8 quality.
2. Primary bolts are transferring structural loads and are elements in the primary load
carrying structure. Bolts in this category are to be delivered with 2.2 works certificates
and there it is no requirements to charpy tests. Bolts smaller than M12 to be stainless
steel A4 quality. Bolts from M12 and up to be hot dip galvanised 8.8 quality. If the
structural calculations show that an increased strength is required, 10.9 qualities may be
used.
3. Essential bolts are part of a non-redundant load path and a breakage may result in a
collapse or a serious mal-function. Bolts used in slew bearings are also considered as
essential. Bolts in this category are to be delivered with 3.1 certificates. If installed in a
slew bearing for offshore cranes, 3.2 certificates is required. Normally 8.8 or 10.9
qualities are used in this category. No higher than 10.9 quality is allowed. The
requirements to charpy test are given in DNV “Standard for certification of lifting
appliances Oct 2008, Ch. 2, Sec. 2, Table D4. Bolts with diameter less than Ø25mm has
no charpy test requirements. The requirements for bolts from Ø25mm are 42J for
offshore applications and 25J for other applications Test temperature (Td) is normally -
20 degC for offshore cranes and -10 degC for other cranes.
3 Tightening torques
Bolt tension forces including tolerances for "large-clearance metric thread" – DIN 2510 –
Sheet 2 – using hydraulic tension cylinders.
Preload the bolts with the advisable care crosswise to the specified values. It is possible to
calculate with a tightening factor of αA of 1.2 to 1.6, depending on the tightening method, and to
use the yield point of the bolt up to 90%.
The preload of the bolt tightened first is influenced by the tightening of the other bolts so that a
minimum of two passes is required.
This will at the same time compensate for the settling produced by the smoothing out of the
unloaded mating surface during preloading (thread and nut contact surface).
As the tension force applied in this method will not only cause elongation in the shaft but also in
the thread, it is important to choose the correct thread series or thread tolerances acc. to
DIN 2510. An inadequate thread clearance may cause jamming of the nut, when the bolt is
elongated. Taking into account the nut height, consultation with the bolts manufacturer is
absolutely necessary.
The bolts should be long enough to leave at least 1 · d above the nuts free for positioning the
tension cylinder.
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L1
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
In order to have comparable measurements it is important that the measurements are done in the exact same
slew positions each year and with the jibs in the same geometric position. The operator panel in the crane cabin
shows both jib and slew positions. These positions can be used for future reference.
The following table is to be used for recording measurements every 6 months following the initial
measurement. The accuracy of the measuring instrument is to be minimum ±0.01mm.
Depth micrometer
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L3
User Manual for Crane
The photo below shows measurement at one of the four measurement points on the crane pedestal. The
maximum allowable deviation is:
If the wear is found to have increased significantly, the time intervals between measurements should be
shortened. If the wear exceeds the given limit, consult MacGregor Marine Service.
*Deviations in flatness are measured in accordance with DIN EN ISO 1101 on the contact surfaces
**The value for increase in slack is a measurement of how much the hardened layers of the bearing are worn
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2 0
3 0
4 0
2 90
3 90
4 90
2 180
3 180
4 180
2 270
3 270
4 270
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L5
User Manual for Crane
Grease sampling:
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Tester:
Signature:
Date:
Grease
sample
result
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L7
User Manual for Crane
2. Hazards
• In order to measure correctly paint may need to be removed.
• For any necessary paint removal for correct measurements, use a paint removal chemical or paint
removal sand paper.
• Ensure adequate protection is used for working with paint removal.
• Use Tectyl rust preventative after measuring to prevent rust.
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L8 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Note: From early 2011, some cranes were equipped with tempered steel sheaves. For these cranes, the wire
sheave groove wear measurement is not applicable.
Obtaining good measurements of wire sheave groove wear will help the crane owner to apply appropriate
sheave maintenance actions in addition to providing relevant input to the crane maintenance schedule.
The wire sheave grooves include a two to three mm induction hardened layer beyond which the hardness
gradually decreases. The abrasion that the grooves are subject to can be monitored and understood by use of a
sliding gauge for measuring the depth of the groove. Measurements are taken to a tenth of a millimeter. Based
on the original inspection date, wear measurement trend analysis can be used to influence the measuring
schedule itself so that it continues to accurately indicate the health and future useful lifetime of the sheaves.
Groove Measuring
There are normally eight wire sheaves to be measured
(four for the main winch and four for the whip winch
wire). The measurement shall be taken at the same
reference position on the wire sheave every time. This is
to avoid "false" wear indications. The reference position
is normally marked on the wire sheave flange by means
of a sign plate (shown here by an arrow).
Operate the crane (rotate wire sheaves) to make the measuring point indicators on the wire
1
sheaves clearly visible and accessible.
Locate the mark (photo at previous page) which exactly indicates where the measurement should
2
be taken.
Perform depth measurement by means of a steel rule and a sliding gauge (or equivalent) to
3
measure the distance from top of flange to bottom of groove (photo below).
Record the measurement/deviation in the "wire sheaves log", an example of which is provided on
4
next page.
5 Repeat procedure for all wire sheaves.
Scheduled Maintenance
Due to the characteristics of wire sheave groove wear, it is recommended that the measuring frequency is set to
once every six months initially for a period of one year. Thereafter it will be at the crane owner's discretion to
adjust the maintenance schedule based on the previous depth measurements and the crane owner's inherent
technical experience and expertise.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
M2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
*Note: The table provided in this page is standardized. The amount of sheaves may differ from crane to crane.
The initial measurement value in the table above is the value for the first measurement taken for each individual wire sheave. If, upon receipt of this procedure,
the values are not already stated measurements should be carried out and logged in conjunction with the cranes’ Harbor Acceptance Test or equivalent.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS M1
User Manual for Crane
Blank Page.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
M2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance - Annex M
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2. Hazards
• Ensure to clean the area before measuring to achieve accurate results.
• If a lift or ladder is used it is advised to use a safety harness.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
M2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
• Open and check that the doors gaskets are in good condition (apply Vaseline, silicone, or similar if dry).
• Check regularly for water ingress, corrosion, damage, loose glands, and ambient conditions in excess of
the specifications.
Tighten all cable terminal Tighten all cabinet Check and clean the
connections and fuses bushings drain plug (if applicable)
VCI device
plate at JB
(see photo
Tighten all cable
below)
terminal connections
and fuses
6 Maintenance - Annex N
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS N1
User Manual for Crane
3. Hazards
• Ensure power is turned off before accessing electrical cabinet or junction box. This is in order to avoid
electrocution. Working with live wires is extremely dangerous.
6 Maintenance - Annex N
N2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. Inspection
1.1. General
The pressure transmitters have been calibrated to a certain pressure range, and sends a 4-20 mA signal,
corresponding to the calibrated range to an analogue input channel in the PLC system.
However, to secure correct pressure readings, an inspection of the most "essential" pressure transmitters must to
be done. MacGregor Norway recommend to do this at least every two years to verify accuracy and followed up
by a recalibration (often replacement) if needed.
The transmitters on active boost cranes which must be checked is listed in the table below, while those for semi-
active cranes are listed on the following page. In the tables, the name of the transmitter, its tag number and
maximum allowed deviation is provided.
Active Boost
For active boost cranes, the following pressure transmitters are evaluated to be "essential" and must be checked
frequently:
Main winch motor displacement pressure 2 -PT204B (or -PT205) 0.5 bar
6 Maintenance - Annex P
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS P1
User Manual for Crane
Semi-Active
For semi-active cranes, the following pressure transmitters are evaluated to be "essential" and must be checked
frequently:
* Whip winch displacement pressure (* if whip winch AHC) -PT260 0.5 bar
Other:
Replenishment pressure -PT203 2.0 bar
Recommended tools:
• Hand pump.
• T-joint (2x).
• Calibrated pressure transmitter (0-60 bar).
• Calibrated pressure transmitter (0-400 bar).
• Calibrated pressure transmitter (0-460 bar) for main pump transmitters.
• Portable data recorder / measurement device.
6 Maintenance - Annex P
P2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
After the transmitter is unplugged from the crane, testing is done in the following order:
Note: The pressure should be applied step by step between 5-10 bar. If the deviation exceeds the maximum
allowed value, the transmitter must be changed. The consequence of having too high deviation will differ from
transmitter to transmitter. Please contact MacGregor Norway for advice!
Transmitter to be tested
6 Maintenance - Annex P
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS P3
User Manual for Crane
2. Replacement
Replacement of pressure transmitters is done in the following order:
Required tools:
• Wrench/spanner - 27 mm.
4. Hazards
• Ensure system is depressurised.
• Clean area after maintenance to avoid slippery surfaces.
• Use drip tray.
6 Maintenance - Annex P
P4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Annex Q - Encoders
1. General
All pulse encoders must be inspected and checked for proper
function, damage and corrosion every 3M/500H, whichever
occur first. They are located the following places:
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS Q1
User Manual for Crane
2. Inspection
Inspection of a pulse encoder is done in the following order:
Required tools:
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
Q2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3. Replacement
If a pulse encoder is damaged, it must be replaced. Replacement is a simple procedure which may be undertaken
by an electrician.
Required tools:
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS Q3
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
Q4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
System Maintenance Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign
Action
1
2
HYDRAULIC
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
6 Maintenance - Annex Z
MacGregor NORWAY AS Z1
User Manual for Crane
System Maintenance Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign
Action
20
MECHANICAL
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
6 Maintenance - Annex Z
MacGregor NORWAY AS Z2
User Manual for Crane
System Maintenance Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign
Action
39
ELECTRICAL
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
6 Maintenance - Annex Z
MacGregor NORWAY AS Z3
User Manual for Crane
Annex A -
Lubrication Standard Specifications (LSS)
6 Maintenance - Annex A
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS A1
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex A
A2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-01 nipples.doc 02 / 28.04.09 1 of 1
Specification no. :
LSS-01
Lubrication equipment:
GREASE NIPPLES IN GENERAL
General Instruction:
Comments / notes :
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-02 wire.doc 03 / 28.04.09 1 of 1
Specification no. :
LSS- 02
Lubrication equipment:
DIN 51502
ISO 6743-09
Comments / notes :
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-03 slew gear BRE.doc 03 / 28.04.09 1 of 3
Specification no. :
LSS- 03 BRE
Lubrication equipment:
Comments / notes :
Lubricating Instruction:
General
- All gears for vertical mounting: completely fill with oil.
Check the table next page for correct plug positions. For vertical mounting an
header oil tank can be supplied.
Continuous working temperature must not exceed 90° C.
OIL CHANGES.
Oil intervals may be modified, depending on actual operating conditions. During
oil change, we recommend that the inside of the gear case is flushed out with
flushing fluid recommended by lubricant manufacturer. Oil should be changed
when hot to prevent build up of sludge deposit. It is advisable to check oil level at
least once per month. If more than 10 % of total oil capacity has to be added,
check for oil leaks. Do not mix oils of different types even of the same make.
Never mix mineral and synthetic oils. Pay attention to oil and gear temperature
during oil change, to avoid the risk of scalding. Be conscious of the pollution
hazard due to the oil.
The main bearing (nearest to the output pinion) from the series
065/150/250/400 and 600 is grease lubricated. Take care to fill the bearing
compartment with grease before starting. This is done by pumping grease into the
grease-nipple until the grease comes out of the main bearing which is protected by a
so called “NILOS” ring. Grease should be completely exchanged every 1000
hours or six months, whatever occurs first.
Lubricating Instruction:
Specification no. :
LSS- 04 BRE
Lubrication equipment:
Comments / notes :
Lubricating Instruction:
General
Check the table next page for correct plug positions. Check oil filling carefully in all cases.
Extension pipes may be installed to facilitate checking of oil level.
Continuous working temperature must not exceed 90° C.
OIL CHANGES.
Oil intervals may be modified, depending on actual operating conditions. During oil
change, we recommend that the inside of the gear case is flushed out with flushing fluid
recommended by lubricant manufacturer. Oil should be changed when hot to prevent
build up of sludge deposit. It is advisable to check oil level at least once per month. If
more than 10 % of total oil capacity has to be added, check for oil leaks. Do not mix oils
of different types even of the same make. Never mix mineral and synthetic oils. Pay
attention to oil and gear temperature during oil change, to avoid the risk of scalding. Be
conscious of the pollution hazard due to the oil.
The main bearing (nearest to the output pinion) from the series 065/150/250/400 and 600
is grease lubricated. Take care to fill the bearing compartment with grease before
starting. This is done by pumping grease into the grease-nipple until the grease comes
out of the main bearing which is protected by a so called “NILOS” ring. Grease should be
completely exchanged every 1000 hours or six months, whatever occurs first.
Lubricating Instruction:
NOTE:
• The gearbox filling/breather port is fitted with a pressure relief breather valve. Inspect and
replace if necessary before refitting.
• The gear section lower plugs are equipped with magnetic tips. At oil change intervals check
for metal particles. Thoroughly clean plug before refitting.
• Each individual gear housing will be slightly rotated compared to each other due to the
eccentric mounting. Therefore indentify the plug nearest to the gear centreline when checking
oil levels in the chambers.
• After removing centreline plug for oil level checks and no oil is visible through port, make a
simple dipstick from a plastic strip or equal to verify oil level.
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGregor Hydramarine
products.
Specification no. :
General Lubrication Specification Gear oil: General Lubrication Specification Brake oil:
Comments / notes :
-
Maintenance system for MacGregor Hydramarine
products.
Lubricating Instruction:
General
Check the next pages for plug positions.
Continuous working temperature must not exceed 90° C.
OIL CHANGES.
• Oil intervals may be modified, depending on actual operating conditions. During oil
change, we recommend that the inside of the gear case is flushed out with flushing
fluid recommended by lubricant manufacturer. Oil should be changed when hot to
prevent build up of sludge deposit. It is advisable to check oil level at least once per
month. If more than 10 % of total oil capacity has to be added, check for oil leaks. Do
not mix oils of different types even of the same make. Never mix mineral and synthetic
oils. Pay attention to oil and gear temperature during oil change, to avoid the risk of
scalding. Be conscious of the oil pollution hazard.
• The gear section oil plugs are equipped with magnetic tips. At oil change intervals
check for metal particles. Thoroughly clean plug before refitting.
Specification no. :
LSS- 05
Lubrication equipment:
Comments / notes :
**) For low temperature operation below ÷20 °C, special arctic oil is
recommended. Please contact relevant supplier for exact specification.
Ex.:
Statoil: HYDRAULIC OIL 131 For temp >÷40 °C < +65 °C
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-08 Drive 05 / 30.04.2009 1 of 1
pinion.doc
Specification no. :
LSS-08
Lubrication equipment:
General Instruction:
Use a brush to apply grease to all tooth flanks of pinions and gear ring.
For location of pinions, refer to the lubrication chart for the product in
question.
Typical properties:
Consistency: NLGI 2
Recommended temperatures: –30→110 °C (for Kluberplex AG 11-462)
Recommended temperatures: –3→150 °C (for Omega 73)
Recommended temperatures: –10→60 °C (for Texclad 2)
Comments / notes:
* : Not to be used in automatic grease pump system
The colour of AG 11-462 is white. Omega73 and Texclad 2 is black
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-11 Heavy duty 01 / 29.04.2009 1 of 1
grease.doc
Specification no. :
LSS-11
Lubricating equipment:
General Instruction:
Typical properties:
Method
Soap type: Calcium
Consistency: 2 NLGI
Oil type: Mineral
Base oil viscosity at 40 °C: 1300 mm²/s ISO 12058*
Base oil viscosity at 100 °C: 106 mm²/s ISO 12058*
Recommended temperatures: –20→120 °C
Long polymer (“tacky”) additives: Yes
Extreme pressure (EP) additives: Yes
Solid lubricants: No
*) Base oil viscosity applies to the final mixed oil including long polymer additives.
Blank page.
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-20 Winch with gear 03 / 29.04.2009 1 of 2
rim.doc
Specification no. :
LSS-20
Lubrication equipment:
General Instruction:
The winch has the following main components which need lubrication:
• A set of gearboxes
• Main bearings
• Wire rope
Comments / notes :
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-20 Winch with gear 03 / 29.04.2009 2 of 2
rim.doc
Lubrication Instruction:
Specification no. :
LSS-21
Lubrication equipment:
General Instruction:
• Bearing
(winch with one gearbox only)
• Wire rope
Comments / notes :
Maintenance system for MacGREGOR Hydramarine
products
Doc. ID. : Rev. / date : Page:
LSS-21 HM Winch 01 / 29.11.2006 2 of 2
without gear rim.doc
Lubrication Instruction:
Specification no:
LSS- 22
Lubrication equipment:
ELECTRIC MOTORS
50 / 60 Hz
General Instruction:
On Lønne motors the bearings should be relubricated every 3 years. This is due to ageing and
irrespective of operation hours. Motors operating under special conditions, such as frequent
operation at maximum speed (n max), heavy vibration, sudden load changes and frequent
reversing operation, the relubrication should be performed at a considerably shorter interval than
at the intervals stated below.
Supplie Manufactu Type Delivery Temp (0C) Mount. Interval Type / Amount Notes Notes
r rer with Ambient / Pos. (h) comp.
grease bearing for vert.
mount.
Lønne Marelli B5M355L Yes 20/50 Vertical 8000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
4 V36 30/60 (V3/V6) 4000 N3 increased by 15 bearing / greasing
45/80 First time greasing deg C, regreasing intervals are noted on a
2000
200 gr. interval halved plate on the motors
55/90 1000
Relubrication 50
gr.
Lønne MEZ 14BG1802 Yes 40 Vertical 4000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
80 V36 50 (V3/V6) 2000 N3 increased by 10K, bearing / greasing
regreasing interval intervals are noted on a
60 1000
Relubrication 20- halved plate on the motors with
30 gr. 40C and in standard
horizontally mounting
Lønne MEZ 14BG315 Yes 40 Vertical 3000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
V36 50 (V3/V6) 1500 N3 increased by 10K, bearing / greasing
60 regreasing interval intervals are noted on a
750
Relubrication 30 - halved plate on the motors with
40C and in standard
40 gr.
horizontally mounting
ABB ABB M3BP355 Yes 25 Vertical 2000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information regarding
V36 40 (V3/V6) 1000 N3 increased by 15 bearing / greasing
Relubrication 70 deg C, regreasing intervals are noted on a
gr. interval halved plate on the motors
Lønne MEZ 7AA/BA Yes 40 Vertical 4000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature
160 V36 50 (V3/V6) 2000 N3 increased by 10K,
60 1000 Relubrication 20- regreasing interval
30 gr. halved
Tp HUALI Y3- Yes 40 Horizo 4000 ESSO UNIREX Temperature Information
nordic 280M2-4 ntal N3 increased by 10- reg.bearing/greasing
15 deg.c, interval are noted on a
Relubrication 30- regreasing interval plate on the motor with
40 gr. halved. 40c and in standard
horiz.mount.
Comments / notes :
Only relubricate bearings when the motor has a speed of at least n >300 rpm.
Lubrication intervals are compensated for vertical mounting.
Smaller electrical motors normally have closed bearings. Relubrication may not
be required.
User Manual for Crane
1. General
The crane is fitted with an automatic lubrication system .The purpose of lubrication is to promote longer service
life for the equipment. The advantage of a automatic lubrication system is that it releases “a little grease
frequently”, as opposed to “too much grease infrequently”, which is often the case with manual lubrication.
2. System Overview
The system will efficiently provide lubrication for all bearings on king/main jib and knuckle jib. Grease is
stored in two container/pump units, and pumped/distributed out via several distribution blocks to each
individual lubrication point on the jib assembly among others. See picture 2 for typical installation of
container/pump unit.
The system itself is fairly simple and comprises a pump with a lubricant reservoir. The pump has 1-3 outlets,
which lead to progressive distributors (”distribution blocks”). These have one inlet port and several outlet ports.
The grease is distributed from the progressive distributor to the various lubrication points or to a new
distribution block on the crane. These distribution blocks are mechanical blocks that have been designed
according to the desired dosage. See pump unit M55 and M56 in Drawing, Vol. 2: 2.10 Lubrication Charts.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS B1
User Manual for Crane
In order for the adjustable element to receive the correct dose of lubricant, it is also important to set the pump
sequence. The adjustment screws are located behind a red cap at the front of the pump where the one set screw
is for setting the number of pump revolutions and the other is for setting the frequency of pump actuation. If the
pump setting is 30 revolutions and 30 minutes it means that the pump shall run 30 revolutions every 30 minutes
the pump has current.
The crane automatic lubrication system will also provide lubrication for the main winch bearings and main
winch drive pinions/gear wheel.
Safety valve.
(Do not cover)
Pump elements
6 Maintenance - Annex B
B2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
If the pump has no integrated timer / logics, it is controlled by the crane’s PLC.
Typical setup see picture 3. If the alarm is released frequently and no grease are released through the safety
valve, set Overload Time Before Alarm higher than 7 sec. The alarm can also be released when the Lubrication
monitor are mounted away from the pump unit.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS B3
User Manual for Crane
• Blockage in the progressive distributor due to a jammed slide/piston in an element can occur because of
contamination in the lubricant or because the element has been under counter pressure and unused for a
long time.
Action: Disconnect the outlet connections, start the pump and observe if lubricant is released trough the
safety valve. If not: replace the progressive distributor. If lubricant is released: replace the connectors
and check the next distributor or the element.
• High counter pressure due to long tubes/hoses. Install a check valve on the pump element outlet.
• Breakage/damage of a tube/hose. Lubricant leaking on a damaged hose or a pipe can occur without
realising the alarm. In consequence one or more lubricant points are not receiving lubricant. Inspect the
hoses regularly (3M).
7. Lubricant
It is important that the grease is pump-able in the system, even at low temperatures. The system has been
designed to use NLGI class 2 grease.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
B4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
filling socket
for grease coupling box
filling press
Filling the pump units (See Picture 4.) demands a high cleanliness level. Avoid any particles. Even the
slightest dirt can block the piston in the distributor blocks.
6 Maintenance - Annex B
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS B5
User Manual for Crane
10003724 M 06 LL NUT 10
6 Maintenance - Annex B
B6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
The automatic lubrication system (if applicable) delivers lubrication to nearly all critical rotation points.
Most of the manual lubrication points serve preservation purposes and not lubrication of a rotation bolt. Use
LSS-01. See Manual Lubrication Grease Nipples Chart in Vol. 2 of the user manual.
2. Preservation Points
According to the Periodic Maintenance Program (“preservation points”) lubricate the following points:
6 Maintenance - Annex C
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS C1
User Manual for Crane
3. Rotation Points
According to the Periodic Maintenance Program (“rotation points”) lubricate the following points:
Lubrication of hinges
Lubricate door hinges and other non critical lubrication points.
6 Maintenance - Annex C
C2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. Lift Wires
1.1. General
MacGregor HM offshore cranes uses the following
wire rope type(s):
1.2. Inspection
In order to keep wire ropes in a good working condition, routine inspections and periodic maintenance is
necessary. On wire ropes frequently used in AHC operations, particular attention must be paid at the areas
where they pass over a wire sheave as the wire rope strands have a tendency to open slightly and thus making it
possible for the inspector to get a better view of the wire rope core.
As a minimum, the wire ropes should be inspected monthly. However, lift wires in continuous service should
be observed during normal operation and visually inspected on a weekly basis.
The purpose of the inspection is to reveal dryness, abrasion, internal/external corrosion, core or strand
protrusion/distortion, wire breaks, wear, kinks etc. before the wire rope becomes unsafe to work with (see
illustrations on the following page of unwanted situations).
Note: Any deterioration leading to a suspected loss of original rope strength should be carefully examined and
the Discard criteria provided in ISO 4309 applied in determining whether to remove the rope from service.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS D1
User Manual for Crane
Wire protrusion.
External corrosion.
Kinked wire.
Local increase in rope diameter due to core distortion.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
D2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1.3. Lubrication
Over time, the factory lubrication of the wire ropes will wear off due to the environment and usage. Periodic
maintenance is therefore a necessity.
Manual lubrication with the aid of brushes, rags, gloves, or by other means is costly, risky, and ineffective. The
lubricant forms a film on the surface which water vapour can penetrate, thus becoming trapped. Temperature
changes cause condensation and rust then begins to form from the inside. This will lead to severe corrosion
which promotes premature fatigue failures in the wires and strands.
A high pressure wire lubrication system (e.g. Masto lubrication system) will be able to maintain good
lubrication of the wire rope, penetrating through to its core which is absolutely necessary to keep friction low
and corrosion away.
How often the wire ropes need to be re-lubricated depends on the environment in which the wire ropes operate
along with the usage and the result of the routine inspections. Generally, if the wire rope show signs of dryness,
lubrication should be initiated, ideally before. As a minimum, check every 3 month if the wire rope show signs
of lubrication deterioration.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS D3
User Manual for Crane
2. Lifting Hooks
2.1. Inspection
Every 4 years, the hook and hook nut are to be dismantled, inspected and retested (proof loaded). Particular
attention to be paid to the following:
• Wear in hook, centre pin, becket and threads in hook and nut.
• Play in sheave bushes or bearings.
• Spacer bolts, nuts and lynch pins.
• Check for cracks in welds.
• Condition of safety catch and grease nipples.
• Wear to holes in side plates and becket.
2.2. Lubrication
Lubrication of the hooks is normally to be done once a week (each week for frequently used hooks/blocks,
monthly for infrequently used equipment or each time it is used). Refer to the periodic maintenance table.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
D4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
4. Hazards
• Avoid skin contact with hydraulic oils by use of gloves.
• Be wary of any cuts that may be caused by running a hand carelessly across damaged wire. Use gloves.
• Ensure winch has been stopped before inspecting wire.
• When laying down the double part block on its side for lubrication, ensure the block is completely
secure as there can be a risk of it falling over.
6 Maintenance - Annex D
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS D5
User Manual for Crane
1. General
Inspection and replacement intervals should be done according to chapter 6.2 Periodic Maintenance.
Hydraulic hose manufacturers estimate that 80% of hose failures are attributable to external physical damage
through pulling, kinking, crushing or abrasion of the hose.
Hydraulic hose can and will age whether it is in normal service conditions or unused in storage. Hose failure is
not an indication of poor product performance, but rather natural degradation. After a while a hydraulic hose
will show sign of wear that include cracking, blisters and bubbles.
The operating conditions that a correctly installed hydraulic hose is subjected to will ultimately determine its
service life. Extremes in temperature, e.g. high daytime operating temperatures and very cold conditions when
the machine is standing at night, accelerates aging of the hose's rubber tube and cover.
• Environmental conditions.
• Ultraviolet light.
• Salt water.
• Air pollutants.
• Extreme temperatures.
• Ozone.
• Chemicals.
• Electricity.
• Abrasion damage.
6 Maintenance - Annex E
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS E1
User Manual for Crane
Abrasion caused by hoses rubbing against each other or surrounding surfaces is the most common type of
damage. Replace the hoses and avoid new abrasion and external damage, ensure all clamps are kept secure, pay
careful attention to routing whenever a replacement hose is installed and if necessary, apply inexpensive
polyethylene spiral wrap, zip tie, sleeves and guards to protect hydraulic hoses from abrasion (see photo below).
6 Maintenance - Annex E
E2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2. Replacement
MacGregor recommend to replace hoses at the following intervals:
Replacement of denso tape on hose connections after reinstallation is recommended to avoid corrosion.
Installation of a replaced hose at less than the minimum recommended bend radius may significantly reduce the
lifetime of the hose (see illustrations below). Particular attention must be given to prevent sharp bends at the
hose connection to the fitting (photo above).
Proper physical installation of the hose assembly requires a correctly installed port connection ensuring that no
twist or torque is transferred to the hose when the fittings are being tightened.
Bending a hydraulic hose in more than one plane results in twisting of its wire reinforcement. A twist of five
degrees can reduce the service life of a high-pressure hydraulic hose by as much as 70% and a seven degree
twist can result in a 90% reduction in service life.
6 Maintenance - Annex E
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS E3
User Manual for Crane
4. Hazards
• Ensure both the system and the specific damaged hose are devoid of pressure before attempting any
replacement. Removing hoses or tampering with damaged hoses while the system is under pressure can
result in a high pressure release of hydraulic oil.
• Clean the maintenance area before and after maintenance to avoid slippery surfaces and any
contamination.
• Remember to dispose of any damaged or unusable components in the correct manner, by taking them to
a recycling center that deals with the components in question.
6 Maintenance - Annex E
E4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
1.1. Before Disassembly
Prior to replacement of the hydraulic filters (for action intervals,
see section 6.2 - "Periodic Maintenance Program"), it is important
to make sure that the oil level in the tank is below the return filters
mounted on the tank top. These filters have contamination
retainers which might contain some particles. Lower the level in
the tank by lifting the main jib and the knuckle jib. This action
must be taken to reduce the risk of mixing unfiltered “dirty” oil
with the clean oil in the tank.
Then, shut down the HPU for at least 15 minutes. This will release
the pressure and drain oil to the tank. When applicable, press the
emergency (local) stop button.
Make sure you have the correct filters and sealings. MacGregor Return filter with
recommends to replace the O-rings each time the filters are replaced. contamination retainer(circled)
Most of the filters are located on the HPU (inside the king). However, they can also be placed outside on the
king platform or mounted on the winches. Normally, all filters (apart from the air breathers and emergency
supply filter) have clogged filter indicators (lights) and an alarm indication in the crane control system.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F1
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2. Breather Filters
Breather filters prevent contamination from the surroundings from entering
the system in connection with fluctuations of the oil level in the tank (tank
breathing).
Some filters are delivered as one unit but most commend are filters with
separate elements.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F3
User Manual for Crane
3. Offline Filter
Offline oil filtration systems with integrated circulating pumps are
ideal for controlling oil contamination levels for particles, water
and degradation products (oxidation resin/sludge, varnish). The
filters are normally mounted at the bottom of the tank and
circulates the oil in the tank.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Stop the CJC filter Close valve on the oil Close valve on the oil Automatic air vent: No Open oil drain valve.
pump inlet filter outlet action Drain according to
Air vent screw: Open environmental
screw precautions
When the filter housing Lift off the filter housing Unscrew the spring nut Remove the spring and Remove the used filter
is drained, unscrew the the spring guide inserts. Depose of
top nut according to regulations
Clean the filter bottom Put the new CJC filter Insert type B, BLA or Mount the spring guide Tighten the spring nut Replace both O-rings Replace O-ring for the Tighten the top nut with Automatic air vent: No Be aware that oil
inserts in place BLAT, use insert guide carefully - make sure by hand until contact top nut a torque of 90Nm action. spillage is a serious
between the filter there is no contact with spring guide. Then Air vent screw: Replace safety risk - keep clean!
elements between the O-ring and tighten the spring nut 4 usit ring for air vent
the thread turns per filter insert screw, and tighten with
torque of 10 Nm
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F5
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
4. Return Filters
These filters are normally low pressure filters.
The location are typically at the top of the
tank, but they can also be mounted as in-line
filters outside on the king platform or on the
winch itself.
1. Moisten the sealing surfaces and thread on the cover plate and housing, as well as the O-ring on the
cover plate and element, with clean operating fluid.
2. When fitting a new element, check that the designation corresponds to that of the old element.
3. Fit the contamination retainer onto the new or cleaned filter element by turning clockwise (only for type
1.0).
4. Place the filter element(s) carefully onto the element location spigot.
5. Screw on the cover plate fully. Then unscrew by one quarter-turn.
6. Screw in the oil drain screw(s); tighten the vent screw(s).
7. Switch on the hydraulic system and vent filter at an appropriate point in the system.
8. Check the filter for leakage.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F7
User Manual for Crane
Drain valve
4.3. Hazards
• Avoid skin exposure to hydraulic oil.
• Clean area before and after maintenance to
avoid slippery surfaces or contamination.
• Dispose of old filter appropriately by taking it to a recycling centre.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
F8 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
5. Pressure Filters
High-pressure filters are installed after the pumps and other prime movers to protect critical hydraulic
components such as cylinders, motors and valves.
1. Close the inlet and the outlet valve (if present). Ref. Hydraulic flow diagram.
2. Remove oil drain plug at the bottom of the bowl, collect oil in a container.
3. Unscrew bowl. (Collect fluid in a suitable container and dispose of it in accordance with environmental
regulations).
4. Remove filter element from element location spigot (examine surface of element for dirt residue and
larger particles; these can indicate damage to the components).
5. Clean bowl by using white sprite or similar.
6. Examine filter, especially sealing surfaces and threads, for mechanical damage.
7. Replace O–rings.
1. Moisten thread and sealing surfaces on the filter bowl and head, as well as the O–ring on the bowl and
element if necessary, with clean operating fluid.
2. When fitting a new element, check that the designation corresponds to that of the old element.
3. Place filter element carefully onto the element location spigot.
4. Screw in filter bowl fully.
5. Screw in oil drain plug.
6. Unscrew filter bowl by one quarter–turn.
7. IMPORTANT: Open Inlet and outlet valve
8. Clean/dry the outside of the filter bowl. After start-up of the hydraulic system again, check for any
leaks.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F9
User Manual for Crane
5.3. Hazards
• Clean area before and after maintenance to avoid slippery surfaces or contamination.
• Ensure valves are closed and system depressurised before performing any maintenance. If valves are
opened while the system is pressurised, high pressure hydraulic oil will be released.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
6. Drain Filters
The drain filters are normally located at the top of the tank, but can also be mounted outside on the platform or
on the winches. Three different drain filter types can occur:
1. Loosen cover plate bolts, turn and 1. Moisten sealing surfaces and thread on
remove the cover plate. the cover plate and housing, as well as
2. Remove filter element carefully from the O-rings on the cover plate and
element spigot. Examine element element, with clean hydraulic fluid.
surface for dirt residue and larger 2. When fitting a new element, check that
particles; these can indicate damage to the designation corresponds to that of the
the system components. old element.
3. Remove contamination retainer (if 3. Fit the contamination retainer (if present)
present) by turning anti-clockwise onto the new filter element by turning it
(bayonet fitting). clockwise.
4. Clean cover plate, housing and 4. Place filter element(s) carefully onto the
contamination retainer; pay particular element location spigot.
attention to the threads. 5. Re-fit cover plate and tighten cover plate
5. Examine filter, especially sealing bolts.
surfaces and thread, for mechanical 6. Switch on hydraulic system and Check
damage. filter for leakage.
6. Replace O-rings.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F11
User Manual for Crane
6.3. Hazards
• Avoid skin exposure to hydraulic oil.
• Clean area before and after maintenance to
avoid slippery surfaces or contamination.
• Dispose of old filter appropriately by taking it to a recycling centre.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
1. Verify that the HPU is not running. 1. Use clean hydraulic fluid to moisten
2. Close the inlet valves to the sealing surfaces and threads on the cover
replenishment pumps, normally located plate and housing, as well as the O-rings
on the tank wall. on the cover plate and element.
3. Close the outlet valve (if present). 2. When fitting a new element, check that
the designation corresponds to that of the
4. Open the air bleed plug on the top of the old element.
filter to make it easier to drain the oil.
3. Place filters element(s) carefully onto the
5. Drain the replenishment pump filters element location spigot.
with the valves at the bottom of the filter
houses. 4. Screw on cover plate fully and then
unscrew by one quarter-turn.
6. Unscrew top covers.
5. Close the drain valve and air bleed plug.
7. Remove filter element(s) from element
spigot. Examine element surface for dirt 6. IMPORTANT: Open the inlet and outlet
residue and larger particles; these can valves.
indicate damage to system components.
8. Clean cover plate and housing; pay Vent the filters:
particular attention to the threads.
1. Start the HPU and let the replenishment
9. Examine filter, especially sealing pump run for one minute.
surfaces and threads, for mechanical
2. Stop the HPU
damage.
3. Release carefully air bleed plug on top of
10. Replace O-rings and check seals.
the replenishment filter and bleed of all
air.
4. Close the air plug when the oil is floating
and no more air is bleeding.
5. Clean up, start HPU and check filters for
leakages
Replenishment filters
6 Maintenance - Annex F
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS F13
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex F
1. General
According to section 6.2 - "Periodic
Maintenance", the health of the hydraulic oil
in the system needs to be tested at a regular
basis. This is to be done by taking an oil
sample from the reservoir.
2. Bottle Cleanliness
Because of the extreme oil cleanliness levels, even the slightest dirt originating in a sample bottle can have an
adverse effect on the precision of the particle count. It is common to represent bottle contamination levels as the
number of particles greater than ten microns per millilitre (0.01 mm).
6 Maintenance - Annex G
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS G1
User Manual for Crane
3. How to Sample
1. The system should have normal operating temperature and flow conditions when taking an oil sample.
MacGregor recommends to operate the system for at least 30 minutes with actuators cycling prior to
talking samples. (If not possible to sample when the equipment is operating, sample as soon as safely
possible after shutdown to prevent the settling of contaminants).
2. Open the sampling valve and let at least one litre pass the ball valve tube. Collect the flushed fluid in a
container.
3. Use a 100 % clean standard analysis bottle (typical 500 ml) provided by a bottle supplier. Open the
sample bottle cap, taking care not to contaminate. Hold the cap in hand or place on a clean surface, face
down.
4. Fill the sample bottle about halfway, cap and shake well to flush the internal surface. Discard the fluid.
5. Fill the sample bottle again until the fluid level is about 1 cm (½”) from the top.
6. Cap the bottle immediately and then close the sampling valve.
7. Label the sample bottle with sample details, fill out the sample form and enclose both in the supplied
plastic container for transport.
4. Visual Analysis
Looking and smelling at hydraulic fluid is the simplest way to determine the fluid's condition. Clean fluid is
amber in color. A milky, dark, or otherwise abnormal color may indicate the presence of one or more
contaminants. A milky appearance implies contamination by water. If the fluid looks milky, take immediate
action to avoid severe damage to your hydraulic system.
A marked change in the smell of the hydraulic fluid can indicate a chemical breakdown. If a distinct change in
the smell of hydraulic fluid is detected, have it chemically analyzed by a commercial lab.
5. Type of Analysis
A minimum recommendation from MacGregor is to perform a particle and water analysis every 6 months,
whether you are conducting onsite particle counting, or relying on a commercial lab. A full oil analysis are
recommending to be done once a year. The analysis may include particle counter, water content, viscosity,
oxidation, iron, silicon and copper content.
6 Maintenance - Annex G
G2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
7. Hazards
• Avoid skin exposure to hydraulic oil. If exposed wash area with water and soap.
• Clean area before and after sample to avoid slippery surfaces or contamination of sample.
• Ensure bottle top of sample is secure.
6 Maintenance - Annex G
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS G3
User Manual for Crane
Blank Page.
6 Maintenance - Annex G
G4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
Instructions for pre-charging of both bladder and piston accumulators via an accumulator test and filling kit is
provided in this section. When checking or re-charging accumulator pressure, the test and filling kit provided by
MacGregor Norway AS must be used.
Note: When the accumulator is installed in a system, reduce the system pressure to 0.
12T Winch
WH-11.1, 12.1, 13.1, 14.1, 11.2, 12.2, 13.2, SP2552-2-L-XA-005 50 bar
14.2
Slew System
SH11, 12, 13, 14 SP2552-2-L-XA-004 6 bar
6 Maintenance - Annex I
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS I1
User Manual for Crane
2. Charging Procedures
2.1. Bladder Accumulator
• Attach the hexagonal connector (1) to the nitrogen bottle.
• Remove the gas valve protective caps from the accumulator. Secure the swivel connector (2) on the gas
valve and tighten sufficiently to prevent gas leakage. (Use adapter (5) on the accumulator for
installation of swivel connector on gas valve). Screw the bar handle (3) in a clockwise direction to open
the accumulator gas valve.
2 1
• Slowly open the nitrogen bottle valve until the expanding bladder closes the poppet valve. Check this
closure prior to charging to desired pressure.
• Close the nitrogen bottle valve. Wait for 5 minutes, before checking the pre-charge pressure. To lower
the pressure, open the air bleed valve (4).
• The Pre-charge pressure will drop slightly when the compressed gas cools off. Therefore, pre-charge to
20% above required pressure.
• Screw the bar handle (3) in a counter clockwise direction to close the gas valve. Use the air bleed valve
(4) to expel all gas from the pre-charging assembly. Remove the swivel connector (2) . (Remove the
adapter (5) if this has been used). Carefully test the gas connections for leakage by applying soapy
water or using leak detector in and around the gas valve area when the pre-charging is complete.
• Fit the gas valve protective caps.
• Remove the hexagonal connector (1) from the nitrogen bottle.
• Check the pre-charge after one, two and three weeks to ensure that no leakage has occurred. Further
pre-charge checks should be made every six months.
6 Maintenance - Annex I
I2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Note: Use nitrogen only! Compressed air and oxygen involve risk of explosion!
6 Maintenance - Annex I
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS I3
User Manual for Crane
2.4. Hazards
• Filling accumulators involves dealing with pressurised nitrogen which if handled incorrectly can result
in explosion. Experience personnel recommended.
• Check for damaged hoses, as working with damaged hoses can lead to release of pressurised gas.
• Ensure hose connections are secure.
6 Maintenance - Annex I
I4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. General
• Bolt inspection critical areas: Elongation, threads, cracks and tension.
• Inspect all slew ring bolts / nuts (bolts / nuts in place): 1 M / 500 H
• Perform “knock-test” of all slew ring bolts: 6 M / 500 H
• Initial re-tensioning of all bolts: 1 M after crane delivery
• Periodic re-tensioning of all bolts: 6 M / 500 H
• Removal and examination of individual bolts: 20 % of bolts annually*
* 20% of the bolts shall be removed and examined. The first 20% shall be taken in the most loaded sector of the
crane. If any significant defects are found during this examination another 20% are drawn. If any of this second
set is found to be defective then all bolts shall be drawn. If the first 20% are found to be acceptable the bolts can
be re-used and the next 20 % can be drawn the following year.
When refitting, all bolts shall be tensioned according to: HM doc. No: T0001.
1.1. Knock-Test
It is recommended to use a ball peen hammer and do a “knock test” on each bolt. In the event that a nut should
have become loose, the lack of tension in the bolt will generate a different sound during the knock test as
compared to the fully tensioned bolts. Loose nuts indicate that bolt must be re-tensioned according to HM doc.
no: T0001.
Note: At the 6’th month interval, the knock-test and re-tensioning can be performed every other time.
T0001 – Tightening Torques & Bolt Tensioning Forces: See the following pages.
6 Maintenance - Annex K
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS K1
User Manual for Crane
3. Hazards
• A safety harness is recommended if a ladder or lift is being used for re-tensioning.
6 Maintenance - Annex K
K2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
TECHNICAL REQUIREMENTS
This document and all information and data herein or herewith is the confidential and proprietary property of
MacGregor Norway AS and is not to be used, reproduced or disclosed in whole or in part by or to anyone without
the written confirmation from MacGregor Norway AS.
© MacGregor Norway AS
T0001 - 5
T:\Technical Requirements\
Title: BOLT SELECTION / TIGHTENING TORQUES / BOLT TENSIONING FORCES
Doc. No.: T0001
1 Applicability
The bolt selection in this document refers to how to select bolts and bolt quality in general
applications (e.g. winch assembly, gearbox assembly, etc.) and special applications (e.g. slew
ring bolts and nuts)
The tightening torques in this document applies to critical bolts specifically identified by the
drawing, technical specification/requirement or other document. See section 3.
The bolt tensioning forces (hydraulic tensioning) apply to all crane slewing ring bolts with
thread diameter M33 or larger. See section 4.
The tightening torques (section 3) are valid for standard, full-section, uncoated carbon steel (not
stainless) fasteners lubricated with anti-seize compound, such as Loctite 8009. These tightening torques
are also generally used for hot dip zinc coated fasteners, although such fasteners would require a
somewhat higher torque to achieve maximum clamping force. Source: Tingstad table T-18, lower left-
hand section.
2 Bolt/nut Selection
Selection of bolts/nuts for different assemblies and applications is normally done according to
material specification list on the relevant assembly drawing. Here the bolt size, type and quality
and number are specified. In addition to this, all bolts shall conform with and be tested in
accordance with a recognised standard e.g. pertinent part of ISO 898.
In general bolts are to be delivered according to DNV “Standard for certification of lifting
appliances Oct 2008, Ch. 2, Sec. 2, D400
Bolt connections are normally divided into three different groups; secondary, primary and
essential.
1. Secondary bolts are bolts in platforms, stairs, ladders, railings, installation of cabins and
cabinets etc. Bolts in this category are to be delivered with 2.2 works certificate and it is
T:\Technical Requirements\ Page 2 of 5
Title: BOLT SELECTION / TIGHTENING TORQUES / BOLT TENSIONING FORCES
Doc. No.: T0001
no requirement to charpy tests. Bolts smaller than M12 to be stainless steel A4 quality.
Bolts from M12 and up to be hot dip galvanised 8.8 quality.
2. Primary bolts are transferring structural loads and are elements in the primary load
carrying structure. Bolts in this category are to be delivered with 2.2 works certificates
and there it is no requirements to charpy tests. Bolts smaller than M12 to be stainless
steel A4 quality. Bolts from M12 and up to be hot dip galvanised 8.8 quality. If the
structural calculations show that an increased strength is required, 10.9 qualities may be
used.
3. Essential bolts are part of a non-redundant load path and a breakage may result in a
collapse or a serious mal-function. Bolts used in slew bearings are also considered as
essential. Bolts in this category are to be delivered with 3.1 certificates. If installed in a
slew bearing for offshore cranes, 3.2 certificates is required. Normally 8.8 or 10.9
qualities are used in this category. No higher than 10.9 quality is allowed. The
requirements to charpy test are given in DNV “Standard for certification of lifting
appliances Oct 2008, Ch. 2, Sec. 2, Table D4. Bolts with diameter less than Ø25mm has
no charpy test requirements. The requirements for bolts from Ø25mm are 42J for
offshore applications and 25J for other applications Test temperature (Td) is normally -
20 degC for offshore cranes and -10 degC for other cranes.
3 Tightening torques
Bolt tension forces including tolerances for "large-clearance metric thread" – DIN 2510 –
Sheet 2 – using hydraulic tension cylinders.
Preload the bolts with the advisable care crosswise to the specified values. It is possible to
calculate with a tightening factor of αA of 1.2 to 1.6, depending on the tightening method, and to
use the yield point of the bolt up to 90%.
The preload of the bolt tightened first is influenced by the tightening of the other bolts so that a
minimum of two passes is required.
This will at the same time compensate for the settling produced by the smoothing out of the
unloaded mating surface during preloading (thread and nut contact surface).
As the tension force applied in this method will not only cause elongation in the shaft but also in
the thread, it is important to choose the correct thread series or thread tolerances acc. to
DIN 2510. An inadequate thread clearance may cause jamming of the nut, when the bolt is
elongated. Taking into account the nut height, consultation with the bolts manufacturer is
absolutely necessary.
The bolts should be long enough to leave at least 1 · d above the nuts free for positioning the
tension cylinder.
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L1
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
In order to have comparable measurements it is important that the measurements are done in the exact same
slew positions each year and with the jibs in the same geometric position. The operator panel in the crane cabin
shows both jib and slew positions. These positions can be used for future reference.
The following table is to be used for recording measurements every 6 months following the initial
measurement. The accuracy of the measuring instrument is to be minimum ±0.01mm.
Depth micrometer
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L3
User Manual for Crane
The photo below shows measurement at one of the four measurement points on the crane pedestal. The
maximum allowable deviation is:
If the wear is found to have increased significantly, the time intervals between measurements should be
shortened. If the wear exceeds the given limit, consult MacGregor Marine Service.
*Deviations in flatness are measured in accordance with DIN EN ISO 1101 on the contact surfaces
**The value for increase in slack is a measurement of how much the hardened layers of the bearing are worn
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2 0
3 0
4 0
2 90
3 90
4 90
2 180
3 180
4 180
2 270
3 270
4 270
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L5
User Manual for Crane
Grease sampling:
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L6 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Tester:
Signature:
Date:
Grease
sample
result
6 Maintenance - Annex L
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS L7
User Manual for Crane
2. Hazards
• In order to measure correctly paint may need to be removed.
• For any necessary paint removal for correct measurements, use a paint removal chemical or paint
removal sand paper.
• Ensure adequate protection is used for working with paint removal.
• Use Tectyl rust preventative after measuring to prevent rust.
6 Maintenance - Annex L
L8 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Note: From early 2011, some cranes were equipped with tempered steel sheaves. For these cranes, the wire
sheave groove wear measurement is not applicable.
Obtaining good measurements of wire sheave groove wear will help the crane owner to apply appropriate
sheave maintenance actions in addition to providing relevant input to the crane maintenance schedule.
The wire sheave grooves include a two to three mm induction hardened layer beyond which the hardness
gradually decreases. The abrasion that the grooves are subject to can be monitored and understood by use of a
sliding gauge for measuring the depth of the groove. Measurements are taken to a tenth of a millimeter. Based
on the original inspection date, wear measurement trend analysis can be used to influence the measuring
schedule itself so that it continues to accurately indicate the health and future useful lifetime of the sheaves.
Groove Measuring
There are normally eight wire sheaves to be measured
(four for the main winch and four for the whip winch
wire). The measurement shall be taken at the same
reference position on the wire sheave every time. This is
to avoid "false" wear indications. The reference position
is normally marked on the wire sheave flange by means
of a sign plate (shown here by an arrow).
Operate the crane (rotate wire sheaves) to make the measuring point indicators on the wire
1
sheaves clearly visible and accessible.
Locate the mark (photo at previous page) which exactly indicates where the measurement should
2
be taken.
Perform depth measurement by means of a steel rule and a sliding gauge (or equivalent) to
3
measure the distance from top of flange to bottom of groove (photo below).
Record the measurement/deviation in the "wire sheaves log", an example of which is provided on
4
next page.
5 Repeat procedure for all wire sheaves.
Scheduled Maintenance
Due to the characteristics of wire sheave groove wear, it is recommended that the measuring frequency is set to
once every six months initially for a period of one year. Thereafter it will be at the crane owner's discretion to
adjust the maintenance schedule based on the previous depth measurements and the crane owner's inherent
technical experience and expertise.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
M2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
*Note: The table provided in this page is standardized. The amount of sheaves may differ from crane to crane.
The initial measurement value in the table above is the value for the first measurement taken for each individual wire sheave. If, upon receipt of this procedure,
the values are not already stated measurements should be carried out and logged in conjunction with the cranes’ Harbor Acceptance Test or equivalent.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS M1
User Manual for Crane
Blank Page.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
M2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
6 Maintenance - Annex M
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
2. Hazards
• Ensure to clean the area before measuring to achieve accurate results.
• If a lift or ladder is used it is advised to use a safety harness.
6 Maintenance - Annex M
M2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
• Open and check that the doors gaskets are in good condition (apply Vaseline, silicone, or similar if dry).
• Check regularly for water ingress, corrosion, damage, loose glands, and ambient conditions in excess of
the specifications.
Tighten all cable terminal Tighten all cabinet Check and clean the
connections and fuses bushings drain plug (if applicable)
VCI device
plate at JB
(see photo
Tighten all cable
below)
terminal connections
and fuses
6 Maintenance - Annex N
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS N1
User Manual for Crane
3. Hazards
• Ensure power is turned off before accessing electrical cabinet or junction box. This is in order to avoid
electrocution. Working with live wires is extremely dangerous.
6 Maintenance - Annex N
N2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
1. Inspection
1.1. General
The pressure transmitters have been calibrated to a certain pressure range, and sends a 4-20 mA signal,
corresponding to the calibrated range to an analogue input channel in the PLC system.
However, to secure correct pressure readings, an inspection of the most "essential" pressure transmitters must to
be done. MacGregor Norway recommend to do this at least every two years to verify accuracy and followed up
by a recalibration (often replacement) if needed.
The transmitters on active boost cranes which must be checked is listed in the table below, while those for semi-
active cranes are listed on the following page. In the tables, the name of the transmitter, its tag number and
maximum allowed deviation is provided.
Active Boost
For active boost cranes, the following pressure transmitters are evaluated to be "essential" and must be checked
frequently:
Main winch motor displacement pressure 2 -PT204B (or -PT205) 0.5 bar
6 Maintenance - Annex P
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS P1
User Manual for Crane
Semi-Active
For semi-active cranes, the following pressure transmitters are evaluated to be "essential" and must be checked
frequently:
* Whip winch displacement pressure (* if whip winch AHC) -PT260 0.5 bar
Other:
Replenishment pressure -PT203 2.0 bar
Recommended tools:
• Hand pump.
• T-joint (2x).
• Calibrated pressure transmitter (0-60 bar).
• Calibrated pressure transmitter (0-400 bar).
• Calibrated pressure transmitter (0-460 bar) for main pump transmitters.
• Portable data recorder / measurement device.
6 Maintenance - Annex P
P2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
After the transmitter is unplugged from the crane, testing is done in the following order:
Note: The pressure should be applied step by step between 5-10 bar. If the deviation exceeds the maximum
allowed value, the transmitter must be changed. The consequence of having too high deviation will differ from
transmitter to transmitter. Please contact MacGregor Norway for advice!
Transmitter to be tested
6 Maintenance - Annex P
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS P3
User Manual for Crane
2. Replacement
Replacement of pressure transmitters is done in the following order:
Required tools:
• Wrench/spanner - 27 mm.
4. Hazards
• Ensure system is depressurised.
• Clean area after maintenance to avoid slippery surfaces.
• Use drip tray.
6 Maintenance - Annex P
P4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Annex Q - Encoders
1. General
All pulse encoders must be inspected and checked for proper
function, damage and corrosion every 3M/500H, whichever
occur first. They are located the following places:
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS Q1
User Manual for Crane
2. Inspection
Inspection of a pulse encoder is done in the following order:
Required tools:
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
Q2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
3. Replacement
If a pulse encoder is damaged, it must be replaced. Replacement is a simple procedure which may be undertaken
by an electrician.
Required tools:
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS Q3
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
6 Maintenance - Annex Q
Q4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
System Maintenance Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign
Action
1
2
HYDRAULIC
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
6 Maintenance - Annex Z
MacGregor NORWAY AS Z1
User Manual for Crane
System Maintenance Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign
Action
20
MECHANICAL
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
6 Maintenance - Annex Z
MacGregor NORWAY AS Z2
User Manual for Crane
System Maintenance Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign. Date Comments Sign
Action
39
ELECTRICAL
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
6 Maintenance - Annex Z
MacGregor NORWAY AS Z3
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
Blank page.
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
2552-2-07MEC-LL01 LONG LEAD ITEMS 1,00 BOM ea 0
20927987 02 CABIN LEFT PLATFORM LEFT MAIN ASSY 1,00 BOM ea 2.421
20212294 01 CABIN PLATFORM 1,00 Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000310 04 NUT H.D.G 6,00 Service pcs 0
10001993 05 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 12,00 Service pcs 0
11026173 05 SLEW BEARING 1,00 Item pcs 0
31300012 05.C ABS PRODUCT CERTIFICATE 1,00 Service ea 0
10000253 06 WASHER A4 48,00 Service pcs 0
10000236 07 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 28,00 Service pcs 0
10000249 08 NUT A4-80 28,00 Service pcs 0
10000249 09 NUT A4-80 2,00 Service pcs 0
10005217 10 CIRCLIP 4,00 Item pcs 1
11009199 11 DISTANCE SPACER 4,00 Item ea 0
10002345 12 V-RING 4,00 Item pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11017189 07 LUBRICATION FITTINGS 14,00 Item pcs 0
11017149 08 LUBRICATION FITTINGS 8,00 Item pcs 0
11011011 09 LUBRICATION FITTINGS 5,00 Item ea 0
11011023 10 LUBRICATION FERRULE 2,00 Item pcs 0
11017156 11 LUBRICATION FERRULE 15,00 Item pcs 0
11017157 12 LUBRICATION FERRULE 17,00 Item pcs 0
11017185 13 LUBRICATION GUN 1,00 Item pcs 1
10003542 14 LUBRICATION HOSE 50,00 Item mtr 2
10004421 15 LUBRICATION HOSE 50,00 Item mtr 4
11000297 16 HYDRAULIC HOSE 5,00 Item mtr 2
11000451 17 DKO-L STRAIGHT COUPLING 4,00 Service pcs 0
10002973 18 Ø12 MM STAINLESS STEEL PIPE 18,00 Service mtr 0
11011026 19 LUBRICATION BLOCK SS 1,00 Item pcs 1
11024101 20 BOLT CAP 72,00 Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000273 03 BOLT 6,00 Service pcs 0
10000309 04 NUT H.D.G. 6,00 Service pcs 0
10003373 05 WASHER NORDLOCK ELZN 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000260 06 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 07 NUT H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000257 09 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000255 10 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
11003777 35 WASHER 63,00 Item ea 63
11003776 36 BOLT 63,00 Item ea 63
21073442 37 MANIFOLD 1,00 Item ea 38
10002393 38 CLAMP 2,00 Item pcs 2
10003375 39 WASHER NORDLOCK A4 8,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000258 04 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 05 NUT H.D.G. 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000256 06 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
20402022 04 PLATE 1,00 Item ea 0
10000315 05 WASHER H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000258 06 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 07 NUT H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10005217 24 CIRCLIP 8,00 Item pcs 1
11009996 25 SHACKLE 12,00 Item ea 1
11009522 26 TURNBUCKLE 12,00 Item ea 2
11009518 27 THIMBLE 12,00 Item ea 0
10000251 28 WASHER A4 6,00 Service pcs 0
10000211 29 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000247 30 NUT A4-80 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000253 31 WASHER A4 24,00 Service pcs 0
10000234 32 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 8,00 Service pcs 0
11004996 33 BUSH 1,00 Item ea 1
10003161 34 BUSH 1,00 Item ea 1
11010223 35 WIRE Ø8mm 120,00 Item mtr 29
10005628 36 V-RING 2,00 Item pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
20114646 02 DRUM 1,00 Item ea 0
20114669 03 FOUNDATION 1,00 Item ea 0
10000782 04 WASHER H.D.G. HARDENED 80,00 Service pcs 1
11012328 05 SOCKET HEAD BOLT 30,00 Item ea 12
11012327 06 SOCKET HEAD BOLT 44,00 Item ea 16
20016080 07 WIRE CLAMP 3,00 Item ea 3
10000316 08 WASHER H.D.G. 18,00 Service pcs 0
10000279 09 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 6,00 Service pcs 0
20114654 10 PLATE 1,00 Item ea 0
10000278 11 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 4,00 Item pcs 1
10000309 12 NUT H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11017074 16 BOLT BLACK STEEL 6,00 Item pcs 3
20124304 17 PLATE 2,00 Item ea 0
10000253 18 WASHER A4 6,00 Service pcs 0
10000233 19 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 6,00 Item pcs 0
10000270 20 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000354 21 WASHER H.D.G. HARDENED 4,00 Service pcs 0
11013241 22 BOLT SOCKET HEAD CAP BLACK STEEL 4,00 Item ea 0
10001437 40 CONSOLE 2,00 Item pcs 3
10002393 41 CLAMP 4,00 Item pcs 4
10000316 42 WASHER H.D.G. 16,00 Service pcs 0
10000272 43 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000309 44 NUT H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000236 45 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000249 46 NUT A4-80 8,00 Service pcs 0
10001438 47 DAMPER RING 2,00 Item pcs 1
20202336 48 CAMERA BRACKET ASSEMBLY 1,00 Item ea 2
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000258 07 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 08 NUT H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000225 09 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000252 10 WASHER A4 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000248 11 NUT A4-80 4,00 Service pcs 0
10007312 12 BUSH 2,00 Item pcs 0
10007311 13 CIRCLIP 1,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
31300016 01-C ABS CERTIFICATION 1,00 Service ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10006113 MH52 VALVE HOUSING 1,00 Item pcs 13
11004380 MH53 CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item ea 1
10001461 MH54 TEST COUPLING 10,00 Service pcs 1
11003748 MH55 FILTER,HIGH PRESSURE 1,00 Item ea 30
10007055 MH56 FILTER ELEMENT 1,00 Item pcs 1
10005908 MH57 BALL VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 6
10006115 MH58 SAE 6000 PSI MALE THREADED FLANGE COMPLETE 2,00 Service pcs 5
10000430 MH60 BALL VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 2
10000428 MH63 BALL VALVE 2,00 Service pcs 1
11107301 MH64 EMERGENCY PUMP 1,00 Item ea 21
10005411 MH65 PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 4
11022176 MH66 CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item ea 0
10002265 MH67 BALL VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
10001472 MH68 PRESSURE GAUGE 1,00 Service pcs 0
11108246 MH72 PROPORTIONAL VALVE 1,00 Item ea 0
11015955 MH76 PUMP BLOCK 1,00 Item ea 7
10000428 MH77 BALL VALVE 1,00 Service pcs 1
11016783 MH78 CABINET 400x600x220(WHD) 1,00 Item ea 17
21073442 MH82 MANIFOLD Item ea 0
10006248 MH83 CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
10000421 MH84 RESTRICTOR VALVE HS 06 1,00 Item pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000530 WH29 SHUTTLE VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
11002436 WH30 RELIEF VALVE 1,00 Item ea 0
11002437 WH31 VALVE HOUSING INC CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item ea 1
11016784 WH35 CABINET 800x800x325(WHD) 1,00 Item ea 42
10007029 WH36 PRESSURE REDUCING VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
10004716 WH37 VALVE HOUSING 1,00 Item pcs 1
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002500 -F10 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F11 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F12 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11008711 -F13 CIRCUIT BREAKER 6A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F14 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F15 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11005776 -F16 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 1pol C Item ea 0
11013597 -G01 POWER SUPPLY 10A Item ea 0
11012044 -H05 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11012044 -H06 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11012044 -H07 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11012043 -H12 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H12.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H12.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H12.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H12.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H12.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11012043 -H16 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H16.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H16.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H16.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H16.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H16.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11012043 -H18 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H18.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H18.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H18.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H18.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H18.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11007971 -HS117 COMPLETE_EM.STOP MOELLER Service ea 0
11008786 -K01 CONTACTOR 400A 3ph Item ea 0
11006311 -K01.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
11008786 -K02 CONTACTOR 400A 3ph Item ea 0
11006311 -K02.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
11012030 -K03 CONTACTOR 250A AC Item ea 0
11006311 -K03.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
11006311 -K03.2 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 18
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11008772 -K13 AUXILIARY CONTACT Item ea 0
11008769 -K13.1 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11008772 -K14 AUXILIARY CONTACT Item ea 0
11008769 -K14.1 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11008769 -K15 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11008772 -K15.1 AUXILIARY CONTACT Item ea 0
10009705 -K21 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K21.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K22 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K22.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K23 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K23.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K24 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K24.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K25 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K25.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K26 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K26.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K27 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K27.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K28 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K28.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K29 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K29.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K30 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K30.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K31 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K31.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K32 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K32.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
11006373 -K34 TIME RELAY 3-60s Item ea 0
11052050 -K37 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K37.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K38 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K38.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K39 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K39.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 19
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11013892 -K40 RELAY Item ea 0
11012052 -K40.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11008769 -K56 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11052050 -K91 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K91.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K92 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K92.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11006314 -P01 THERMISTOR OVERLOAD RELAY 230VAC Item ea 0
11006314 -P03 THERMISTOR OVERLOAD RELAY 230VAC Item ea 0
11006314 -P04 THERMISTOR OVERLOAD RELAY 230VAC Item ea 0
11011955 -P21 AMMETER Item ea 0
11013692 -P21.1 FRONT PROTECTION 48x48 Item ea 0
11007570 -P21.2 AMPMETER Item ea 0
11013692 -P21.3 FRONT PROTECTION 48x48 Item ea 0
11007570 -P23 AMPMETER Item ea 0
11013692 -P23.1 FRONT PROTECTION 48x48 Item ea 0
11002190 -P31 HOUR COUNTER 50/60Hz DIN MOUNTED Item ea 0
11012863 -Q01 CIRCUIT BREAKER 3P Item ea 0
11011648 -Q03 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11007530 -Q03.1 MOTOR PROTECTIVE BREAKER 4,0-6,3A Item ea 0
11011648 -Q04 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11011647 -Q04.1 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11011648 -Q06 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11003506 -Q06.1 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER 1-1,6A Item ea 0
11012520 -Q13 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11012520 -Q14 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11011658 -Q15 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11013762 -R10 ENCLOSURE HEATER 800W Item ea 0
11002517 -S1.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S1.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S1.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002518 -S13 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S13.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S13.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S16 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S16.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S16.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 20
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002518 -S19 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S19.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S19.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002535 -S20 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S20.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S20.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S20.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -S20.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11012620 -SB1 ENCLOSURE INTERNAL THERMOSTAT Item ea 0
11012620 -SB2 ENCLOSURE INTERNAL THERMOSTAT Item ea 0
11107397 -STARTER CABINET
STARTER CABINET 1,00 Item ea 0
11012046 -T01 EARTH FAULT TRANSFORMER/BRUK 11014414 Item ea 0
11012046 -T02 EARTH FAULT TRANSFORMER/BRUK 11014414 Item ea 0
11012047 -T03 CURRENT TRANSFORMER Item ea 0
11011954 -T04 CURRENT TRANSFORMER 400-5A Item ea 0
11007574 -T06 CURRENT TRANSFORMER 50/5A Item ea 0
11008904 -U01 MONITORING RELAY Item ea 0
11012870 -U27 EARTH FAULT MONITORING Item ea 0
11108967 -UL01 UPS 3000VA 2x156-280VAC Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105973 -X10.1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X12 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009080 -X34 PHOENIX CAT Item ea 0
11105973 -X44 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X6 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -XA TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105973 -XA.1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11107002 -XA.2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -XP20 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -XP25 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11007963 -F2.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11012043 -H02 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H02.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H02.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H02.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H02.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H02.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11007972 -HS116 COMPLETE_EM.STOP_WITHOUT_CAGE MOELLER Item ea 0
11002623 -HS116.1 PROTECTION CAGE FOR EM. STOP Service ea 0
11006372 -K01 CONTACTOR 50A 3ph Item ea 0
11006311 -K01.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
10009705 -K02 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K02.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K91 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K91.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
11012452 -Q01 CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11011648 -Q01.1 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11007530 -Q02 MOTOR PROTECTIVE BREAKER 4,0-6,3A Item ea 0
11012044 -S01 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11002518 -S02 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S02.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S02.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11107400 -STARTER CABINET
STARTER CABINET 1,00 Item ea 0
11007528 -T1 TRANSFORMER 660-690V/230V 180VA Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X6 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11012033 -K01.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10008122 -K3 RELAY 24VDC 2xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K5 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K6 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K7 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL 1,00 Item pcs 0
11012000 -OP206 PORTABLE CONTROL STATION Item ea 0
11007975 -S01 COMPLETE_STOP MOELLER Service ea 0
11002524 -S01.1 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002535 -S03 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S03.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S03.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S03.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -S03.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11105958 -X12 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11013597 -A35.1 POWER SUPPLY 10A Item ea 0
11009669 -A35.2 UPS UNIT 24V/6A Item ea 0
11009675 -A35.3 UPS BATTERY MODULE 7Ah Item ea 0
10007473 -D01 BUS CONNECTOR Item pcs 0
11012118 -D01.1 CPU 319-3-PN/DP USE 11013465 Item ea 0
11108900 -D01.2 MEMORY CARD Item ea 0
10005726 -D02 SM321 32DI/24VDC Item pcs 0
11002451 -D02.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 40-PIN Item ea 0
11002446 -D03 16 DIGITAL OUTPUT Item ea 0
11002451 -D03.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 40-PIN Item ea 0
11000573 -D04 8 CH AI SM331 Item ea 0
11002450 -D04.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 20PIN Item ea 0
11000573 -D05 8 CH AI SM331 Item ea 0
11002450 -D05.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 20PIN Item ea 0
11005840 -D06 ANALOG OUTPUT 8ch Item ea 0
11002450 -D06.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 20PIN Item ea 0
11012940 -D07 FM350-1 COUNTER MODULE Item ea 0
11002271 -D100 RS 485 REPEATER Item ea 0
10006834 -D100.1 PROFIBUS CONNECTOR 90DEG Item pcs 0
11002271 -D200 RS 485 REPEATER Item ea 0
10006834 -D200.1 PROFIBUS CONNECTOR 90DEG Item pcs 0
11002271 -D201 RS 485 REPEATER Item ea 0
11107316 -D50 PC Item ea 0
11107126 -D50.1 SOFTWARE LISENS Item ea 0
11109037 -D50.2 WINDOWS 7 PROFESSIONAL 1,00 Item ea 0
11109043 -D50.3 MEMORY 1,00 Item ea 0
11109044 -D50.4 MINI PCIE HALF CARD 1,00 Item ea 0
11109045 -D50.5 HARD DISK 1,00 Item ea 0
11011838 -E21 UNI SWITCH Item ea 0
11002500 -F01 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F02 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F03 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11008692 -F04 CIRCUIT BREAKER 20A 1pol C Item ea 0
11005776 -F05 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 1pol C Item ea 0
11007962 -F06 FUSE PLUG WITH LED Item ea 0
11007963 -F06.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
12000127 -G01 SITOP POWER SUPPLY 24VDC 20A Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 24
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11007477 -G02 FLEXI POWER SUPPLY 230V/3-50VDC 120W Item ea 0
11108990 -HB001 TOUCHMONITOR Item ea 0
11011943 -HB001.2 STEERING ARM Item ea 0
11108991 -HB001.3 CABLE Item ea 0
11011859 -HS101 SWITCH 20A 3POL Item ea 0
10008121 -K01-K10 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K11 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
11012052 -K11.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K12 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K12.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
10008122 -K13-K16 RELAY 24VDC 2xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008122 -K17 RELAY 24VDC 2xNO FOR RAIL 1,00 Item pcs 0
10008121 -K18 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL 1,00 Item pcs 0
11013903 -K44 RELAY Item ea 0
11052050 -K51 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K51.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11011853 -K90 SAFETY RELAY Item ea 0
11052050 -K91 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K91.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K92 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K92.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K93 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K93.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11006283 -RC105 LCD DISPLAY 7" INCL 10M CABLE Item ea 0
11052039 -S01 CIRCUIT BREAKER 32A 3P C Item ea 0
11014193 -U103 REMOTE ACCESS ROUTER Item ea 0
10005061 -U43 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U43.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U43.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005061 -U44 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U44.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U44.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005061 -U45 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U45.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U45.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005061 -U46 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U46.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 25
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11001114 -U46.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005060 -U50 VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10008130 -U50.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U50.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
11014174 -U61 ETHERNET SWITCH Item ea 0
11012665 -U66 EXTENDER XGA 1:3 Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X1.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105973 -X10.1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009094 -X10.2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X12 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X121 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X13 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X14 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X2 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X3 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009080 -X30 PHOENIX CAT Item ea 0
11105975 -X301 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009080 -X33 PHOENIX CAT Item ea 0
11105958 -XB TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -XP20 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11007963 -XP22 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11007963 -XP23 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -XP25 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11008782 -XS01 SOCKET OUTLET DIN-MOUNTED Service ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11007971 -HS102 COMPLETE_EM.STOP MOELLER Service ea 0
11002535 -HS103 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS103.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS103.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS103.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS103.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11012821 -HS110 PUSH BUTTON BLUE Item ea 0
11002517 -HS110.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -HS110.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -HS110.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS110.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS110.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002524 -HS100.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS100.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002535 -HS101 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS101.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS101.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS101.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS101.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11006178 -HS104 MUSHROOM STAY-PUT BUTTON YELLOW Item ea 0
11002517 -HS104.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002524 -HS104.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS104.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002518 -HS104.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS104.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002623 -HS104.6 PROTECTION CAGE FOR EM. STOP Service ea 0
11008446 -HS111 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS111.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS111.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS111.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS111.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS111.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS111.6 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11008446 -HS112 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS112.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS112.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS112.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS112.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS112.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS112.6 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11008446 -HS113 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS113.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS113.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS113.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS113.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS113.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS113.6 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002535 -HS114 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS114.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 28
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002518 -HS114.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS114.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS114.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11012178 -JU101 KOMPLETT VHF/UHF/FM/CD Item ea 0
11013821 -K02 CONTACTOR Item ea 0
11052050 -K03 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K03.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K04 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K04.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11013822 -K05 RELAY Item ea 0
11002521 -PB2 PUSH BUTTON BLACK Item ea 0
11002517 -PB2.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -PB2.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -PB2.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -PB2.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002521 -PB3 PUSH BUTTON BLACK Item ea 0
11002517 -PB3.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -PB3.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -PB3.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -PB3.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002521 -PB4 PUSH BUTTON BLACK Item ea 0
11002517 -PB4.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -PB4.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -PB4.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -PB4.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002535 -S2 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S2.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S2.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S2.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -S2.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11107194 -T1 ROOM CONTROLLER Item ea 0
11002529 -UA102 BUZZER 18-30V AC/DC Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009094 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X10.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X14 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 29
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11105958 -X3 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11108935 -CABIN CABIN COMPLETE 1,00 Item ea 1.600
11107402 -CONTROL CABIN
CONTROL SYSTEM CABIN 1,00 Item ea 0
11108930 -HC200 GAS DETECTOR Item ea 0
11108939 -JU104 TELEPHONE 1,00 Item ea 0
11108931 -JU105A LOUDSPEAKER 1,00 Item ea 0
11108931 -JU105B LOUDSPEAKER 1,00 Item ea 0
11107195 -ME1 FAN Item ea 0
11107196 -R1 AIR DUCT HEATER Item ea 0
11107196 -R2 AIR DUCT HEATER Item ea 0
11026089 -RESCUE SAFETY & RESCUE EQUIPMENT 1,00 Item pcs 4
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11105958 -X2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X3 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11011792 -RC101 CAMERA COLOUR CCC102 1,00 Item ea 0
11006285 -RC101.1 FEMALE CONNECTOR 1,00 Item ea 0
11006284 -RC101.2 MALE CONNECTOR 1,00 Item ea 0
11001752 -ZT204 MULTITURN ENCODER 1,00 Item ea 1
Blank page.
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
MacGregor Norway AS Page 1
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
2552-2-07MEC-LL01 LONG LEAD ITEMS 1,00 BOM ea 0
20927987 02 CABIN LEFT PLATFORM LEFT MAIN ASSY 1,00 BOM ea 2.421
20212294 01 CABIN PLATFORM 1,00 Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000310 04 NUT H.D.G 6,00 Service pcs 0
10001993 05 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 12,00 Service pcs 0
11026173 05 SLEW BEARING 1,00 Item pcs 0
31300012 05.C ABS PRODUCT CERTIFICATE 1,00 Service ea 0
10000253 06 WASHER A4 48,00 Service pcs 0
10000236 07 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 28,00 Service pcs 0
10000249 08 NUT A4-80 28,00 Service pcs 0
10000249 09 NUT A4-80 2,00 Service pcs 0
10005217 10 CIRCLIP 4,00 Item pcs 1
11009199 11 DISTANCE SPACER 4,00 Item ea 0
10002345 12 V-RING 4,00 Item pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11017189 07 LUBRICATION FITTINGS 14,00 Item pcs 0
11017149 08 LUBRICATION FITTINGS 8,00 Item pcs 0
11011011 09 LUBRICATION FITTINGS 5,00 Item ea 0
11011023 10 LUBRICATION FERRULE 2,00 Item pcs 0
11017156 11 LUBRICATION FERRULE 15,00 Item pcs 0
11017157 12 LUBRICATION FERRULE 17,00 Item pcs 0
11017185 13 LUBRICATION GUN 1,00 Item pcs 1
10003542 14 LUBRICATION HOSE 50,00 Item mtr 2
10004421 15 LUBRICATION HOSE 50,00 Item mtr 4
11000297 16 HYDRAULIC HOSE 5,00 Item mtr 2
11000451 17 DKO-L STRAIGHT COUPLING 4,00 Service pcs 0
10002973 18 Ø12 MM STAINLESS STEEL PIPE 18,00 Service mtr 0
11011026 19 LUBRICATION BLOCK SS 1,00 Item pcs 1
11024101 20 BOLT CAP 72,00 Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000273 03 BOLT 6,00 Service pcs 0
10000309 04 NUT H.D.G. 6,00 Service pcs 0
10003373 05 WASHER NORDLOCK ELZN 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000260 06 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 07 NUT H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000257 09 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000255 10 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
11003777 35 WASHER 63,00 Item ea 63
11003776 36 BOLT 63,00 Item ea 63
21073442 37 MANIFOLD 1,00 Item ea 38
10002393 38 CLAMP 2,00 Item pcs 2
10003375 39 WASHER NORDLOCK A4 8,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000258 04 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 05 NUT H.D.G. 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000256 06 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
20402022 04 PLATE 1,00 Item ea 0
10000315 05 WASHER H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000258 06 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 07 NUT H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10005217 24 CIRCLIP 8,00 Item pcs 1
11009996 25 SHACKLE 12,00 Item ea 1
11009522 26 TURNBUCKLE 12,00 Item ea 2
11009518 27 THIMBLE 12,00 Item ea 0
10000251 28 WASHER A4 6,00 Service pcs 0
10000211 29 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000247 30 NUT A4-80 3,00 Service pcs 0
10000253 31 WASHER A4 24,00 Service pcs 0
10000234 32 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 8,00 Service pcs 0
11004996 33 BUSH 1,00 Item ea 1
10003161 34 BUSH 1,00 Item ea 1
11010223 35 WIRE Ø8mm 120,00 Item mtr 29
10005628 36 V-RING 2,00 Item pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
20114646 02 DRUM 1,00 Item ea 0
20114669 03 FOUNDATION 1,00 Item ea 0
10000782 04 WASHER H.D.G. HARDENED 80,00 Service pcs 1
11012328 05 SOCKET HEAD BOLT 30,00 Item ea 12
11012327 06 SOCKET HEAD BOLT 44,00 Item ea 16
20016080 07 WIRE CLAMP 3,00 Item ea 3
10000316 08 WASHER H.D.G. 18,00 Service pcs 0
10000279 09 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 6,00 Service pcs 0
20114654 10 PLATE 1,00 Item ea 0
10000278 11 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 4,00 Item pcs 1
10000309 12 NUT H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11017074 16 BOLT BLACK STEEL 6,00 Item pcs 3
20124304 17 PLATE 2,00 Item ea 0
10000253 18 WASHER A4 6,00 Service pcs 0
10000233 19 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 6,00 Item pcs 0
10000270 20 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000354 21 WASHER H.D.G. HARDENED 4,00 Service pcs 0
11013241 22 BOLT SOCKET HEAD CAP BLACK STEEL 4,00 Item ea 0
10001437 40 CONSOLE 2,00 Item pcs 3
10002393 41 CLAMP 4,00 Item pcs 4
10000316 42 WASHER H.D.G. 16,00 Service pcs 0
10000272 43 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000309 44 NUT H.D.G. 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000236 45 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 8,00 Service pcs 0
10000249 46 NUT A4-80 8,00 Service pcs 0
10001438 47 DAMPER RING 2,00 Item pcs 1
20202336 48 CAMERA BRACKET ASSEMBLY 1,00 Item ea 2
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000258 07 BOLT HEX HEAD H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000308 08 NUT H.D.G. 2,00 Service pcs 0
10000225 09 BOLT HEX HEAD A4-80 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000252 10 WASHER A4 4,00 Service pcs 0
10000248 11 NUT A4-80 4,00 Service pcs 0
10007312 12 BUSH 2,00 Item pcs 0
10007311 13 CIRCLIP 1,00 Service pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
31300016 01-C ABS CERTIFICATION 1,00 Service ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10006113 MH52 VALVE HOUSING 1,00 Item pcs 13
11004380 MH53 CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item ea 1
10001461 MH54 TEST COUPLING 10,00 Service pcs 1
11003748 MH55 FILTER,HIGH PRESSURE 1,00 Item ea 30
10007055 MH56 FILTER ELEMENT 1,00 Item pcs 1
10005908 MH57 BALL VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 6
10006115 MH58 SAE 6000 PSI MALE THREADED FLANGE COMPLETE 2,00 Service pcs 5
10000430 MH60 BALL VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 2
10000428 MH63 BALL VALVE 2,00 Service pcs 1
11107301 MH64 EMERGENCY PUMP 1,00 Item ea 21
10005411 MH65 PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 4
11022176 MH66 CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item ea 0
10002265 MH67 BALL VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
10001472 MH68 PRESSURE GAUGE 1,00 Service pcs 0
11108246 MH72 PROPORTIONAL VALVE 1,00 Item ea 0
11015955 MH76 PUMP BLOCK 1,00 Item ea 7
10000428 MH77 BALL VALVE 1,00 Service pcs 1
11016783 MH78 CABINET 400x600x220(WHD) 1,00 Item ea 17
21073442 MH82 MANIFOLD Item ea 0
10006248 MH83 CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
10000421 MH84 RESTRICTOR VALVE HS 06 1,00 Item pcs 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
10000530 WH29 SHUTTLE VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
11002436 WH30 RELIEF VALVE 1,00 Item ea 0
11002437 WH31 VALVE HOUSING INC CHECK VALVE 1,00 Item ea 1
11016784 WH35 CABINET 800x800x325(WHD) 1,00 Item ea 42
10007029 WH36 PRESSURE REDUCING VALVE 1,00 Item pcs 0
10004716 WH37 VALVE HOUSING 1,00 Item pcs 1
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002500 -F10 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F11 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F12 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11008711 -F13 CIRCUIT BREAKER 6A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F14 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F15 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11005776 -F16 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 1pol C Item ea 0
11013597 -G01 POWER SUPPLY 10A Item ea 0
11012044 -H05 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11012044 -H06 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11012044 -H07 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11012043 -H12 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H12.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H12.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H12.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H12.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H12.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11012043 -H16 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H16.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H16.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H16.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H16.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H16.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11012043 -H18 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H18.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H18.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H18.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H18.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H18.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11007971 -HS117 COMPLETE_EM.STOP MOELLER Service ea 0
11008786 -K01 CONTACTOR 400A 3ph Item ea 0
11006311 -K01.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
11008786 -K02 CONTACTOR 400A 3ph Item ea 0
11006311 -K02.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
11012030 -K03 CONTACTOR 250A AC Item ea 0
11006311 -K03.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
11006311 -K03.2 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 18
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11008772 -K13 AUXILIARY CONTACT Item ea 0
11008769 -K13.1 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11008772 -K14 AUXILIARY CONTACT Item ea 0
11008769 -K14.1 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11008769 -K15 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11008772 -K15.1 AUXILIARY CONTACT Item ea 0
10009705 -K21 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K21.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K22 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K22.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K23 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K23.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K24 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K24.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K25 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K25.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K26 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K26.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K27 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K27.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K28 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K28.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K29 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K29.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K30 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K30.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K31 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K31.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K32 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K32.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
11006373 -K34 TIME RELAY 3-60s Item ea 0
11052050 -K37 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K37.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K38 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K38.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K39 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K39.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 19
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11013892 -K40 RELAY Item ea 0
11012052 -K40.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11008769 -K56 CONTACTOR 230VAC 3PHASE 9A 1NO Item ea 0
11052050 -K91 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K91.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K92 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K92.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11006314 -P01 THERMISTOR OVERLOAD RELAY 230VAC Item ea 0
11006314 -P03 THERMISTOR OVERLOAD RELAY 230VAC Item ea 0
11006314 -P04 THERMISTOR OVERLOAD RELAY 230VAC Item ea 0
11011955 -P21 AMMETER Item ea 0
11013692 -P21.1 FRONT PROTECTION 48x48 Item ea 0
11007570 -P21.2 AMPMETER Item ea 0
11013692 -P21.3 FRONT PROTECTION 48x48 Item ea 0
11007570 -P23 AMPMETER Item ea 0
11013692 -P23.1 FRONT PROTECTION 48x48 Item ea 0
11002190 -P31 HOUR COUNTER 50/60Hz DIN MOUNTED Item ea 0
11012863 -Q01 CIRCUIT BREAKER 3P Item ea 0
11011648 -Q03 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11007530 -Q03.1 MOTOR PROTECTIVE BREAKER 4,0-6,3A Item ea 0
11011648 -Q04 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11011647 -Q04.1 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11011648 -Q06 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11003506 -Q06.1 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER 1-1,6A Item ea 0
11012520 -Q13 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11012520 -Q14 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11011658 -Q15 MOTOR PROTECTIVE CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11013762 -R10 ENCLOSURE HEATER 800W Item ea 0
11002517 -S1.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S1.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S1.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002518 -S13 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S13.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S13.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S16 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S16.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S16.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 20
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002518 -S19 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S19.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S19.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002535 -S20 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S20.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S20.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S20.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -S20.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11012620 -SB1 ENCLOSURE INTERNAL THERMOSTAT Item ea 0
11012620 -SB2 ENCLOSURE INTERNAL THERMOSTAT Item ea 0
11107397 -STARTER CABINET
STARTER CABINET 1,00 Item ea 0
11012046 -T01 EARTH FAULT TRANSFORMER/BRUK 11014414 Item ea 0
11012046 -T02 EARTH FAULT TRANSFORMER/BRUK 11014414 Item ea 0
11012047 -T03 CURRENT TRANSFORMER Item ea 0
11011954 -T04 CURRENT TRANSFORMER 400-5A Item ea 0
11007574 -T06 CURRENT TRANSFORMER 50/5A Item ea 0
11008904 -U01 MONITORING RELAY Item ea 0
11012870 -U27 EARTH FAULT MONITORING Item ea 0
11108967 -UL01 UPS 3000VA 2x156-280VAC Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105973 -X10.1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X12 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009080 -X34 PHOENIX CAT Item ea 0
11105973 -X44 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X6 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -XA TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105973 -XA.1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11107002 -XA.2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -XP20 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -XP25 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11007963 -F2.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11012043 -H02 SWITCH 2POS W/LIGTH Item ea 0
11002517 -H02.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11003505 -H02.2 LED ELEMENT BLUE 12-30VAC/DC FRONT FIX Item ea 0
11002518 -H02.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11001858 -H02.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -H02.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11007972 -HS116 COMPLETE_EM.STOP_WITHOUT_CAGE MOELLER Item ea 0
11002623 -HS116.1 PROTECTION CAGE FOR EM. STOP Service ea 0
11006372 -K01 CONTACTOR 50A 3ph Item ea 0
11006311 -K01.1 AUX. CONTACTOR BLOCK 2NO+2NC Item ea 0
10009705 -K02 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K02.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10009705 -K91 RELAY 24V DC Item pcs 0
11012033 -K91.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
11012452 -Q01 CIRCUIT BREAKER Item ea 0
11011648 -Q01.1 AUXILIARY CONTACT 1NO 1NC MOUNT RIGHT SIDE CIRC.BRItem ea 0
11007530 -Q02 MOTOR PROTECTIVE BREAKER 4,0-6,3A Item ea 0
11012044 -S01 PUSH BUTTON WITH LAMP Item ea 0
11002518 -S02 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11008446 -S02.1 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S02.2 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11107400 -STARTER CABINET
STARTER CABINET 1,00 Item ea 0
11007528 -T1 TRANSFORMER 660-690V/230V 180VA Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X6 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11012033 -K01.1 CHANGEOVER RELAY SOCKET Item ea 0
10008122 -K3 RELAY 24VDC 2xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K5 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K6 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K7 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL 1,00 Item pcs 0
11012000 -OP206 PORTABLE CONTROL STATION Item ea 0
11007975 -S01 COMPLETE_STOP MOELLER Service ea 0
11002524 -S01.1 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002535 -S03 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S03.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S03.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S03.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -S03.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11105958 -X12 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11013597 -A35.1 POWER SUPPLY 10A Item ea 0
11009669 -A35.2 UPS UNIT 24V/6A Item ea 0
11009675 -A35.3 UPS BATTERY MODULE 7Ah Item ea 0
10007473 -D01 BUS CONNECTOR Item pcs 0
11012118 -D01.1 CPU 319-3-PN/DP USE 11013465 Item ea 0
11108900 -D01.2 MEMORY CARD Item ea 0
10005726 -D02 SM321 32DI/24VDC Item pcs 0
11002451 -D02.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 40-PIN Item ea 0
11002446 -D03 16 DIGITAL OUTPUT Item ea 0
11002451 -D03.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 40-PIN Item ea 0
11000573 -D04 8 CH AI SM331 Item ea 0
11002450 -D04.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 20PIN Item ea 0
11000573 -D05 8 CH AI SM331 Item ea 0
11002450 -D05.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 20PIN Item ea 0
11005840 -D06 ANALOG OUTPUT 8ch Item ea 0
11002450 -D06.1 FRONT CONNECTOR 20PIN Item ea 0
11012940 -D07 FM350-1 COUNTER MODULE Item ea 0
11002271 -D100 RS 485 REPEATER Item ea 0
10006834 -D100.1 PROFIBUS CONNECTOR 90DEG Item pcs 0
11002271 -D200 RS 485 REPEATER Item ea 0
10006834 -D200.1 PROFIBUS CONNECTOR 90DEG Item pcs 0
11002271 -D201 RS 485 REPEATER Item ea 0
11107316 -D50 PC Item ea 0
11107126 -D50.1 SOFTWARE LISENS Item ea 0
11109037 -D50.2 WINDOWS 7 PROFESSIONAL 1,00 Item ea 0
11109043 -D50.3 MEMORY 1,00 Item ea 0
11109044 -D50.4 MINI PCIE HALF CARD 1,00 Item ea 0
11109045 -D50.5 HARD DISK 1,00 Item ea 0
11011838 -E21 UNI SWITCH Item ea 0
11002500 -F01 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F02 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11002500 -F03 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 2pol C Item ea 0
11008692 -F04 CIRCUIT BREAKER 20A 1pol C Item ea 0
11005776 -F05 CIRCUIT BREAKER 10A 1pol C Item ea 0
11007962 -F06 FUSE PLUG WITH LED Item ea 0
11007963 -F06.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
12000127 -G01 SITOP POWER SUPPLY 24VDC 20A Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 24
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11007477 -G02 FLEXI POWER SUPPLY 230V/3-50VDC 120W Item ea 0
11108990 -HB001 TOUCHMONITOR Item ea 0
11011943 -HB001.2 STEERING ARM Item ea 0
11108991 -HB001.3 CABLE Item ea 0
11011859 -HS101 SWITCH 20A 3POL Item ea 0
10008121 -K01-K10 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008121 -K11 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
11012052 -K11.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K12 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K12.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
10008122 -K13-K16 RELAY 24VDC 2xNO FOR RAIL Item pcs 0
10008122 -K17 RELAY 24VDC 2xNO FOR RAIL 1,00 Item pcs 0
10008121 -K18 RELAY 24VDC 1xNO FOR RAIL 1,00 Item pcs 0
11013903 -K44 RELAY Item ea 0
11052050 -K51 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K51.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11011853 -K90 SAFETY RELAY Item ea 0
11052050 -K91 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K91.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K92 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K92.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K93 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K93.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11006283 -RC105 LCD DISPLAY 7" INCL 10M CABLE Item ea 0
11052039 -S01 CIRCUIT BREAKER 32A 3P C Item ea 0
11014193 -U103 REMOTE ACCESS ROUTER Item ea 0
10005061 -U43 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U43.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U43.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005061 -U44 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U44.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U44.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005061 -U45 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U45.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U45.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005061 -U46 VALVE AMPLIFIER Item ea 0
10008130 -U46.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 25
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11001114 -U46.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10005060 -U50 VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
10008130 -U50.1 SOCKET FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item pcs 0
11001114 -U50.2 HOLDING SPRING FOR VALVE CONTROLLER Item ea 0
11014174 -U61 ETHERNET SWITCH Item ea 0
11012665 -U66 EXTENDER XGA 1:3 Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X1.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105973 -X10.1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009094 -X10.2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X12 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X121 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X13 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X14 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X2 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X3 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009080 -X30 PHOENIX CAT Item ea 0
11105975 -X301 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009080 -X33 PHOENIX CAT Item ea 0
11105958 -XB TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -XP20 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11007963 -XP22 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11007963 -XP23 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -XP25 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11008782 -XS01 SOCKET OUTLET DIN-MOUNTED Service ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11007971 -HS102 COMPLETE_EM.STOP MOELLER Service ea 0
11002535 -HS103 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS103.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS103.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS103.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS103.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11012821 -HS110 PUSH BUTTON BLUE Item ea 0
11002517 -HS110.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -HS110.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -HS110.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS110.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS110.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002524 -HS100.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS100.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002535 -HS101 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS101.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS101.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS101.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS101.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11006178 -HS104 MUSHROOM STAY-PUT BUTTON YELLOW Item ea 0
11002517 -HS104.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002524 -HS104.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS104.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002518 -HS104.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS104.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002623 -HS104.6 PROTECTION CAGE FOR EM. STOP Service ea 0
11008446 -HS111 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS111.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS111.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS111.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS111.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS111.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS111.6 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11008446 -HS112 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS112.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS112.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS112.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS112.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS112.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS112.6 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11008446 -HS113 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 3pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS113.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -HS113.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -HS113.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS113.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11002524 -HS113.5 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS113.6 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002535 -HS114 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -HS114.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 28
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11002518 -HS114.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -HS114.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -HS114.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11012178 -JU101 KOMPLETT VHF/UHF/FM/CD Item ea 0
11013821 -K02 CONTACTOR Item ea 0
11052050 -K03 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K03.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11052050 -K04 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY 24VDC COIL Item ea 0
11012052 -K04.1 4 CHANGEOVER RELAY, SOCKET Item ea 0
11013822 -K05 RELAY Item ea 0
11002521 -PB2 PUSH BUTTON BLACK Item ea 0
11002517 -PB2.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -PB2.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -PB2.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -PB2.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002521 -PB3 PUSH BUTTON BLACK Item ea 0
11002517 -PB3.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -PB3.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -PB3.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -PB3.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002521 -PB4 PUSH BUTTON BLACK Item ea 0
11002517 -PB4.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11001858 -PB4.2 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11002518 -PB4.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002518 -PB4.4 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002535 -S2 CHANGE OVER SWITCH 2pos Item ea 0
11002517 -S2.1 ADAPTER Service ea 0
11002518 -S2.2 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NO Service ea 0
11002524 -S2.3 CONTACT ELEMENT 1NC Service ea 0
11001858 -S2.4 LABEL MOUNT 50mm Item ea 0
11107194 -T1 ROOM CONTROLLER Item ea 0
11002529 -UA102 BUZZER 18-30V AC/DC Item ea 0
11105958 -X1 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11009094 -X10 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11007963 -X10.1 TERMINAL 2.5 mm² WITH JUMPER Item ea 0
11105958 -X14 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
MacGregor Norway AS Page 29
09/12/2014
Component Part list 2552-2-07ML SP2552-2 HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT 14:42:22
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11105958 -X3 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11108935 -CABIN CABIN COMPLETE 1,00 Item ea 1.600
11107402 -CONTROL CABIN
CONTROL SYSTEM CABIN 1,00 Item ea 0
11108930 -HC200 GAS DETECTOR Item ea 0
11108939 -JU104 TELEPHONE 1,00 Item ea 0
11108931 -JU105A LOUDSPEAKER 1,00 Item ea 0
11108931 -JU105B LOUDSPEAKER 1,00 Item ea 0
11107195 -ME1 FAN Item ea 0
11107196 -R1 AIR DUCT HEATER Item ea 0
11107196 -R2 AIR DUCT HEATER Item ea 0
11026089 -RESCUE SAFETY & RESCUE EQUIPMENT 1,00 Item pcs 4
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11105958 -X2 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
11105958 -X3 TERMINAL BLOCK Item ea 0
Item number Position NameAlias Oper. No. Quantity Item type Unit Weight Note
11011792 -RC101 CAMERA COLOUR CCC102 1,00 Item ea 0
11006285 -RC101.1 FEMALE CONNECTOR 1,00 Item ea 0
11006284 -RC101.2 MALE CONNECTOR 1,00 Item ea 0
11001752 -ZT204 MULTITURN ENCODER 1,00 Item ea 1
Blank page.
4 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
MacGregor Norway AS
Andøyfaret 15
NO-4623 Kristiansand
NORWAY
Phone: +47 91 68 60 00
Fax: +47 38 01 87 01
[email protected]
[email protected]
www.MacGregor.com
Remember to refer to the actual equipment machine number for exact definition of components and service
advice.
Important Notice:
During the warranty period, all necessary spare parts must be supplied by MacGregor. The use of spare parts
supplied by other suppliers violates and forfeits the warranty.
Blank page.
General Crane
Lubrication
• C.2201.0000.LU01
Electrical Drawings:
Blank Page.
2. Drawings
2.1. Hydraulic - Crane
Blank page.
Blank page.
Blank page.
Blank page.
11026026
1 13 WIRE Ø28 150M MBL782KN 570 20980358
20980358
72 12 PROTECTIVE CAP Ø53x49 FOR SUPERBOLT 0 11024101
11024101
1 11 SWIVEL HOOK 500 11006787
11006787
1 10 MECH.BOLT 494 20583306
20583306
1 9 MECH. BOLT 260 20583280
20583280
8 8 MECH.BOLT 25 20588614
20588614
1 7 LADDER TO FOUNDATION 20 20891019
20891019
72 6 SUPERBOLT CY-M30x3.5/W 0 11016681
11016681
72 5 STUDBOLT M30x220 10.9 W/ 3.2 CERT 1 20673148
20673148
1 4 KNUCKLE JIB 4079 20926947
20926947
INFORMATION ITEMS ONLY! 1 3 MAIN JIB MAIN JIB 11372 20926945
20926945
1 i-4 JIB CYLINDER RH Ø180/Ø140 x 2625 1143 1 2 FOUNDATION 2672 20926936
20926936
1 i-3 JIB CYLINDER LH Ø180/Ø140 x 2625 1143 1 1 KING 15037 20926935
20926935
1 i-2 JIB CYLINDER LH Ø200/Ø180 x 3800 1466 Qty. Item Description Specification Weight Ref. No.
1 i-1 JIB CYLINDER RH Ø200/Ø180 x 3800 1466 Sheet: 1 of 4 Scale/Format:
3 14
8 4
7 2 6
12
5
11
A(1:10)
13 i-2
i-4
11026026
1 13 WIRE Ø28 150M MBL782KN 570 20980358
20980358
72 12 PROTECTIVE CAP Ø53x49 FOR SUPERBOLT 0 11024101
11024101
1 11 SWIVEL HOOK 500 11006787
11006787
1 10 MECH.BOLT 494 20583306
20583306
1 9 MECH. BOLT 260 20583280
20583280
8 8 MECH.BOLT 25 20588614
20588614
1 7 LADDER TO FOUNDATION 20 20891019
20891019
72 6 SUPERBOLT CY-M30x3.5/W 0 11016681
11016681
72 5 STUDBOLT M30x220 10.9 W/ 3.2 CERT 1 20673148
20673148
1 4 KNUCKLE JIB 4079 20926947
20926947
i-1 i-3 1 3 MAIN JIB MAIN JIB 11372 20926945
20926945
1 2 FOUNDATION 2672 20926936
20926936
1 1 KING 15037 20926935
20926935
Qty. Item Description Specification Weight Ref. No.
11026026
10
1 13 WIRE Ø28 150M MBL782KN 570 20980358
REF
20980358
REF 72 12 PROTECTIVE CAP Ø53x49 FOR SUPERBOLT 0 11024101
11024101
1 11 SWIVEL HOOK 500 11006787
11006787
1 10 MECH.BOLT 494 20583306
20583306
1 9 MECH. BOLT 260 20583280
20583280
8 8 MECH.BOLT 25 20588614
20588614
1 7 LADDER TO FOUNDATION 20 20891019
20891019
72 6 SUPERBOLT CY-M30x3.5/W 0 11016681
11016681
72 5 STUDBOLT M30x220 10.9 W/ 3.2 CERT 1 20673148
20673148
1 4 KNUCKLE JIB 4079 20926947
20926947
1 3 MAIN JIB MAIN JIB 11372 20926945
20926945
1 2 FOUNDATION 2672 20926936
20926936
1 1 KING 15037 20926935
20926935
SECTION D-D Qty. Item Description Specification Weight Ref. No.
4150 (COG)
123 (COG)
Sheet: 4 of 4 Scale/Format:
HMC2201 1:60/A3
CRANE
Projection: State:Released Rev.:
MAIN ASSEMBLY
SP2552-2-R-XX-01 20926930 3
THIS IS A COMPUTER AIDED DRAWING AND MUST NOT BE ALTERED MANUALLY.
Name: SP2552-2-R-XX-02 KING MAIN ASSEMBLY, Number: 20926935, Version: 3.2, State: RELEASED, Modifier: jantzsh
This document and all data disclosed herein or herewith are the
confidential and proprietary property of MACGREGOR NORWAY AS.
and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed in whole or in
34 part by or to anyone without the written permission of
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS.
Tolerances to comply with: Welds to comply with:
ISO 13920-AE for welded structures EN 287-1/2
NOTE: ISO 2768-mk-E for other parts EN ISO 15614, AWS 01.1
UNO in drawing UNO in drawing
WIND SENSOR HEIGHT TO BE ADJUSTED TO
Rev Description Drawn Appr. Date
BE BELOW THE HELI LIGHTS 0 ISSUED FOR PRODUCTION SHJ SVB 23/07/2013
ADDED INFO ITEMS 9-19, REPLACED ITEM 13
1 SHJ SVB 06/11/2013
ADDED 35-40
REPLACED ITEM 37, REMOVED ITEM 19, ADDED
2 SHJ SVB 02/05/2014
ITEM 41, INFO ITEMS ADDED/REMOVED
3 REPLACED ITEM 11 SHJ SVB 28/11/2014
31 24
14
25
33
17
32 15
i-7
1
i-2
20
i-7 16
41
27
28 DETAIL A
23 SCALE 1:10
30 29
i-3
13
2 32 PIPE 0 20894718
1 31 RAILING 8 20936548
2 27 PLATE 2 20891101
i-16
SEE DETAIL D 1 26 LADDER 82 20910326
1 25 146
i-13 KING TOP PLATFORM 20933853
1 i-21 TRANSFORMER 16 kVA 118 11109057 58 15 WASHER M30 DIN6916 HARDENED H.D.G. 0 10001847
1 i-19 JUNCTION BOX ELECTRICAL 10 11029062 3 13 OIL TANK FK120 ASSEMBLY 2 21006973
1 i-15 ACCUMULATOR EHV 32-330 BLADDER ACCUM. 80 10002392 2 9 BEARING GE 120 TXA-2LS 8 11017983
1 i-14 FILTER NF BNHC 1310 DP 10D 1.1 17 11015119 28 8 HEX NUT M10 DIN934 A4-80 0 10000249
3 i-13 SLEW GEAR 290 11108044 28 7 BOLT HEX HEAD M10x30 DIN933 A4-80 0 10000236
2 i-12 OIL LEVEL INDICATOR 254 MM OIL LEVEL INDICATOR 2 10000414 48 6 WASHER M10 DIN125A A4 0 10000253
2 i-10 LEVEL SWITCH MOBREY MINI LEVEL SWITCH SMA1 2 11005419 1 4 SLIPRING BRACKET 108 20582619
2 i-8 FILTER RF BNHC 330 DG 10D1.X 35 11003576 1 2 PLATFORM LEFT 2421 20927987
Sheet: 1 of 4 Scale/Format:
1 i-5 CIRCULATION PUMP PGA00738 95
SCALE 1:75
11105315
21226114
2 40 Encoder Assembly 16 20067828
20067828
8 39 WASHER 0 10003375
10003375
2 38 ACCUMULATOR CLAMP FK 220-2-316 1 10002393
10002393
1 37 HP BLOCK 11/2"SAE 32 21155108
21155108
63 36 BOLT M14X170 UNI5931-67-8G FOR GEAR 0 11003776
11003776
63 35 WASHER 15x24x2.5 R80 FOR GEAR BOLT 0 11003777
11003777
1 34 WIND SENSOR STAND 35 20820491
20820491
2 33 STUD BOLT M16X130,8.8 HOT DIP GALV 0 10009403
10009403
2 32 PIPE 0 20894718
20894718
i-15 39 38 1 31 RAILING 8 20936548
20936548
19 30 HEX NUT M16 DIN934-8.8 H.D.G HEX NUT 0 10000309
10000309
15 29 BOLT HEX HEAD M16x50 DIN933 A4-80 0 11012930
11012930
34 28 WASHER M16 ELZN NORD-LOCK WASHER 0 10002959
10002959
2 27 PLATE 2 20891101
20891101
1 26 LADDER 82 20910326
20910326
SEE DETAIL B 1 25 KING TOP PLATFORM 146 20933853
20933853
1 24 LADDER 123 20933729
20933729
1 23 MOTOR AND PUMP 1419 20973607
20973607
1 22 KING PLATFORM LEFT 401 20933742
20933742
3 1 21 KING PLATFORM LEFT 634 20933740
SEE DETAIL C
20933740
72 20 PROTECTIVE CAP Ø53x49 FOR SUPERBOLT 0 11024101
11024101
7 14 18 STUDBOLT M30x220 10.9 W/ 3.2 CERT 1 20673148
20673148
58 17 BOLT SOCKET HEAD M30x220 DIN912 10.9 2 11016175
11016175
8 72 16 SUPERBOLT CY-M30x3.5/W 0 11016681
11016681
58 15 WASHER M30 DIN6916 HARDENED H.D.G. 0 10001847
10001847
6 1 14 KING RAILING 2 31 20589809
20589809
3 13 OIL TANK FK120 ASSEMBLY 2 21006973
21006973
4 12 V-RING V-199 A 0 10002345
10002345
4 11 DISTANCE SPACER 1 20579863
20579863
12 i-11
4 10 CIRCLIP I 180, INTERNAL CIRCLIP 0 10005217
10005217
i-14 2 9 BEARING GE 120 TXA-2LS 8 11017983
11017983
11 28 8 HEX NUT M10 DIN934 A4-80 0 10000249
10000249
28 7 BOLT HEX HEAD M10x30 DIN933 A4-80 0 10000236
10000236
10 48 6 WASHER M10 DIN125A A4 0 10000253
10000253
1 5 SLEW BEARING 1007 11026173
11026173
9 i-9 1 4 SLIPRING BRACKET 108 20582619
20582619
1 3 TANK COVER 26 20573691
20573691
18 1 2 PLATFORM LEFT 2421 20927987
20927987
1 1 KING 6264 20926932
20926932
REMOVED FRONT AND SIDE PLATE DETAIL B i-8 Qty. Item Description Specification Weight Ref. No.
21226114
2 40 Encoder Assembly 16 20067828
20067828
8 39 WASHER 0 10003375
10003375
2 38 ACCUMULATOR CLAMP FK 220-2-316 1 10002393
10002393
1 37 HP BLOCK 11/2"SAE 32 21155108
21155108
63 36 BOLT M14X170 UNI5931-67-8G FOR GEAR 0 11003776
11003776
63 35 WASHER 15x24x2.5 R80 FOR GEAR BOLT 0 11003777
11003777
1 34 WIND SENSOR STAND 35 20820491
20820491
2 33 STUD BOLT M16X130,8.8 HOT DIP GALV 0 10009403
10009403
2 32 PIPE 0 20894718
20894718
i-5 1 31 RAILING 8 20936548
20936548
19 30 HEX NUT M16 DIN934-8.8 H.D.G HEX NUT 0 10000309
10000309
15 29 BOLT HEX HEAD M16x50 DIN933 A4-80 0 11012930
11012930
34 28 WASHER M16 ELZN NORD-LOCK WASHER 0 10002959
10002959
2 27 PLATE 2 20891101
20891101
1 26 LADDER 82 20910326
i-4
20910326
1 25 KING TOP PLATFORM 146 20933853
20933853
1 24 LADDER 123 20933729
20933729
1 23 MOTOR AND PUMP 1419 20973607
20973607
1 22 KING PLATFORM LEFT 401 20933742
20933742
1 21 KING PLATFORM LEFT 634 20933740
20933740
72 20 PROTECTIVE CAP Ø53x49 FOR SUPERBOLT 0 11024101
11024101
14 18 STUDBOLT M30x220 10.9 W/ 3.2 CERT 1 20673148
20673148
58 17 BOLT SOCKET HEAD M30x220 DIN912 10.9 2 11016175
11016175
72 16 SUPERBOLT CY-M30x3.5/W 0 11016681
11016681
58 15 WASHER M30 DIN6916 HARDENED H.D.G. 0 10001847
10001847
1 14 KING RAILING 2 31 20589809
20589809
3 13 OIL TANK FK120 ASSEMBLY 2 21006973
21006973
4 12 V-RING V-199 A 0 10002345
10002345
4 11 DISTANCE SPACER 1 20579863
20579863
i-6 4 10 CIRCLIP I 180, INTERNAL CIRCLIP 0 10005217
10005217
2 9 BEARING GE 120 TXA-2LS 8 11017983
11017983
i-21
28 8 HEX NUT M10 DIN934 A4-80 0 10000249
i-16
10000249
i-18 28 7 BOLT HEX HEAD M10x30 DIN933 A4-80 0 10000236
10000236
48 6 WASHER M10 DIN125A A4 0 10000253
10000253
1 5 SLEW BEARING 1007 11026173
11026173
1 4 SLIPRING BRACKET 108 20582619
20582619
1 3 TANK COVER 26 20573691
20573691
1 2 PLATFORM LEFT 2421 20927987
20927987
1 1 KING 6264 20926932
20926932
Qty. Item Description Specification Weight Ref. No.
Sheet: 3 of 4 Scale/Format:
SP2552-2-R-XX-02 20926935 3
THIS IS A COMPUTER AIDED DRAWING AND MUST NOT BE ALTERED MANUALLY.
Name: SP2552-2-R-XX-02 KING MAIN ASSEMBLY, Number: 20926935, Version: 3.2, State: RELEASED, Modifier: jantzsh
This document and all data disclosed herein or herewith are the
confidential and proprietary property of MACGREGOR NORWAY AS.
and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed in whole or in
part by or to anyone without the written permission of
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS.
Tolerances to comply with: Welds to comply with:
ISO 13920-AE for welded structures EN 287-1/2
ISO 2768-mk-E for other parts EN ISO 15614, AWS 01.1
UNO in drawing UNO in drawing
Rev Description Drawn Appr. Date
SEE SHEET 1
6484
1085
COG
6882
COG
248
Sheet: 4 of 4 Scale/Format:
35
SEE DETAIL B
19
20
36
34 33
SECTION B-B
24
31
32
23
40 47 SECTION A-A 22
41 45 46 21
SEE DETAIL A
2 40 CONSOLE 3 10001437
12 26 TURNBUCKLER 0 11009522
8 i-4 12 25 SHACKLE 0,6T 0 11009996
4 15 1400 x 225 mm 1
18 SWL T/M SIGN 10007447
29 11
2 6 BOLT HEX HEAD M12x40 DIN933 8.8 H.D.G. 0 10000258
SCALE 1:10 SCALE 1:10 DETAIL C 1 1 MAIN JIB STEEL ASSEMBLY 7886 20926940
15262
6018 (COG)
4356
-21 (COG)
64 (COG)
1810
Sheet: 2 of 2 Scale/Format:
SP2552-2-R-XX-04 20926945 1
THIS IS A COMPUTER AIDED DRAWING AND MUST NOT BE ALTERED MANUALLY.
Name: SP2552-2-R-XX-06 KNUCKLE JIB MAIN ASSEMBLY, Number: 20926947, Version: 3.2, State: RELEASED, Modifier: jantzsh
This document and all data disclosed herein or herewith are the
confidential and proprietary property of MACGREGOR NORWAY AS.
and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed in whole or in
9 part by or to anyone without the written permission of
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS.
10 15 Tolerances to comply with: Welds to comply with:
ISO 13920-AE for welded structures EN 287-1/2
ISO 2768-mk-E for other parts EN ISO 15614, AWS 01.1
UNO in drawing UNO in drawing
25 Rev Description Drawn Appr. Date
0 ISSUED FOR PRODUCTION SHJ SVB 12/07/2013
13 1 ITEM 21 CHANGED SHJ SVB 10/09/2013
2 ITEM 13 REPLACED, SECTION VIEW C ADDED SHJ GHG 16/10/2013
3 REPLACED ITEM 14 SHJ SVB 28/11/2014
11
10 155
195
20
130
18
12
8
20
SECTION C-C
SCALE 13:200
19
4
16
24 21
14 SECTION B-B
5
7 SCALE 1:10
Hmax=3279
2 COG-Z COORDINATE
3 28 NUT M8 DIN934 A4-80 0 10000248
10000234
MAIN ASSEMBLY
SP2552-2-R-XX-06 20926947 3
THIS IS A COMPUTER AIDED DRAWING AND MUST NOT BE ALTERED MANUALLY.
Name: SP2552-2-R-XX-08_FOUNDATION_MAIN_ASM, Number: 20926936, Version: 1.3, State: RELEASED, Modifier: jantzsh
This document and all data disclosed herein or herewith are the
MACGREGOR
confidential and proprietary property of NORWAY AS
and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed in whole or in
part by or to anyone without the written permission of
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
Tolerances to comply with: Welds to comply with:
ISO 13920-AE for welded structures EN 287-1/2
ISO 2768-mk-E for other parts EN ISO 15614, AWS 01.1
UNO in drawing UNO in drawing
Rev Description Drawn Appr. Date
0 ISSUED FOR PRODUCTION SHJ SVB 12/07/2013
1 UPDATED ITEM 1, ADDED NOTES SHJ SVB 09/05/2014
(COG)
1121
(2520)
(20 CUT OFF AFTER TEST)
1 HOLE FOR FILLING
( n2032x15)
1
2
3
4
1
(COG) 5
75
(COG)
10000308
8 4 BOLT HEX HEAD M12x40 DIN933 8.8 H.D.G. 0 10000258
10000258
16 3 WASHER M12 ELZN NORD-LOCK WASHER 0 10003373
10003373
1 2 BRACKET FOR SLIPRING 38 20886137
20886137
1 1 1 FOUNDATION 2586 20926939
20926939
Qty. Item Description Specification Weight Ref. No.
Sheet: 1 of 1 Scale/Format:
Blank page.
8 4
(
91
9)
12 6
21 22 i-6 i-7
751
651
(1028)
PCD LAYER 1
PCD LAYER 3
(446)
i-2 i-1
16
4
(684) i-3 i-5
3 9 8 7 1 13 14 15 8 20
(1779)
SPECIFICATION
PRODUCT:
SWL: 15 T (ABS)
DAF: 1.4
DUTY: 1.0
WIRE ROPE: 28, MBL > 779kN
LAYERS: 3
HOISTING CAPACITY: 150 m MAX
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION:
ENCODER COGWHEEL RATIO: 1:5
ESTIMATED WIRE WEIGHT: 570kg
(707)
0 BOLT HEX HEAD M24 DIN 933 8.8 H.D.G. (DEPENDS ON LENGTH)
11013241
4 21 WASHER M16 DIN6916 HARDENED H.D.G. 0 10000354
10000354
4 20 BOLT HEX HEAD M16x35 DIN 933 8.8 H.D.G. 0 10000270
(1248)
10000270
6 19 BOLT HEX HEAD A4 M10x16 DIN933 A4-80 H.D.G. 0 10000233
10000233
(30)
10000253
2 17 PLATE 2 20124304
20124304
6 16 BOLT SOCKET HEAD M24x90 DIN912 10.9 0 11017074
11017074
3 15 BOLT HEX HEAD M12x25 DIN933 8.8 H D G 0 10000255
10000255
3 14 WASHER M12 DIN125A H.D.G. 0 10000315
WIRE DIRECTION
10000315
17 1 13 ENCODER ASSY 14 20114828
20114828
4 12 HEX NUT M16 DIN934-8.8 H.D.G HEX NUT 0 10000309
10000309
18
4 11 BOLT HEX HEAD M16x75 DIN933 8.8 H.D.G. 0 10000278
10000278
19 1 10 PLATE 28 20114654
20114654
6 9 BOLT HEX HEAD M16x80 DIN933 8.8 H.D.G. 0 10000279
10000279
(1220)
(1280)
10000316
3 7 WIRE CLAMP 22-28 mm DIAMETER 1 20016080
20016080
44 6 BOLT SOCKET HEAD M24x70 DIN912 10.9 BLACK STEEL 0 11012327
11012327
FOOTPRINT REQUIREMENT 0.8 30 5 BOLT SOCKET HEAD M24x80 DIN912 10.9 0 11012328
11012328
80 4 WASHER M24 DIN6916 HARDENED H.D.G. 0 10000782
10000782
1 3 FOUNDATION FOR PULSE ENCODER 152 20114669
20114669
INFORMATION ITEMS ONLY! 1 2 DRUM 742 20114646
20114646
)
1 1 FOUNDATION 152
8x 26
20114655
1 i- 7 VB-425700E VB-425700E 0
20114655
(60)
Blank page.
16 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
User Manual for Crane
Blank Page.
18 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed Cable Supplier
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. CRANE SYSTEM Customer Gas Detector (outside crane cabin) Cables supplied by Customer
Customer Gas Detector (customer supply) (3pc) Cables supplied by MACGREGOR
3 pc Utility Consumers
Customer Public Address Loudspeaker (inside crane cabin)
Customer Public Address (4 pc) Cabin Type
A 4 pc - Air condition unit A
Customer Telephone (inside crane cabin) Cabin 2500 LEFT mounted
- Cabin heater
Customer Telephone (4 pc) 4 pc - Flood lights
Colour RAL 9010 White
Customer Com. - Auxiliary devices Main Motors
Customer Com. Signals (spare)
6 pc - VHF / UHF /FM / CD
- Winch camera MW Main motors with SPM connection
- AOPS/MOPS
- CT Activate
+CC300
UPS, AVI-Lights
UPS, AVI-Lights CRANE CABIN
2 pc
2x230V/60Hz - 0,2kW LOCATED OUTSIDE CRANE PEDESTAL
-M11
CJC Filter
DOL M 3x440VAC / 60Hz
3 ~ 0.5kW (S1-100%)
L1 -M01
Heat Main Pump Motor I
Crane Main Supply (-M01) Therm M 3x440VAC/60Hz
3x440VAC + PE / 60 Hz L2 S/D 3 ~ 215kW (S6-40%)
215 kW In = 340A
S/D
E L3 -M20 E
Heat Oil Cooler Motor 1
PE M 3x440VAC / 60Hz
Therm
PE DOL
3 ~ 3.5kW (S1-100%)
+JB450
Starter Cabinet
+ES400
-M31
Emergency Supply Emergency Motor
DOL M 3x440VAC/60Hz
3x440VAC + PE / 60 Hz
22 kW Emergency Connection Cabinet +ES404
Heat 3 ~ 20kW (S1-100%) Emergency
+ECC1 /251.D8 Drive Panel
+OP206
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Main Block Diagram SP2552-2 XI 101
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 4 Electrical Customer Interface 4
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 102
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. -MW 12T
Cap.: 150m
CT
AOPS
A MOPS A
B 3 Extra profibus B
4 Slave Monitor
5 MRU
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Main Block Diagram SP2552-2 XI 102
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 4 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 201
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Crane Pedestal Crane Cabin Outside Crane Cabin
Option 2
2x2x0.75mm² /413.B2
-W1236 -JU104 Desk Phone Option 8
-W1237 1x2x0.75mm² -JU105A /413.B3
PA Loudspeaker A
-W533 Profibus
3G1.5mm²
C C
Profibus
+OP103 Chair left side
-W203
-W532
Knuckle Jib In/Out /429.C7
-HCV102 Winch Up/Down
-W308 7G0.75mm²
-UA102 /421.C3
-W1221 3G1.5mm² -P2 M
WASHER PUMP 2
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-12-13 Sub Block Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XI11 201
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Control System 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 202
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Crane Cabin Outside Crane King Main Winch skid Main Jib Aft Main Jib Fwd Knuckle Jib
/430.E4
Slew position -ZT208 /430.E7 /431.E7
encoder 2 -W513 Profibus
A -ZT204 Main Winch position -ZT207 Knuckle Jib position A
encoder encoder 2
Ref. /201F4 /430.E2
3G0.75mm²
3G0.75mm²
Slew position -ZT201
Profibus
encoder 1 Note: 3
Profibus
Profibus
Proximity switch 2
-ZS242
MW Upper hook stop
/431.E6 /418.A2
Main Jib position
-W522
-W207
-ZT203 Note: 3
-W521
-W520
-W238
M20 Profibus encoder 2 Proximity switch 1
-W523 11105525 -ZS241
M20 3G0.75mm² MW Upper hook stop
-W206 /431.E3 /418.A2
-JB201 Main Jib position
570x380x150mm
-ZT202
encoder 1
3G0.75mm²
3G0.75mm²
3G0.75mm²
M20 3G0.75mm² encoder 1
-W205 M20 M20
-W208
-W512
-W503
-W209
3G0.75mm²
-JB202
570x380x150mm
Junction Box
+JB201 M20
-W211
M20
Ref. /205A4
-ZS241.W1
-ZS242.W1
M20
-W212
M20 M20
400x200x150mm
D Starter Cabinet D
Option 1
-W215
Em. HPU
Starter Panel
+ES404
Ref. /251D6
E -W202 18G0.75mm² M25 E
Junction Box
Main Winch +JB203 Note:
-W601.RC101 Coax+2x1.5mm² -RC101 Fixed cable 5x0.5mm² -RC101 Camera Junction Box
+JB202 Ref. /252B6 Nr: Description: Axapta nr:
/411.E2
1 Fixed plug/cable Transmitters/Valves On/Off 11011236
Ref. /252B5
2 Fixed plug/cable Transmitters/Prop. valves 11011235
3 Fixed plug/cable Sensors (M12) 11009764
Camera Monitor 4 Fixed plug/cable for dual prop. valves (AMP) 11006179
-RC105
-W604.RC105.1,-W604.RC105.2 7x0.5mm²+scr,Coax+2x1.5mm² 5 Fixed plug/cable for filters 11011656
Control Cabinet /411.D4
+CC100 /411.D6 6 Fixed plug/cable for XYV209/212A/212B 11009764
7 7 pins plug 10004047
Ref. /203A1
8
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Sub Block Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XI11 202
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Control System 3
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 203
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed +CRANE KING Note:
Crane Cabin Outside Crane King Nr: Description: Axapta nr:
HPU Tank System
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Ref. /202F1 Ref. /202D3 1 Fixed plug/cable Transmitters/Valves On/Off 11011236
2 Fixed plug/cable Transmitters/Prop. valves 11011235
3 Fixed plug/cable Sensors (M12) 11009764
A Note: 3 /309.A7 A
-W401.PT201 4x0.34mm² Oil Level HPU Tank 4 Fixed plug/cable for dual prop. valves (AMP) 11006179
-PT201 /424.A3
0-0.5bar
3G0.75mm² Note: 3 Oil Temp HPU Tank
5 Fixed plug/cable for filters 11011656
-W402.TT201 -TT201 /424.A4 6 Fixed plug/cable for XYV209/212A/212B 11009764
3G1mm² Note: 5 MH18 Return Filter 1
/309.B7
7 7 pins plug 10004047
-W404.PS216 -PS216 /417.A3
25G0.75mm² /424.A6
Option 2
-W469 4x0.34mm² Note: 3 Main Line Pressure
-W416.PT202 -PT202
0-400bar /424.A5
4x0.34mm² Note: 3 MH76 Main Pump Regulator Pressure
-W419.PT203 -PT203
0-400bar
4x0.34mm² Note: 3 LS Pressure A
-W472.PT219A -PT219A /424.A1
C 0-400bar C
4x0.34mm²
Note: 3 LS Pressure B
-W473.PT219B -PT219B /424.A2
0-400bar
2x0.75mm² Note: 2 MH76 LS Pump Pressure /426.F8
-W457.XYV240 -XYV240
D
Option 1 D
F Ref. /204A1 F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Sub Block Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XI11 203
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Control System 3
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 204
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Crane Cabin Outside Crane King
Ref. /203F1 Ref. /202D2
A A
400x400x220mm
-XP1
-W470 12G0.75mm² -W440 12G0.75mm² -W441 12G0.75mm² STOP /428.B2
-S01
MainWinch&KnJib
-S03 / MainJib&Slew
B Select B
/428.A7
-H1 Joystick Outside Cabinet
Starter Cabinet Emergency panel
+ES400 +ECC1 +OP206
Ref. /251A6 Ref. /251E6
C C
D D
E E
Control Cabinet
+CC100
Ref. /205A1
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Sub Block Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XI11 204
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Control System 4
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 205
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and Note:
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Crane Cabin Outside Crane King Main Winch skid Nr: Description: Axapta nr:
1 Fixed plug/cable Transmitters/Valves On/Off 11011236
Ref. /204F1
2 Fixed plug/cable Transmitters/Prop. valves 11011235
Option 2
-W471 25G0.75mm²
C C
Option 11
Option 2
D D
Note: 3
4x0.34mm² /423.A2
MW MOPS Pilot pressure
-W447.PT205 -PT205 0-400bar
Option 11
Note: 1
3x1.0mm² WH22.2 MW MOPS
-W474.XY209 -XY209 ADJUST SELECT /406.E6
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date Sub Block Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XI11 205
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Control System 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 251
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
Ref. /204B4
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed Ref. /201F3
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Crane Pedestal Outside Crane King
-W001.PE 1x70mm² PE
3x1x70mm² u-v-w2
-W001.U2,-W001.V2,-W001.W2 -M01
1x120mm² 3x1x70mm² u-v-w1 M Main Pump Motor I
A -PE.1 -W001.U1,-W001.V1,-W001.W1
3~ A
PE 3G1.5mm² Heater 3x440VAC/60Hz
-W012 215kW (S6-40%)
-W013 3G0.75mm² Therm
In = 340A
3x
3x
-W001.P1,-W001.P2,-W001.P3 1x120mm²
-M01
Crane Main Supply 1
225kW / 3x440VAC / 60Hz
(S6-40%)
-W026 3G1.5mm²
Avi. Light Supply
0.2kW / 2x230VAC / 60Hz
B B
M -M10
-W010 4G2.5+2x(2x1.0)mm² 3 ~ Circulation Pump Motor
3x440VAC / 60Hz
4.3kW (S1-100%)
/512.F2 -M11
Option 5 4G1.5mm² M
CJC Filter
3x440VAC / 60Hz
-W011 3 ~ 0.5kW (S1-100%)
-W034 3G1.5mm²
Ref. /201F1
Starter Cabinet
RIO
5G1.5mm²
+ES400
Slipring Ref. /252B2
+CC300 +JB450
Ref. /202E2
-W123
D D
3G2.5mm²
/101.F6
3x6/6mm² u-v-w -M31
-W031 M
-W122
Emergency Motor
Starter panel 3G1.5mm² Heater 3~
-W032 3x440VAC/60Hz
Em.motor Therm 20kW (S1-100%)
4G10mm²
+ES404
Ref. /204B5
-W030
E E
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Crane Cabin Outside Crane King Main Winch Skid Main Jib Aft Main Jib Fwd Knuckle Jib
Ref. /205F1
/504.F3
-ES03 Floodlight
A /506.E7 /506.E8 500W A
-ES01 AVI-Light -ES02 AVI-Light
230VAC 230VAC /504.F4
2x18W -ES04 Floodlight
Battery Backup 1.5h -ES05 500W
/504.E6
3G1.5mm²
3G1.5mm²
Ref. /251D6 Ref. /202E5 Ref. /202E7 Ref. /202C8
-W119
-W120
-W110 3G1.5mm²
B B
-W112 3G1.5mm²
-W101 4G10mm²
-W114 3G1.5mm² M20 M20 -W117 3G1.5mm² M20 M20 -W118 3G1.5mm² M20 M20
-W102 3G2.5mm²
/504.D4
-W121 3G1.5mm² -ES08 Light Main Winch
-ME1
D 4G1.5mm² M Cabin Defrosting Fan D
-W1210 1 ~ 272W
3G1.5mm² Black
Control Cabinet -W1217 -PB0
+CC100 Misc console
+OP105
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date Sub Block Diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XI11 252
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Power System 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 301
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed PE RE PE
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Ref. /351D3 PE
YEGN
1
6
A 2 A
7
8
3 Option 5 -D01
4 A2
9
5 B2
10 PE RE PE
6 YEGN IE
11 -XB PE
7 1 1/BK
12 1 +ES400
8 2 1/BU
13 2 2x2x0.75mm²
9 3 2/BK -W1236 Ref./305A4
14 3
10 4 2/BU
15 4
11 5 BK
16 5 1x2x0.75mm²
12 6 BU -W1237
17 18G1.5mm² 6 -JU104
13 -W216 7 BK 1/BK
B 18 7 1x2x0.75mm² W1 B
Option 5 PE 19
14 8
8
BU
YEGN
-W1238 1/BU
W
15 9 1 2/BK
Option 7 20
16 10
9
2 4G0.75mm² 2/BU
TCP/La
21 10 -W1239 TCP/Lb
17 11 3
22 11 Telephone
12
12
13
Ref. /351E3 14
13 Option 8
14
15
Ref. /351E3 15
16
16
17
17 -JU105A
BK
25 WH
26 GN
C 27
BU
RD C
28 PA Loudspeaker A
29 Option 3
30 -X30
WH/OR
31 1 -JU105B
-W702 Ethernet 2x2x0.34 OR BK
32 2 WH
WH/GN
33 3 GN
GN BU
34 6 RD
35 RJ-45 Option 7 PA Loudspeaker B
36
-U65
WH/OR WH/OR
37
WH/OR
Option 9
P1.1 38
OR OR OR
D P1.2 Ethernet 2x2x0.34mm² 39 D
WH/GN -W701 WH/GN WH/GN
P1.3
GN GN
40
GN
Option 10 /201.B7
P1.4 41 Note 1 -HC200
1
P1 42 -24VDC
2
RJ45 RJ45 43 +24VDC
44 Note 2 CAL
45 -24VDC
46 Option 4 +24VDC
47 +4-20mA
3
48 -4-20mA
49 RS-485
50 RS-485
51 Option 6 Relay
E 52 Fault E
53 Low
54 High
55 Gas Detector
56
57
58 Note 1: Gas detector is customer supply,
PE Option 5 and will be installed by customer
PE PE RE PE
RE PE
+CC300 +JB450 +CC100 Note 2: Cable will be installed from CC100
Ref. /351A3 Ref. /302A1
to mounting bracket for detector outside crane cabin
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 301
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 302
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Ref. /301F5
RE PE
PE RE RE PE
A -X1 A
Ref. /305D4
-X1 YEGN
1
1 YEGN
2
2 1
29
3
3 2
30
4
4 7G1.5mm² 3
31
5 -W201
5 4
32
6
6 5
33
6
34
Ref. /303A1
B -S1 B
4
3
Ref. /251F6
YEGN YEGN
-X12 -X12 PE
1 1 PE
1 1 -X12
2 1 1 24VDC 1/15 1/15
2 2 1 YEGN
3 2 2 2 Slew Release 2/15 2/15 -X12
3 3 2 1
4 3 3 3 MW UP/DN 3/15 3/15 1
4 4 3 2
5 4 4 4 MAIN JIB UP/DN 4/15 4/15 2
5 5 4 3
6 12G0.75mm² 5 5 5 KN.JIB IN/OUT 5/15 5/15 3
6 -W470 6 12G0.75mm² 5 4
7 6 6 -W440 6 SLEW CW/CCW 6/15 6/15 4
7 7 6 5
8 7 7 7 Slew By-pass 7/15 7/15 12G0.75mm² 5
C 8 8 7 -W441 6 C
9 8 8 8 Spare 8/15 8/15 6
9 9 8 7
10 9 9 9 Spare 9/15 9/15 7
10 10 9 8
11 10 10 24VDC 10/15 10/15 8
11 11 10 9
11 11 0 11/15 11/15 9
12 11 10
12/15 12/15 10
12 11
13/15 13/15 11
-XP20
10 14/15 14/15
7
8 PE
YEGN
9 Emergency panel
+ECC1 PE +OP206
Ref./355B1
D -XP25 D
11
0V 5
-X33 -X34
WH/OR WH/OR
1 1
OR OR
2 Ethernet 2x2x0.34mm² 2
WH/GN -W706 WH/GN
3 3
GN GN
6 6
RJ-45 RJ-45
E E
RE PE
PE RE RE PE
+CC100 +ES400
Ref./303A1 Ref.
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 302
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 4
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 303
PE
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Ref. /302F1
RE PE PE PE PE PE
A A
-X1
Ref. /302B1
D D
E E
RE PE PE PE PE PE
+CC100
+JB202 +JB203
Ref./305A2
Ref. /307C4 Ref. /356B7
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 303
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 304
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
-ZS241
BN
A PE 1/BN A
YEGN PE Fixed cable 3×0.34mm² BK
-X1 -ZS241.W1 4/BK
1 BN BU
1 3/BU
2 BK MW Upper Hook Stop1
2
3 BU
3 -ZS242
4 BN BN
4 1/BN
5
5
BK
-ZS242.W1 Fixed cable 3×0.34mm² BK
4/BK
-W214 12G0.75mm² 6
6
BU BU
3/BU
/303B8
7 MW Upper Hook Stop2
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
B 11
11 B
12
PE
PE
C C
+JB204
Ref. /356C5
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 304
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 305
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed Ref. /301B8
Ref. /303F1
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
RE PE PE RE RE PE PE
A A
YEGN YEGN
-X1 -X1
1 1
1 1
2 2
2 2
3 3
3 3
4 4
B 4 4 B
5 5
5 5
6 6
6 6
7 7
7 7
8 8
8 8
9
9
-W215 18G0.75mm² 9
9
10 10
10 10
11 11
11 11
12 12
12 12
13 13
13 13
-X1 14 14
14 14
15 15
Ref. /303C1 15 15
16 16
16 16
C YEGN YEGN
17
17 17
17 C
1 1
25 18 18
2 2
26 19
3 3
27 20
4 4
28 21
5 5
29 22
30
6
-W204 12G0.75mm² 6
23
7 7 PE
31 24
8 8
32 25
9 9
33 26
10 10
34 27
11 11
35 28
D +ES404 D
E RE PE PE RE RE PE E
+CC100 +ES400
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 305
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 306
RE
PE
RE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Ref. /305F2
A A
PE RE RE PE
YEGN
-X2
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
B 9 B
10
10
11
11
YEGN -ZT201
1 1
12 3G0.75mm² L+
2 -W206 2
M
13
Profibus
GN
A1
T
YEGN -W523 RD
B1
1 Slew position encoder 1
14 3G0.75mm²
2 -W205 /307A1 To +JB201
Note 15
SCREEN TERMINATED
IN REPEATER-PLUG IN YEGN
+CC100. 1
16
2 -ZT208
C 17 C
1
3G0.75mm² L+
-D100 -W238 2
M
A2´ GN
Profibus A1
B2´ -W520 RD
B1
GN
-D200 A2
GN RD
A1 B2
RD
B1
GN
A1´ Profibus Slew position encoder 2
RD -W521 /307A1 To +JB201
B1´
A2
B2
A2´ 12G0.75mm²
D B2´
-W217 /307C1 D
A2
B2 -D01
E A2´
GN GN
A1
E
-W506 Profibus
RD RD
B2´ B1
SCREEN TERMINATED
IN REPEATER-PLUG IN
+ES400
+ES400
PE RE RE PE
Ref./315A4
+CC100
Ref. /308A2
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 306
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 307
RE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed PE PE
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
YEGN YEGN
-X2 -ZT204
1 1 1
A 3G0.75mm² 1 3G0.75mm² L+ A
/306C6 -W205 2 2 -W207 2
2 M
T
GN GN GN
Profibus 3 Profibus A1
/306D6 -W521 RD RD -W522 RD
4 B1
5
/205.B7
-XY226
BN Main Winch Encoder
3x1.0mm² A1
/311C4 -W452.XY226 BU
A2
CT on/off
B B
-ZT202
-XY219 1
BN 3G0.75mm² 10-30V
3x1.0mm² A1 -W209 2
/311E5 -W448.XY219 BU 0V
A2
Slew Motor Bypass on/off GN
Profibus A-IN
-W503 RD
B-IN
GN
A-OUT
RD
B-OUT
Ref. /303F3
Main Jib Encoder1
PE PE
PE PE
+JB201
C YEGN -X2 YEGN Profibus C
Ref. /311A3 1 1 -W504
1
2 2
2 YEGN -ZT206
3 1 1
3 3G0.75mm² 10-30V
4 2 -W211 2
12G0.75mm² 4 YEGN 0V
/306D6 -W217 5 1
5
6
6
2
YEGN
T GN
/306D6 7 1 A-IN
7 RD
8 2 B-IN
/306D6 8
9
9
10
10
11 Knuckle Jib Encoder1
11
D D
-X3
GN GN
Profibus 1
-W502 RD RD -ZT207
2 1
3G0.75mm² 10-30V
3 -W212 2
0V
T GN
A-IN
RD
B-IN
GN GN
Knuckle Jib Encoder2
Profibus 4
-W511 RD RD
E 5 E
6 -W513 Profibus
-ZT203
1
3G0.75mm² 10-30V
-W208 2
0V
GN
PE PE Profibus A-IN
-W512 RD
B-IN
+JB202 GN
A-OUT
RD
Ref. /356B5 B-OUT
Main Jib Encoder2
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 307
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 3
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 308
PE
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Ref. /306F2
A A
RE PE
-RC101
-E21 Coax
BK 1
C1_4
RD Coax+2x1.5mm² 2
C1_3 -W601.RC101 RD
3
C1_2 BK
Coax 4
C1_1 Camera Main Winch
-E21
C2_4
C2_3
B C2_2 B
C2_1
-E21
C3_1
C3_2
C3_3
C3_4
-E21 -RC105
Coax Coax
MON_1 CORE
MON_2 Coax+2x1.5mm² SHIELD
RD -W604.RC105.2 RD
MON_3 +_RD
BK BK
C MON_4 -_BK C
-X3 -RC105
WH WH
1 WH
RD RD
2 RD
3
BU
-W604.RC105.1 7x0.5mm²+scr BU
BU
BN BN
4 BN
WH/YE WH/YE
5 WH/YE
GY GY
6 GY
YE YE
7 YE
D 8 D
9
Camera - Monitor
+CC100
Ref. /314D1
E E
RE PE
+CC100
Ref./309A1
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 308
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 309
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
/203.A7
Ref. /308F2 Ref.
-PT201
BN
4x0.34mm² 1/+
A -W401.PT201 BU A
2/-
RE PE Oil Level HPU Tank
PE RE RE PE
-TT201
1
3G0.75mm² 1/+
YEGN -W402.TT201 2
-X1 2/-
1 BN Temp HPU Tank
1
2 BU
-X1 2 YEGN -LS202
3 1 1
3 3G0.75mm²
Ref. /305D2 4 2 -W417.LS202 2
4 YEGN
5 1 Level Switch HPU Tank
YEGN 5
6 2
1 6 YEGN -LS203
36 1 1
B 2 7 3G0.75mm² B
37 7 2 -W418.LS203 2
3 8 YEGN
38 1
4 9 /203.A7 Level Switch HPU Tank
39 8 2
5 10 YEGN -PS216
40 1 1
6 11 3G1mm² 1
41 9 2 -W404.PS216 2
7 12 2
42
8 Return Filter 1 /203.A7
43 1
9 13 -PS211
44 10 2 1
10 14 3G1mm² 1
45 1 -W406.PS211 2
11 15 2
46 11 2
12 16 Winch Motor Drain Filter
47 25G0.75mm² /203.B7
13 -W468 -PS212
48 1 1
14 17 3G1mm² 1
C 49 12 2 -W407.PS212 2 C
15 18 2
50 Main Pump Drain Filter
16 /203.B7
51 1
17 19 -PS210
52 13 2 1
18 20 3G1mm² 1
53 -W408.PS210 2
19 2
54
20 21 Slew/Tugger Drain Filter
55 14 /203.B7
21 22 -PS218
56 1
22 3G1mm² 1
57 15 BN -W409.PS218 2
23 23 2
58 16 BU
24 24 CJC Filter
59 17 BN /203.B7
25 -PS202
18 BU 1
26 3G1mm² 1
19 -W411.PS202 2
D 27 2 D
Ref. /310B1 20 High Pressure Filter1A
28
+OUTSIDE CRANE KING
21
29
22
30
23
31
24
32 Option 2 -PT202
/203.C6
BN
4x0.34mm² 1/+
-W416.PT202 BU
2/-
Ref. /310B3 Main Line Pressure
/203.C6
-PT203
BN
4x0.34mm² 1/+
-W419.PT203 BU
E 2/- E
Main Pump Regulator Pressure
RE PE
PE RE RE PE
+CC100 +JB200
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 309
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 310
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
RE PE PE RE RE PE
-XYV240
1
2x0.75mm² A1
-W457.XYV240 2
LS Pump Pressure A2
-X1
Ref. /309E3
-X1 /203.C6
Ref. /309D1 1 1
33 -PT219A
2 2 BN
34 4x0.34mm² 1/+
3 -W472.PT219A BU
B 1 35 LS Pressure A 2/- B
60 4
2 36
61 5
3 37
62 6 BN /203.C6
4 38
63 7 BU
5 39 -PT219B
64 8 BN BN
6 40 4x0.34mm² 1/+
65 9 BU -W473.PT219B BU
7 41 LS Pressure B 2/- /203.E6
66
8 -XYVH202
67 10 1
9 42 2x0.75mm² +
68 11 2 -W420.XYVH202 2
10 43 -
69 12
11 44 -XYVL202
70 2 1
12 25G0.75mm² 45 2x0.75mm² +
71 -W469 -W421.XYVL202 2
13 Main Winch UP/DOWN -
C 72 13 C
14 46
73 14 2 /203.E6
15 47 -XYVH204
74 15 1
16 48 2x0.75mm² +
75 2 -W422.XYVH204 2
17 49 -
76
18 -XYVL204
77 1
19 16 2x0.75mm² +
78 50 -W423.XYVL204 2
20 17 2 Main Jib Up/Down -
79 51
21 18
80 52
22 2 /203.E6
81 53 -XYVH206
23 1
82 2x0.75mm² +
24 19 -W424.XYVH206 2
83 54 -
20 2
55 -XYVL206
D 21
56
1
+ D
-W425.XYVL206 2x0.75mm²
2 2
Ref. /311A1 57 YEGN Knuckle Jib In/Out -
22
58
23 BU -XYVH201 /203.F6
59 1
24 2x0.75mm² +
60 -W426.XYVH201 2
-
-XYVL201
1
2x0.75mm² +
Ref. /315A4 -W427.XYVL201 2
Slew CC/CCW -
/205.B7
YEGN -XYV213
BN
E 4x0.75mm² A1 E
-W428.XYV213 BU
A2
+CC100 +JB200
Ref./311A1
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 310
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 311
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed Ref. /310F1 Ref. /307C2 -PT208
/205.B7
-X1 BN
4x0.34mm² 1/+
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
RE PE PE RE RE PE -W443.PT208 BU
Ref. /310D1 2/-
/205.D7
-PT205 MW Brake pressure 1
YEGN YEGN BN
A -X1 4x0.34mm² 1/+ A
1 -W447.PT205 BU
84 1 BN 2/-
1
2
85
3
2
2
BU MW MOPS Pilot pressure Option 12
86 3 BN
3
4 4 BU
87 4
5 /205.B7
88 5 -PT206
5 BN
6 6 1/+
89 -W465 25G0.75mm² 6 4x0.34mm²
7 -W445.PT206 BU
90 7 BN 2/-
7
8 8 BU /205.E7
91 8 MW Accumulator pressure YEGN
9 YEGN -XY209
92 9 BN BN
9 A1
10 10 BU -W474.XY209 3x1.0mm²
93 10 BU
11
YEGN A2
94 11 BN
11
B 95
12 12 BU MW MOPS adjust select B
12 /205.C7
13 13 YEGN -XY221
96 13
14 14 BN
97 14 3x1.0mm² A1
15 -W446.XY221 BU
98 15 A2
15
16 16
99 16 MW MOPS
17 17
100 17
18 18
101 18
19 19
102 19
20
103
21
20
20 Option 2
104 21
21
22
105
23
22
22
BN
Option 2
106 23 BU /307B3
23
24 24
C 107 24 C
Ref. /314B1
YEGN
Ref. /314C1 1
25
YEGN 2
26
1 3
121 27
2 4
122 28
3 5
123 29
4 6
30
124
5 31
Option 11
125
6
D 126 D
7 7
127 25G0.75mm² 32
8 -W471 8
128 33
129
9 9
34 Option 2
10 10
130 35
11 11
131 36
12 12
132 37
13 13
133 38
14 14
134 39
15 15 BN
135 40 3x1.0mm²
16 16 BU -W448.XY219 /307B3
136 41
17 17 PK
137 42
18 18 YE
138 43
E 139
19 19
44
RD E
20 20 GY
140 45 -AT01
21 21 GN PK
141 46 1/PK
22 22 BU YE
142 47 2/YE
23 23 WH RD
143 48 3/RD
24 24 BN GY
144 49 4/GY
GN
Option 11 BU
5/GN
PE PE PE
6/BU
RE RE RE WH
Ref. /313C2 8x0.75mm² 7WH
+JB201 -W455.AT01 BN
8/BN
+CC100
Ref. Wind Sensor
F Ref./313A1 F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-12-13 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 311
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 3
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 312
RE
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
RE PE
-X1
A 1 A
2
3
4
5
6
7 PE -HB101
1 1
8 3+PE L
2 -W1228 2
9 Map Light 2
-P1
1 1
10 3G1.5mm² 39
B 2 -W1220 2 B
11 Washer Pump 1 M5
YEGN -P2
1 1
12 3G1.5mm² 40
2 -W1221 2
13 Washer Pump 2 M5
-MD1
1 1
14
2 2
15
16
3
-W1222 5G1.5mm² 3
14
4 4
17 P3
YEGN YEGN
18 Left Wiper
-MD2
1 1
C 19 C
2 2
20
21
3
-W1223 5G1.5mm² 3
19
4 4
22 P3
YEGN YEGN
23 Front Wiper
-MD3
1 1
24
2 2
25
26
3
-W1224 5G1.5mm² 3
24
4 4
27 P3
YEGN YEGN
28 Right Wiper
-MD4
1 1
29
D 30
2 2
31 D
-W1225 4G1.5mm²
3 3
31 P3
YEGN YEGN
32
Roof Wiper
Ref. /314B6
E RE PE E
Control Panel
+OP105
Ref. /314B5
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 312
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 313
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Ref. /311F1
RE PE PE
A A
YEGN -HS102
YEGN 1
-X13 1
1 2
1 2
2 3
2 7G0.75mm² 3
3 -W310 4
3 4
4 5
4 11
5 6
5 12
6
6
B 7 B
8
9
10
-X1
Ref. /311E1
YEGN
YEGN
1 -X14
145 1
2 3G0.75mm² 145
146 -W312 2
146
C PE PE C
YEGN
-X1 -X1
1 1 1 1
148 3G1.5mm² 1 3G1.5mm² 1
2 -W325 2 2 -W203 2
149 2 2
3 3
4 4
-D100 -HCV101.2
D A1
GN GN
A1 D
-W533 Profibus
RD RD
B1 B1 -HCV102.2
GN GN
A2 A1
B2
RD -W532 Profibus
RD
B1
T
A2
B2
YEGN YEGN
-X1 -X14
1 1
147 3G0.75mm² 147
2 -W313 2
151 148
E E
RE PE PE
PE PE
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 313
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 314
PE
PE
RE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Ref. /313F1
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
RE PE
Ref. /313F4
A YEGN A
-X14
1
1
2 YEGN
2 -X14
3 1
3 1
4 2
4 2
5
5
7G0.75mm²
3
3 MOPS
6 -W307 4
6 4 MW -HS104
5
-X1 5
Chair left side 6
Ref. /311C1 6
+OP103
-X2
Ref. /311D1
1
2
3
4
-X3 5
D Ref. /308D2 6 D
7
8
1 1
10 3G1.5mm² 9
2 -W309 2
11 10
PE
PE
Misc. consolle
+OP105
E E
RE PE
+CC100
Ref./354A1
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2014-01-27 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 314
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 315
PE
RE
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Ref. /306F6
RE PE PE RE RE PE
-X1
A A
Ref. /310D3
61
62
63
64
B B
C C
D D
Option 1
E E
RE PE PE RE RE PE
+ES400 +JB200
Ref. /351A7
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XT 315
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Lubrication System 3
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 351
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
PE PE PE RE
-JB450 -PE1
1 1
PE
-Q01
L1
1
-W001.P1 1x120mm² 1
2
L2
1
-W001.P2 1x120mm² 1
4
L3
1
-W001.P3 1x120mm² 1
6
B B
C PE PE C
Crane Utility Supply YEGN YEGN -ET440
YEGN YEGN YEGN
3x440VAC+PE -JB450 -XA
BN BN BN BN
60Hz - 20kW 1 1U 2U 1
2
BK
-W035 3x16/16mm² BK
1V 2V
BK
-W027 3x16/16mm² BK
2
GY GY GY GY
3 1W 2W 3
440VAC 230VAC
60Hz 60Hz
PE PE
PE PE +ET440
PE PE Ref. /301A3
+CC300
Ref. /301B3
YEGN YEGN
1 1
23 3G1.5mm² 6
2 -W026 2
24 7
E E
PE PE PE RE
+JB450 +ES400
Ref. /352A1
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XT 351
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 352
RE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed Ref. /351F7
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
RE PE MAIN PUMP MOTOR 1
-K01 -M01
A 1 1x70mm² 1 A
2 -W001.W1 U1
4
1
-W001.U1 1x70mm² 1
V1
6
1
-W001.V1 1x70mm² 1
W1
-K02
2
1
-W001.U2 1x70mm² 1
V2
4
1
-W001.V2 1x70mm² 1
U2
6
1
-W001.W2 1x70mm² 1
W2
-PE1 -M01
1 1
B PE B
Ref. /353C1
C -X16 YEGN
C
1
1
2
2
3
4
Ref. /353D1
D D
E E
RE PE
+ES400
Ref./353A1
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XT 352
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 353
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Ref. /352F1
YEGN -M10
RE PE 1
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
U1
YEGN 2
-X44 V1
1 3
1 W1
A 2 4G2.5+2x(2x1.0)mm² 5 A
2 -W010 R1
3 6
3 R2
7
T1
8
YEGN T2
Circulation Pump Motor YEGN -M11
3 3
4 U1
5
2
-W011 4G1.5mm² 2
V1
1 1
6 W1
-M20 CJC Filter
1
U1
YEGN 2
V1
1 3
B 7 W1 B
8
2
-W020 4G2.5+2x(2x1.0)mm² 5
R1
3 6
9 R2
7
T1
8
T2
YEGN
PE
-X6 Oil Cooler Motor I
Ref. /352C1
5
5
6
6
5
7
C 8
6 C
-X16
Ref. /352C1
7
5
8
6
7
7
8
8
D D
E E
+ES400 RE PE
F Ref./355C1 F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XT 353
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 354
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
Ref. /314F1
RE PE -ME1
PE RE RE PE 1
-X10 1
2
Ref. /356A1 4G1.5mm² 3
-W1210 3
2
YEGN
YEGN YEGN -X10 PE
BK BK
4 1
5
WH
-W1200 4G10mm² WH
2
RD RD Cabin Defrosting Fan
6 3
-R1
1
B 1 B
2
Ref. /356D1 3G1.5mm²
-W1211 L1
2
L2
YEGN YEGN
1 PE
4
2
5 Cabin Heater Left
3 -R2
6 1
1
YEGN
1 2
7 3G1.5mm²
2 -W1212 L1
8 2
L2
YEGN YEGN
1 PE
9
2
C 10 Cabin Heater Right C
11
E E
RE PE PE RE RE PE
Control Panel
+CC100 +OP105
Ref. /356A1
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XT 354
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Power System 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 355
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
Ref. /302D5
PE
-X61
1
1
2
2
B 3 B
YEGN
YEGN
Ref. /305D7
PE
PE
-K01 -M31
GY GY
2 U1
BK 3x6/6mm² BK
SCR-YEGN
PE 4 -W031 V1
3G2.5mm²
+ECC1 BN BN
6 SCR-YEGN W1
C C
-Q01
2
-W122
D D
-X10
Ref. /356D3
YEGN YEGN
-X10
1 1
19 5G1.5mm² 1
2 -W123 2
20 2
3 3
21 3
4 4
22 4
PE
PE PE
+ES400 +ES404
E E
Ref./356A2
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
4 Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 External Wiring Diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XT 355
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
1 Reissued according to change report #1 2013-11-19 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 356
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Ref. /354F1 Ref. /355E1
-ES01
PE 1
PE RE PE L -ES02
2 1
A N L A
-X10 YEGN YEGN -X10 YEGN 2
WH WH PE N
1 4G10mm² 1 YEGN
BK -W101 BK Aircraft Warning Light PE
2 2
RD RD Winch Skid Aircraft Warning Light
3 3
Main Jib
1
4 3G1.5mm² Ref. /307F4
Ref. /354B1 2 -W112
5
PE PE Ref. /303F5
YEGN -X10 YEGN
1 1, 1
6 3G1.5mm² 1 3G1.5mm² PE PE
2 -W113 2, 2 -W116
7 YEGN YEGN 2 YEGN YEGN YEGN
1 1, 1 1, 1
B 8 3G1.5mm² 3 3G1.5mm² 1 B
2 -W114 2, 2 -W117 2 2
9 4 2
PE PE
+JB202
PE PE
+JB203
YEGN
1
10 3G1.5mm²
2 4G1.5mm² -W118
11 -W115
3
12
Ref. /304C2
-ES03
1
PE PE L
2
YEGN YEGN N
1 YEGN -X10 YEGN
C 13 3G1.5mm² 1, 1 PE C
2 -W110 1 3G1.5mm²
14 2, 2 -W119 Floodlight
2
on Kn.Jib
1
3 3G1.5mm²
PE 2 -W120
Ref. /354B1 4
PE
+JB204 -ES04
1
L
7 2
YEGN YEGN N
8 YEGN
1 1 PE
9 3G2.5mm² 15
2 -W102 2 Floodlight
10 16 YEGN
1 on Kn.Jib
17 3G1.5mm²
2 -W121
18
D YEGN
D
1 -ES06 -ES07
11 1 1 1
2 L1 L1
12 Ref. /355D1 3 3 3
PE RE PE
L4 4G1.5mm² L4
2 2 -W111 2
N N
+ES400 YEGN YEGN YEGN
PE PE
PE Light Fixture, Crane King Light Fixture, Crane Pedestal
-ES05
-HB001 1
1 L1
3G1.5mm² 230VAC
-W302 2 L4
230VAC 2
E N E
YEGN
PE
Touch Screen Light Fixture, Outside Crane King
+CC100
-ES08
1
L
2
N
YEGN
PE
PE
PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
F
E
B
A
D
C
0
3
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Rev.
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Description
+CC100
1
1
Control
Cabinet
-XB 1
6
14 7 -W216 2 -JU104:W
Relay unit.1018
/413E2
2
7
15 8 -W216 3 -JU104:TCP/La
Exchange.1019
Option 8
Date
17 10 -W216 5 -JU105A:WH L.1023
2
/413E3
5
2
10
2013-10-15 ENA
2013-12-13 ENA
2014-01-22 ENA
18 11 -W216 6 -JU105A:RD L.1024
/413E3
6
11
Modified by
19 12 -W216 7 -JU105B:WH L.1025
/413E3
7
12
MSP
MSP
MSP
Option 9
Approved
13
Slipring 13-29
Customer com.signal
10A/230VAC
21 14 -W216 9 -HC200:-24VDC 0V.1024
/413E6
9
14
22 15 -W216 10 -HC200:+24VDC24VDC.1025
/413E6
10
15
3
3
16
Option 10
24 17 -W216 12 -X1:150
/420E8
12
17 Common Alarm.1027
SP2552-2
25 18 -W216 13 -K18:11
/420E8
13
18 0V.1032
26 19 -W216 14
14
19
20
21 -W216 16
4
4
28
16
21
29 22 -W216 17
17
22
Date
Drawn by
5 Project rev.
ENA
39 32
32
2013-10-15
Slipring 39-41 33
40
Spare Profibus DP
Option 3
33
1x2x0.64+scr
34
5
5
41
34
35
6
6
42
35
43 36
36
44 37
37
Slipring 42-44
Loop diagram
Profibus DP
1x2x0.64+scr
Slipring distribution - signal
Option 5
7
7
Loc:
HLA:
Dwg. No.
SP2552-2
+JB450
+AB-XU
8
8
4
Sheet rev.
402
401
Next sheet
F
E
B
A
D
C
F
E
B
A
D
C
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Rev.
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Slipring 45-49
Description
Ethernet
1
1
CAT5
-X30
Control
Cabinet
+CC100
2x2x26AWG 45 38 -W702 WH/OR
46 39 -W702 OR
2
39
47 40 -W702 WH/GN
/410D6
3
ethernet.918+CC300-U65:P1 40
48 41 -W702 GN
4
41
/410C6
49 42 -U103:WAN4ethernet.736
RJ-45
42
Date
6
2
2
2013-10-15 ENA
Connected to
8
Modified by
crane pedestal
switch in CC300
MSP
Approved
50 43
43
51 44
44
Option 4
52 45
3
3
45
53 46
46
54 47
47
Slipring 50-58 55 48
SP2552-2
Ethernet 48
CAT5 56 49
8x1xAWG16 49
57 50
4
4
Date
Drawn by
59 52
Project rev.
Slipring 59-60 52
Coxial cable 53
5
60
ENA
RG59+scr
53
Option 6
2013-10-15
5
5
54
54 55
Option 5
55 56
56 57
Slipring 61-64
Ethernet 57 58
CAT5
2x2x26AWG 58
6
6
Loop diagram
Slipring distribution - signal
7
7
Loc:
HLA:
Dwg. No.
SP2552-2
+JB450
+AB-XU
8
8
0
Sheet rev.
403
402
Next sheet
F
E
B
A
D
C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
-F04
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
24VDC
-F05
-G01
20A
L 230VAC/24VDC + -XP20:1 24VDC.543
A 20A /405A5 A
3 1
1
N +
4 2
2
-
10A
-XP25 1
-
PE 0V.279 -K09:A2 2 -K90:A2 0V.484
/422C1 /405F1 -XP22:1 24VDC.563
/405A7
0V.901 -X2:2 3 -X1:106 0V.933
/430C1 /406C7
-G02 0V.898 -K13:A2, -K13:24 4 -K01:A2 0V.245
L 230VAC / 3-50VDC + /412E1 /420C1
N 120W +
- 0V /421D1
0V.256 -K08:A2 5 -X301:1 0V.780
/420D1
/405E8
- 6 -X1:114 0V.897
B /421E2 B
PE 1
-F07 0V.18 -D01.1:M 7 -K93:A2 0V.931
10A /414A2 /447E4
-XP23:2 24VDC.944
2
12V /414C2
0V.608 -D02:20 8 -X3:1 0V.359
/411A6
-X121 1
0V.24 -D05:20 9 -U46:4 0V.283
/414F1 /426C5
2 -U103:+12V 12VDC.889
/410A1 0V.794 -U61:2 10 -U43:4 0V.494
/410A1 /426C1
3 X
0V.525 -D06:20 11 -X1:10 0V.500
PC /414F3 /418D1
-X1 1 -X1 2 3 4 5 6 -X1 29 30
-D50 0V.890 -U103:0V 12 -X2:17 0V.1028
-D50:230VAC
230VAC.L1.UPS.1027 /410A1 /430D1 A1
/410B1
-F03
C -D50:230VAC
230VAC.L2.UPS.1026 3 C
/410B1 0V.937 -X301:7 13 -D06:29 0V.731 -K44
/406C6 /425B1
-X10 11 -HB001:230VAC
230VAC.L1.UPS.586 A2
-W302 1 4
/410A1 0V.926 -X1:139 14 -X1:117 0V.779
3 1
4 2
/403.C6
12 -W302 2 -HB001:230VAC
230VAC.L2.UPS.583 /423E6 /406E3
/410A1
10A
-W201 2
-W201 4
-W201 6
-W204 6
-W201 1
-W201 3
-W201 5
-W204 5
10A /420E1 /420E4
-A35.1 -A35.2 0V.790 -X1:103 18 -X1:122 0V.789
L 230VAC/24VDC + X1:1 X1:5 -X14:1
24VDC MOPS.222 /425C2 /425C3
2
L+ L+
10A /406A1
3 1
N + X1:2 X1:3
4 2
D M L+ -RRC97:1
UPS 24VDC.959 D
/447E1 0V.919 -X1:95 19 -X301:5 0V.920
- X1:6
10A
Input Output
/416.D3
/416.D2
-A35.3
24VDC.773 -X1:31
24VDC.915 -X1:29
24VDC.604 -X1:30
-X1:32
24VDC.595 -X1:22
-X1:23
/416.D3 0V.414 -D200:M 21 -X2:13 0V.888
+
-W102 2
-W102 1
/430A1 /430D1
-
0V.541
0V.561
0V.899 -X2:15 22 -X2:6 0V.903
/430D1 /430B1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 -X1 33 34
Battery module 0V.1030 -X2:8 23 -X2:4 0V.902
+ES400-X10:15
+ES400-X10:16
/430C1 /430C1
/427A5
/427A5
/427A6
/427A6
/446D4
/446D4
+2V
+1V
+0.5V
+1V
+1V
+0.5V
+0.2V
+0.2V
+0.1V
+0.35V
+320S
+160S
+80S
+40S
+20S
+10S
ON/OFF
UNTERBR
230VAC.L2.UPS.531
230VAC.L1.UPS.527
25
+ES400
26
/506E3
/506E3
UPS SUPPLY
230VAC/60Hz/3,5KW
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 403
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 Power Distribution UPS 4
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 404
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
230 VAC
L2.893 -F05:4
B /502B8 B
L3.892 -F05:2
/502B8
-G01 24 VDC
L 230VAC/24VDC + -F11:1 24VDC.904
1
20A /407A1
N +
-F09
20A
-
- -X1:4 0V.909
/407A1
PE
0 VDC
C C
-G02 12 VDC
L 230VAC / 3-50VDC + -X2:1 12VDC.894
1
120W /409A1
N +
-F10
10A
D - D
- -X2:5 0V.895
/409A1
PE
0 VDC
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 404
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Cabin DC Power Supply 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +OP105 405
1 2 3 32 A 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
24VDC.775 -XP22:2
-X13 1 -X13 5
24VDC.602 -XP22:1 Analog Inputs/PLC Card 24VDC
/405A8 /405A8
-W310 1
-W310 5
A A
24VDC.543 -F05:2 -XP20 1 -D05:1 24VDC.524 24VDC.563 -X1:3 -XP22 1 -K90:14 24VDC.602
-K12 bypasses em. stop in Radio /403A8 /414F1 /403A8 /405A4
-HS102 1 11 24VDC.529 -D01.1:L+ 2 -D03:1 24VDC.617 2 -HS101:L1 24VDC.775
Remote Unit when Local Mode is
12
/414A2 /414C5 /405A1
4
Em.Stop
activated. 24VDC.520 -D06:1 3 -X1:148 24VDC.891 3
/405.A2 2 12 /414F2 /429A1
1
11
3
/405.A2
24VDC.895 -X1:145 4 -X1:109 24VDC.222 4
/405.A2
/405.A3
/419.B2
Chair right side -K93 activates em. stop button on /415C5 /415C2
+OP104 24VDC.236 -X13:3 5 -X1:112 24VDC.420 5
Remote Unit -A97 when Radio /419C1 /415C3
Remote Unit is powered and Radio
-W310 2
-W310 6
24VDC.640 -X3:2 6 -X2:1624VDC.1029
/411A6 /430D1
-HS101 L1 mode is activated. 24VDC.247 -K51:31(11) 7 -X1:40 24VDC.365 POWER WHEN EM.STOP
/419C3 /417D1
Control System ON/OFF -X13 2 -X13 6 IS ACTIVATED AND EM.SUPPLY
24VDC.368 -X1:8 8 -D100:L+ 24VDC.907
B T1 /418D1 /429B1 IN +ES400 IS ACTIVATED B
/405.B1
/422.C4
/447.E5
/422.C4
Local mode Radio remote Local mode Radio remote 24VDC.890 -X2:14 14 -X2:5 24VDC.949
/430D1 /430C1
-K90 13 15 -RRC97:2 24VDC.960
/405.E3
/447E4
16
C 17 C
11(9)
-X1 25 -X1 27
-K91
-W204 1
-W204 3
12(1) 14(5)
/405.E5
Em.stop
-X1:18
EM.STOP.243
+ES400 and /446D4
11(9)
-X1:19
EM.STOP.544
+ES404 in /446D4 -K92
Crane King 12(1) 14(5)
/405.E5
-X1:20
EM.STOP.543 POWER WHEN EM.STOP
/446D4
-X1:21
EM.STOP.546 IS ACTIVATED
/446D4
D +ES400 D
-W204 2
-W204 4
-X1 26 -X1 28
-K91 -K92
A2 32(3) 32(3) IS ACTIVATED, BUT
A2 A2 44(8) 41(12) 44(8) 41(12) NO POWER WHEN
/405.E5
/405.E6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
-RRC97:11
24VDC MOPS.963
A A
24VDC MOPS.222
-A35.2:X1:5
/403D4
/447E7
11
-X14 1 -K11
/405B6
24VDC.600 -XP20:9 TO/FROM CONSTANT TENSION
12 14
RELAY ON RADIO UNIT -A97
-W307 1
/422.C3
B B
/447E7
-X14 1
-RRC97:8
-RRC97:12 24VDC.962
11(9) 21(10) 41(12)
24VDC MOPS.961
11 -K51 -K51 -K51
-HS104 13 23 1
-K08 PLC 12(1) 14(5) 22(2) 24(6) 42(4) 44(8)
MOPS
Main Winch WarningHorn
12 14 Dig.output
14 24 2
/421.D2
/406.F2
/447E6
/406.F2
5 7
/403B6
C -X301 -X301 C
/403D5
/403E5
5 7 TO/FROM MOPS RELAY
ON RADIO UNIT -A97
-XP25:13
-XP25:19
3 4 5
0V.937
-X14 2 6
0V.920
Chair Left Side
0V.933
/447E6
+OP103
0V.919
0V.935
/403C5
/403D6
-X1 118 119
-XP25:3
-W307 4
-W307 6
-W307 3
-W307 5
-W307 2
-X1 -X1
-XP25:19
-XP25:24
94 92
-RRC97:9 #22724.932
-W331 2
-W331 3
-X1
105
-X1 95 94 -X1 93 92 106 107
-X14 2 3 4 5 6
-K52
-W465 23
-W465 24
-W465 10
-UA101
-W465 11
105
-W465 12
-W465 9
/406.E2 2 3
14(5) 11(9) Bullshorn
D /426.D7 Outside cabin D
12(1)
24(6) 21(10) 11 /201.A8
/426.D7
22(2) -K10 1
-X1 12 -X1 11 -X1 10 -X1 9 -X1 22 23 24
34(7) 31(11)
12 14 +JB201 +JB201
32(3)
/422.C2
44(8) 41(12)
-W331 1
42(4)
-W446.XY221 BU
-W446.XY221 BN
-W474.XY209 BU
-W474.XY209 BN
-W452.XY226 BN
-W452.XY226 BU
A1 A1
-X1 117
-K51 -K52
A1 A1 A1
E A2 A2 MW MOPS
E
-XY221 MW MOPS CT
/406.D1
+OP103
-HS104
13 14
/406.C2
23 24
/406.C2
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 406
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 MOPS and CT Configuration 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 407
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
1 1 1
-F11 -F12 -F13
4A 4A 10A
2 /502.B2 /502.B3 /502.B4 2 2
10V(5)
Sig(6)
0V(7)
10V(5)
Sig(6)
0V(7)
10V(5)
Sig(6)
0V(7)
-HS100 3
Heater 4
-HS101 3 13 OFF ON
11(9)
C C
-PB3 3 -PB4 3
-K03
4 14 A1
Defrosting Fan 12(1) 14(5)
OFF ON -K02 4 4
A2
-K02
1 2
D /502.B2 D
3 4
5 6
13 14
-X1 8 9 -X3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 -X1 10 11 -X1 12 13
+OP105
-W1228 2
-W1220 2
-W1221 2
-W1228 1
-W1220 1
-W1221 1
COM
COM
E E
Go
A1
A2
Y1
Y2
Z1
B1
B2
G
L
-HB101 2
-T1
MAP LIGHT 1 Heater Thermostat
N 39 M5 40 M5
-P1 -P2
WASHER PUMP 1 WASHER PUMP 2
1A 3A 3A
25 W 72 W 72 W
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 407
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Cabin Utilities 24VDC 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +OP105 408
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
24VDC.921 -F13:1
/407A8
0V.923 -X1:7
/407A8
1 1 1 1
-F14 -F15 -F16 -F17
6A 10A 6A 4A
2 -HS111 2 -HS112 2 -HS113 2
/408.C1 /408.C4 /408.C5 -HS114
B /408.C1 /408.C4 /408.C5 3 4 B
/408.C1 /408.C7
/408.C4 /408.C5 13 14
/408.C1 /408.C7
/408.C4 /408.C5
-HS112
LOW
OFF
LOW
LOW
OFF
OFF
-HS111
HI
HI
HI
3 13 11 21 3 13 11 21 3 13
-K04
4 14 12 22 12(1) 14(5)
4 14 12 22 4 14 12 22 4 14
/408.B2
/408.B2
/408.B2
/408.B2
/408.B4
/408.B4
/408.B4
/408.B4
/408.B5
/408.B5
/408.B6
/408.B6
/408.B7
C C
21(10)
31(11)
-K04
-K04
22(2) 24(6)
32(3) 34(7)
D D
-W1223 YEGN
-W1224 YEGN
-W1225 YEGN
-W1222 2
-W1222 4
-W1222 1
-W1222 3
-W1223 2
-W1223 4
-W1224 2
-W1224 4
-W1225 2
-W1223 1
-W1224 1
-W1225 1
-W1223 3
-W1224 3
-W1225 3
E 14 P3 19 P3 24 P3 31 P3 E
14 19 24 31
M M M M
P3 P3 P3 P3
-MD1 -MD2 -MD3
LEFT WIPER -MD4
FRONT WIPER RIGHT WIPER ROOF WIPER
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 408
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Window Wipers 24VDC 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +OP105 409
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
-W309 1 -X3 10
12VDC.894 -F10:1 -W309 2 -X3 11 11
/404D8
A -K09 PTT-UHF/VHF A
0V.895 -G02:- 12 14
/404D8
/422.C2
-X2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 =CRANE CABIN
Push To Talk
+CC100
/201.E6
/201.E6
COM COM
SELECTOR SWITCH
UHF VHF 1 2 3 4
-JU101
B /201.E6 B
-JU101
-JU101
MICROPHONE
C C
+12V GND MIC PTT COM +12V GND MIC PTT COM +12 0V FL+ FL- FR+ FR- F+ F- F+ F- UHF/VHF/FM/CD Complete
/201.E7 /201.E6 CD/FM /201.E6 CD/FM
-JU101 ANT -JU101 ANT -JU101 -JU101 Ant -JU101 -JU101 /201.E6
/201.E6
UHF VHF SPEAKER OUTPUTS LEFT SPEAKER RIGHT SPEAKER
CD/FM
D D
-JU101 FM Antenna
/201.E6
Coax
/201.E6
Coax
E E
/201.E6
Coax
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 409
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 UHF/VHF/Radio Console 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +OP105 410
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed POWER
230VAC.L2.UPS.583
-X10:12 -W302 2
/403C4
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
230VAC.L1.UPS.586
-X10:11 -W302 1
/403C4
0V.794 -XP25:10 -D01.1
A /403C5 A
230VAC
230VAC
24VDC.942 -XP20:11
/405B5
/414.C1
0V.890 -XP25:12
/403C5
12VDC.889 -X121:2
RJ45
/403C3 -HB001
230VAC.L2.UPS.1026
-F03:3
/403C4
230VAC.L1.UPS.1027
-F03:1 -W351 HDMI/DVI
/403C4
-W301 USB
-X33:RJ-45ethernet.919
/506E2
B B
CONSOLE
230VAC
230VAC
12VDC
HDMI1
WAN4
USB1
DVI-D
USB2
ETH1
LAN1
LAN0
LAN2
LAN3
+12V
USB
GND
0V
1 2
RJ-45_1
RJ-45_2
RJ-45_3
RJ-45_4
RJ-45_5
RJ-45_6
RJ-45_7
RJ-45_8
+ -
POWER
BOXDC3217IYE INTEL PC i3-3217U /410.C5 Switch /201.A7 LCD Touch screen /201.A6
17 inches
C ETHERNET NETWORK IN +CC100 C
ethernet.736-X30:RJ-45
Option 4
/402E1
/402A2
ethernet.918
+CC450
SLIPRING
D D
24VDC.742 +CC300-XP20:1 ethernet.909 CONNECTED TO ROUTER ON BOARD SHIP
/432C7
0V.736 +CC300-XP25:1
/432D6
GND
P1
P2
P4
P5
L+
M
/201.D2
+CC300
Option 7
IN CRANE PEDESTAL -U65
E E
Option 4
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 410
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 PC / NETWORK Configuration 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 411
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
F
E
B
A
D
C
0
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Rev.
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Description
1
1
4
-W601.RC101 Coax C1_4
/202.E5
CORE
Camera
CCTV
-RC101
-E21
C1_1
Main Winch
SHIELD
UNI-SWITCH
Date
C1_2
Main Winch
2
2
2013-10-15 ENA
2013-12-04 ENA
Modified by
MSP
MSP
12VDC
C2_3
Approved
0V
C2_4
CORE
-E21
C2_1
SHIELD
C2_2
3
3
12VDC
C3_3
0V
SP2552-2
C3_4
CORE
-E21
C3_1
SHIELD
C3_2
4
4
Date
Drawn by
-W604.RC105.2 RD
Project rev.
12VDC
+_RD -W604.RC105.2 BK MON_3
0V
-_BK MON_4
5
-W604.RC105.2 Coax
/411.D6
-E21
CORE
ENA
-RC105
CORE MON_1
SHIELD
Camera Monitor
SHIELD MON_2
2013-10-15
5
5
/405B5
/403B6
0V.359
6
6
/411.D5
/202.F3
24VDC.640 -XP20:6
-XP25:8
-W604.RC105.1 WH
-
-X3 1
WH
-W604.RC105.1 RD
+
2
RD
-W604.RC105.1 BU
Standby
3
BU
Loop diagram
-W604.RC105.1 BN
Camera 2
4
BN
Camera Distribution
-RC105
Camera Monitor
-W604.RC105.1 WH/YE
Camera 3
5
WH/YE
-W604.RC105.1 GY
Next camera
7
7
GY
-W604.RC105.1 YE
Loc:
HLA:
NC
7
YE
Dwg. No.
SP2552-2
+CC100
+AB-XU
8
8
2
Sheet rev.
412
411
Next sheet
F
E
B
A
D
C
F
E
B
A
D
C
0
2
4
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Rev.
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Description
+ES400
1
1
/403B5
-X12 1
-X12:1 24VDC.442
Date
2
2
14
2013-12-04 ENA
2014-01-22 ENA
2014-01-27 ENA
2013-10-15 ENA
11
-W470 3
/426B3 /428F7
-X12 3
-K13
A2
A1
Modified by
12
MW DN.446-D06:6
/426B3
MSP
MSP
MSP
MSP
-K13 22
-K13
Approved
21
24
MW UP.447 -D06:3
/426B3
/426B3
MW DN.451-U43:6
3
3
SP2552-2
-W470 2
/428F5
-X12 2
-X12:3
Slew Release.432
4
4
-K17:21
Slew Release.985
Date
/420B6
Drawn by
5Project rev.
14
11
ENA
-W470 4
/426B4 /428F7
-X12 4
2013-10-15
-K14
5
5
21
24
/426B4
MAIN JIB DN.461
-U44:6
14
11
-W470 5
-K15
A2
A1
/426B5 /428F7
-X12 5
KN.JIB OUT.471
-U45:5 KN.JIB
-X12:6 IN/OUT.436
6
6
12
-K15
KN.JIB IN.475-D06:14
/426B5
22
-K15
21
24
KN.JIB OUT.473
-D06:11
/426B5
Loop diagram
/426B5
KN.JIB IN.469-U45:6
RELAYS FOR OPERATION FROM EMERGENCY CONTROL SYSTEM +OP206
Loc:
HLA:
14
Dwg. No.
11
-W470 6
/426B6 /428F8
-X12 6
SLEW CW.479
-U46:5 SLEW
-X12:7
CW/CCW.438
SP2552-2
12
+CC100
-K16
A2
A1
-K16
SLEW CCW.483
-D06:18
/426B6
22
-K16
21
24
+AB-XU
SLEW CW.481
-D06:15
/426B6
8
8
5
Sheet rev.
/426B6
SLEW CCW.477
-U46:6
/420.B6
/420.B7
22
24
12
14
-K17
A2
A1
/412.E8
/412.D8
-K17
11
21
413
412
Next sheet
F
E
B
A
D
C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Desk Phone PA Loudspeaker A PA Loudspeaker B Gas Detector (supplied and installed by customer)
-JU105A -JU105B
-HC200
B -JU104 /201.B7 /201.B7 B
/201.B7 /201.B7
WH GN RD WH GN RD
Note 1
W1 W TCP/La TCP/Lb WH GN RD WH GN RD
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
W1
TCP/La
TCP/Lb
W
+4-20mA
-4-20mA
+24VDC
+24VDC
-24VDC
-24VDC
RS-485
RS-485
C: 0,5 C: 0,5
Relay
Fault
High
CAL
Low
Note 1: Gas detector is customer supply,
and will be installed by customer
C C
-W1236 2/BU
-W1236 1/BU
-W1236 2/BK
-W1236 1/BK
-W1237 BU
-W1238 BU
-W1237 BK
-W1238 BK
-W1239 2
-W1239 1
-W1239 3
D D
CRANE CABIN
Signal.1026 -XB:11
24VDC.1025-XB:10
-XB:1
-XB:2
-XB:3
-XB:4
-XB:5
-XB:6
-XB:7
-XB:8
-XB:9
Relay unit.1017
Relay unit.1018
Exchange.1019
Exchange.1020
0V.1024
L.1023
L.1024
L.1025
L.1026
/401A1
/401A1
/401A1
/401A2
/401A2
/401A2
/401A2
/401A2
/401A3
/401A3
/401A3
Control Cabinet
+CC100
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 413
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Customer Signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 414
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed -XP20:2 24VDC.529
/405A5
-XP25:7 0V.18
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
/403B5
A L+ M A
Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2
2 I010.0 /415.F1 Reserved -HS109 22 I012.0 /417.F5 Slew Drain Filter -PS210 2 Q010.0 /420.A2 Reserved 2 PIW100 /423.F1 MW Brake Press1 -PT208
-D01.1 3 I010.1 /415.F2 Reserved -HS110 23 I012.1 /417.F6 CJC Filter -PS218 3 Q010.1 /420.A2 Reserved -XY205 3
4 I010.2 /415.F4 Ctrl.Syst.ON/OFF -HS101 24 I012.2 /417.F7 High Pressure Filter1 -PS202 4 Q010.2 /420.A3 Reserved -XY203 4 PIW102 /423.F2 MW MOPS Pilot pressure -PT205
5 I010.3 /415.F3 Reserved -HS106 25 I012.3 /417.F8 Reserved -PS203 5 Q010.3 /420.A4 Reserved -XY204 5
6 I010.4 /415.F5 Control Enable -HS103 26 I012.4 /418.E2 MW Hook Stop1 -ZS241 6 Q010.4 /420.A5 Reserved -XY213 6 PIW104 /423.F4 MW MotorDisplPress1 -PT204
7 I010.5 /415.F6 CT Enable On/Off -HS110 27 I012.5 /418.E2 MW Hook Stop2 -ZS242 7 Q010.5 /420.A6 Reserved -XY282 7
8 I010.6 /415.F7 SPARE 28 I012.6 /418.E5 SPARE 8 Q010.6 /420.A6 Slew Motor Bypass On/Off -XY219 8 PIW106 /423.F5 MW Acc Pressure -PT206
9 I010.7 /415.F8 SPARE 29 I012.7 /418.E7 SPARE 9 Q010.7 /420.A7 Common Alarm 9
S7-300
12 I011.0 /416.E2 UPS MOPS Alarm -A35.2 32 I013.0 /419.F2 Em.Stop Feedback -HS102 12 Q011.0 /421.A2 Bullhorn -UA101 12 PIW108 /423.F6 Wind Speed -AT01
13 I011.1 /416.E3 UPS MOPS 85% Charged -A35.2 33 I013.1 /419.F2 Em.Stop Feedback -RRC97 13 Q011.1 /421.A2 Buzzer -UA102 13
B 14 I011.2 /416.E4 UPS MOPS 24VDC -A35.2 34 I013.2 /419.F3 MW MOPS Feedback -HS104 14 Q011.2 /422.A2 PushToTalk UHF/VHF 14 PIW110 /423.F7 Wind Direction -AT01 B
15 I011.3 /416.E4 Reserved -LS201 35 I013.3 /419.F4 Oil Level L -LS202 15 Q011.3 /422.A2 MOPS MW disable 15
16 I011.4 /416.E5 SPARE 36 I013.4 /419.F5 Oil Level LL -LS203 16 Q011.4 /422.A3 Constant Tension -RRC97 16 PIW112 /425.B4 Reserved -XYV210
17 I011.5 /417.F3 Return Filter 1 -PS216 37 I013.5 /419.F6 SPARE 17 Q011.5 /422.A4 LOCAL/RADIO ON/OFF -RRC97 17
DP-address: 18
18 I011.6 /417.F4 Winch Motor Drain Filter -PS211 38 I013.6 /419.F7 SPARE 18 Q011.6 /421.A4 Front Washer -K03 PIW114 /425.B5 Reserved
19 I011.7 /417.F5 Main Pump Drain Filter -PS212 39 I013.7 /419.F7 SPARE 19 Q011.7 /421.A5 Front Wiper -K04 19
24VDC.617 -XP20:2
C C
0V.608
/403B5
/405A6
Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2
2 2 22
PIW116 /424.F1 LS Pressure A -PT219A 3 23
3 6
4 4 PQW110 /426.A2 Main Winch Up/Down -XYV202H/L 24 PQW118 /426.A8 LS Pump Pressure -XYV240
7
I000.0 /425.A7
PIW118 /424.F2 LS Pressure B -PT219B 5 25 I000.1
D 5 8 I000.2 /425.A8 Hall Sensor Signal B/B* Reserved D
6 6 26 9
PIW120 /424.F3 Oil Level HPU -PT201 I000.3
7 7 27 10 I000.4
8 PIW122 /424.F4 Oil Temp HPU -TT201 8 PQW112 /426.A3 Main Jib Up/Down -XYV204H/L 28 PQW120 /425.A2 Reserved -XYV212 11 I000.5
9 9 29
10 30 S7-300
11 31 FM 350-1 12
12 PIW124 /424.F5 MainPumpRegulatorPressure -PT203 12 PQW114 /426.A4 Knuckle Jib In/Out 32 PQW122 /425.A2 Reserved 13
13 -XYV206H/L -XYV210 I000.6
13 33 14 I000.7
14 PIW126 /424.F6 Main Line Pressure -PT202 14 34 -D07 15
15 I001.0
15 35 16
16 PIW128 /424.F7 MW Loadcell -WT201A 17
17 16 36 I001.1
17 37 18 I001.2
18 PIW130 /424.F7 MW Loadcell -WT201B
19 18 PQW116 /426.A6 Slew CW/CCW -XYV201H/L 38 PQW124 /426.A7 CT MW adjust. valve -XYV213
19 39
-XP25:9
24VDC.520 -XP20:3
0V.525
0V.24
-X1:127 24VDC.909
/425B6
/405A6
/403B5
/405A5
/403C5
-X1:128 0V.907
/425C6
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 414
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 PLC Configuration 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 415
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
-HS110
-HS103 23 24
/415.B6
A 3 4 3 4 A
/415.B5
13 14
-HS103 3 -HS110 3
ControlEnable
CT
ON/OFF ACTIVATE
4 4
/415.A5
/415.A6
-X1 34 33
-X14 145 -X14 146 -X14 147 -X14 148
B +OP105 +OP104 +OP103 B
-W308 2
-W312 2
-W313 2
-W308 1
-W312 1
-W313 1
Option 2
-X1 109 110 -X1 112 111 -X1 145 -X1 146 -X1 147 -X1 151
C C
24VDC.641 -XP20:10
/405B6
L2
-HS101 Control System ON/OFF
T2
/405.B1
D -X1 108 D
E E
2 3 5 4 6 7 8 9
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2014-01-27 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 415
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 Dig. Input signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 416
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
B B
24VDC.774 -XP20:11
/405B6
C C
X2:2
X2:5 X2:7
-A35.2 Mains or battery operation
-A35.2 Alarm -A35.2 Battery charged 85%
/403.D3 X2:1 X2:3
/403.D3 X2:4 X2:6 X2:8
/403.E3
D D
12 13 14 15 16
E E
I011.0 I011.1 I011.2 I011.3 I011.4
UPS MOPS Alarm UPS MOPS 85% Charged UPS MOPS 24VDC Reserved SPARE
-A35.2 -A35.2 -A35.2 -LS201
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 416
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 Dig. Input signal 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 417
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
+ S - + S - 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
-W417.LS202 2
-W418.LS203 2
-W404.PS216 2
-W406.PS211 2
-W407.PS212 2
-W408.PS210 2
-W409.PS218 2
-W411.PS202 2
-W417.LS202 1
-W418.LS203 1
-W404.PS216 1
-W406.PS211 1
-W407.PS212 1
-W408.PS210 1
-W409.PS218 1
-W411.PS202 1
B B
-X1 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
+JB200
-W468 12
-W468 13
-W468 10
-W468 14
-W468 11
-W468 6
-W468 5
-W468 7
-W468 8
-W468 9
C C
-X1 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49
24VDC.365 -XP20:7
/405B6
#39170.905 -D02:35
24VDC.908 -D02:36
D D
/419D4
/419D5
E E
17 18 19 22 23 24 25
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2014-01-27 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 417
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 Dig. Input signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 418
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed /202.B8 /202.A8
Proximity switch 1 Proximity switch 2
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
MW Upper hook stop MW Upper hook stop
I -ZS241
I -ZS242
A A
-ZS241.W1 BN
-ZS241.W1 BU
-ZS242.W1 BN
-ZS242.W1 BU
-ZS241.W1 BK
-ZS242.W1 BK
-X1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
B B
+JB204
-W214 10
-W214 11
-W214 2
-W214 4
-W214 6
-W214 1
-W214 3
-W214 5
-W214 7
-W214 8
-W214 9
-X1 35 36 37
-X1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
+JB203 +JB200
-W213 10
-W213 11
-W213 2
-W213 4
-W213 6
-W213 1
-W213 3
-W213 5
-W213 7
-W213 8
-W213 9
C C
-W469 4
-W469 3
-W469 5
-X1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
+JB202
-W202 10
-W202 11
-W202 2
-W202 4
-W202 6
-W202 1
-W202 3
-W202 5
-W202 7
-W202 8
-W202 9
-X1 11
8 -X1 62 63 64
D 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 D
8
24VDC.368 -XP20:8
/405B5
0V.500 -XP25:11
/403C6
-X1 7
26 27 28 29
E I012.4 I012.5 I012.6 I012.7 E
MW Hook Stop1 MW Hook Stop2 SPARE SPARE
-ZS241 -ZS242
+CC100
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 418
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 Dig. Input signals 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 419
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
11(9)
3
-HS102 Em.Stop
-K93 Local mode
12(1) 14(5)
4
/447.E5
/405.A2
B B
Chair right side
+OP104
-W310 4
-W310 3
-X13 3 -X13 4
C C
31(11)
-K51
/417D1
/417D2
32(3) 34(7)
D D
-X1:41 #39170.905
-X1:42 24VDC.908
E E
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 419
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 Dig. Input signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 420
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Slew Release.985
-X12:2
/412B4
21 11
-K17
22 24 12 14
/412.E8
B B
/412.E8
A1 A1 A1 A1 A1 A1 A1 A1
/420.C2
/420.C3
/420.C4
/420.C5
/420.C6
/420.C6
/420.C7
0V.245 -XP25:4
/403B6
-K01 -K02 -K03 -K04 -K05 -K06 -K07 -K18
/420.C2 /420.C3 /420.C3 /420.C4 /420.C5 /420.C6 /420.C7 /420.C7
14 11 14 11 14 11 14 11 14 11 14 11 14 11 14 11
/420.D2 /420.D3 /420.D4 /420.D4 /420.D6 /420.D7 /420.D8
C 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 C
11 11
11 11 11 11 11
-K07 -K18
-K01 -K02 -K03 -K04 -K06
12 14 12 14
12 14 12 14 12 14 12 14 12 14
/420.C6
/420.C7
/420.C1
/420.C2
/420.C3
/420.C4
/420.C6
D D
-X1 -X1 -X1 -X1 -X1 -X1 -X1
131 96 98 100 133 135 150
1 2 3 4 6 8
-X301 -X301 -X301 -X301 -X301 -X301
131 1 96 2 98 3 100 4 133 6 135 8 150
0V.780 -XP25:5
/403B6
0V.917 -XP25:17 0V.918 -XP25:17
/403D5 /403D6
-X1 132 -X1 97 -X1 99 -X1 101 -X1 134 -X1 136
-W471 12
-W465 14
-W465 13
-W465 16
-W465 15
-W465 18
-W465 17
-W471 14
-W471 13
-W471 16
-W471 15
-W471 11
E E
-X1 37 -X1 36 -X1 14 -X1 13 -X1 16 -X1 15 -X1 18 -X1 17 -X1 39 -X1 38 -X1 41 -X1 40
Common Alarm.1027
+JB201
-XB:12
-XB:13
-W448.XY219 BU
-W448.XY219 BN
0V.1032
/401A3
/401A4
A1
Slew Motor Bypass On/Off
-XY219
/205.B8
/205.B7 A2
F JH18 F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
4 Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 420
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 -D03 Dig. Output signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 421
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
12 13 18 19
B B
-W308 3
-W308 6
-W308 5
-X1 35 -X1 37 -X1 38
A1 A1
3
/201.D7
C C
A1
-K08
A2
/421.D2
-K08
/421.C2
14 11
/406.C4
D 12 D
-W308 4
114
0V.897 -XP25:6
/403B6
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 421
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D03 Dig. Output signals 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 422
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
14 15 16 17
B B
A1 A1 A1 A1
A2 A2 A2 A2
/422.C2
/422.C2
/422.C3
/422.C4
0V.279 -XP25:2
/403A5
-K09 -K10 -K12
/422.B2 /422.B3 -K11 /422.B4
14 11 14 11 /422.B3 14(5) 11(9)
/409.A8 /406.D2 14 11 /405.C3
12 12 /406.B7 12(1)
12
C 24(6) 21(10) C
/405.C2
22(2)
34(7) 31(11)
32(3)
44(8) 41(12)
42(4)
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 422
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D03 Dig. Output signals 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 423
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Option 12
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
5/GN
6/BU
7WH
8/BN
2/YE
3/RD
4/GY
1/PK
-W455.AT01 WH
-W455.AT01 GN
-W455.AT01 RD
-W455.AT01 GY
-W443.PT208 BN
-W443.PT208 BU
-W447.PT205 BN
-W447.PT205 BU
-W445.PT206 BN
-W445.PT206 BU
-W455.AT01 BU
-W455.AT01 BN
-W455.AT01 YE
-W455.AT01 PK
B B
-X1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 -X1 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49
+JB201
-W471 21
-W471 20
-W471 22
-W471 23
-W471 24
-W471 17
-W471 18
-W471 19
-W465 2
-W465 4
-W465 6
-W465 1
-W465 3
-W465 5
-W465 7
-W465 8
C C
144
-X1 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 -X1 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144
D -XP20:9 24VDC.958 D
/405B5
-XP25:16 0V.929
/403D6
0V.926 -XP25:14
/403C5
0V.927 -XP25:15
/403C5
E E
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 12 13 14 15
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 423
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D04 Analog Input signals 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 424
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed /303.B8
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Main Winch
Dual Loadcell
-WT201
-W472.PT219A BU
-W401.PT201 BU
-WT201.W1 WH
-W401.PT201 BN
-WT201.W1 GN
-WT201.W1 RD
-WT201.W1 GY
-W473.PT219B BN
-W473.PT219B BU
-W419.PT203 BN
-W419.PT203 BU
-W416.PT202 BN
-W416.PT202 BU
-W402.TT201 2
-W402.TT201 1
B B
-X1 12 13 14 15
+JB203
C C
-W213 14
-W213 15
-W213 12
-W213 13
-X1 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
-X1 38 -X1 39 -X1 40 -X1 41 -X1 1 2 3 4 -X1 23 -X1 24 -X1 12 13 14 15 16 17
+JB200 +JB202
D D
-W468 21
-W468 20
-W468 22
-W468 23
-W468 24
-W468 17
-W468 18
-W468 19
-W468 15
-W468 16
-W469 6
-W469 7
-W202 12
-W202 13
-W202 14
-W202 15
-W202 16
-W202 17
-W468 2
-W468 4
-W468 1
-W469 8
-W469 9
-W468 3
-X1 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59
-X1 65 66 -X1 50 -X1 51
67 68 -X1 36 37 38 39
-X1 19 20 21 22 23 24
D
D D D
C A
E C A C A C A E
B
B B B
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 424
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D05 Analog Input signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 425
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 6 8
-X1 126 -X1 123
16 17 18 19
PIW112 PIW114
Reserved Reserved
D
-XYV210
0V.731 -XP25:13 C A
/403C6 B
B B
-D04 -D04
/414.B7 /414.B7
PIW112 & PIW114
Measure range Setting: B
/403D6
/414F7
0V.907 -D07:3
-XP25:18
-XP25:18
0V.789
-X1 104 102 103 124 125 121 122 -X1 128 129 130 127
C C
-W465 20
-W465 19
-W471 10
-W471 4
-W471 2
-W471 6
-W471 1
-W471 5
-W471 3
-W471 8
-W471 9
-W471 7
-X1 21 19 20 -X1 28 29 25 26 27 30 -X1 33 34 35 32
+JB201
D D
E E
Option 11 Option 2
Option 2
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 425
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D04/D06 Analog In/Output signals 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 426
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 35 36 37 38 23 24 25 26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
enable
gnd
Input+
+24VDC
enable
gnd
Input+
+24VDC
enable
gnd
Input+
+24VDC
enable
gnd
Input+
+24VDC
enable
gnd
Input+
+24VDC
enable
gnd
Input+
+24VDC
aux +10V
aux -10V
Input-
I max
aux +10V
aux -10V
Input-
I max
aux +10V
aux -10V
Input-
I max
aux +10V
aux -10V
Input-
I max
aux +10V
aux -10V
Input-
I max
aux +10V
aux -10V
Input-
I max
C C
common
common
common
common
common
common
Avalve+
Avalve+
Avalve+
Avalve+
Avalve+
Avalve+
Bvalve+
Bvalve+
Bvalve+
Bvalve+
-U43 2224_2B -U44 2224_2B -U45 2224_2B -U46 2224_2B -U49 2224_2A -U50 2224_2A
9 10 11 9 10 11 9 10 11 9 10 11 9 10 9 10
JP1=2-3 ON 24VDC.1030-XP23:4
JP1=2-3 ON JP1=2-3 ON JP1=2-3 ON DP1 OFF /405E7
DP1 OFF DP1 OFF DP1 OFF
/406.D1
/406.D1
0V.1031 -XP25:24
/403E6
-X1 -X1 -X1 -X1 14(5) 12(1) 24(6) 22(2)
69 71 72 74 75 77 78 80
-X1
70 73 76 79 -K52 -K52 60 61
D 11(9) 21(10) D
69 71 72 74 75 77 78 80
-X1 82 83
81 60
-W469 21
-W469 20
-W469 23
-W469 24
-W469 10
-W469 12
-W469 13
-W469 14
-W469 15
-W469 16
-W469 17
-W469 18
-W469 19
-W469 11
-W469 2
-W469 1
81
-W469 22
-X1 42 43 44 45 -X1 46 47 48 49 -X1 50 51 52 53 -X1 54 55 56 57 -X1 58 59 60 -X1 33 34
+JB200
-W428.XYV213 BN
-W428.XYV213 BU
E E
-W420.XYVH202 2
-W421.XYVL202 2
-W422.XYVH204 2
-W423.XYVL204 2
-W424.XYVH206 2
-W425.XYVL206 2
-W426.XYVH201 2
-W427.XYVL201 2
-W457.XYV240 2
-W420.XYVH202 1
-W421.XYVL202 1
-W422.XYVH204 1
-W423.XYVL204 1
-W424.XYVH206 1
-W425.XYVL206 1
-W426.XYVH201 1
-W427.XYVL201 1
-W457.XYV240 1
+ + + + + + + + A1 A1
-XYVH202 -XYVL202 -XYVH204 -XYVL204 -XYVH206 -XYVL206 -XYVH201 -XYVL201 -XYV213 CT Main Winch -XYV240
Adjustment valve
/203.E7
/203.E7
/203.E7
/203.E7
/203.E7
/203.E7
/203.F7
/203.F7
/205.B8
/203.C7
- - - - - - - - A2 A2
Main Winch Up Main Winch Down Main Jib Up Main Jib Down Knuckle Jib Out Knuckle Jib In Slew CW Slew CCW LS Pump Pressure
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 426
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D06 Analog Output signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 427
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
/403E7
/403E7
/403E7
/403E8
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
0V.541
A A
+CC100-X1:1 24VDC.915
+CC100-X1:2 24VDC.604
+CC100-X1:3 24VDC.773
+CC100-X1:4
-XP20:1 24VDC.950
/438C7
-W201 2
-W201 4
-W201 1
-W201 3
B B
-F15
440V
-T08 230V
-F16
-G01
10A
415V
-W122 1 -XA 8 400V L 230VAC/24VDC +
/508E1 10A
3 1
1
N +
4 2
2
440VAC.924-X61:1 -W122 2 -XA 9 0V 0V
/508E1
-
10A
440VAC.926-X61:2 440-415-400/230V
250VA -
PE
-X1 29 -X1 30 31 32
C C
+ECC1
1 3
A1
-K40 -K40
/427.C5 2 4
A2 -K40
/427.D4
/427.E4
-XP25:1 0V.921
/438E7
D D
-K40
2 1
/427.C5
43 44
3 4
/427.C5
31 32
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
4 Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 427
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 Power Distribution 24VDC 51
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 428
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed Joystick Y-direction Joystick Y-direction /204.B8
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. Joystick X-direction Joystick X-direction -H1 Joystick Outside Cabinet
-H1 -H1
A A
VL/RD
OG/RD
YE/GN
RD/BN
GN/RD
OG
RD
GN
YE
BN
WH
OG/BK
RD/BK
PK/BK
BK
GY
-XH01 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 -XH01 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
/204.B8
0V -10VDC
21
-K06
11 11
22 24
-K05 -K06
/428.D4
12 14 12 14
11
/428.C3
/428.C4
-K07
12 14
11(2) 11 21
/428.D3
A1 A1 A1 A1 A1
-K01 -K03 -K03
-K01 -K03 -K07 -K05 -K06
C 12(3) 14(1) 12 14 22 24 C
A2 A2 A2 A2 A2
/428.C2
/428.C3
/428.D3
/428.C2
/428.C3
/428.D3
/428.C3
/428.C4
-X12 10 -X12 11 -X12 1 -K01 -K03 -K05 -K06 -X12 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
/428.C2 /428.C3 /428.C3 /428.C4
14(1) 11(2) 14 11 14 11 14 11
-W441 2
-W441 4
-W441 3
/428.C2 /428.C7 /428.C7 /428.C8
-W441 10
-W441 11
6/15 -W441 6
-W441 1
5/15 -W441 5
7/15 -W441 7
8/15 -W441 8
9/15 -W441 9
12(3) 12 12 12
24 21 24 21
/428.C8 /428.B5
22 22
12/15
13/15
14/15
2/15
4/15
3/15
10/15
11/15
1/15
-K07
/428.C3
14 11
/428.C5
12
D D
2/15
3/15
4/15
5/15
6/15
7/15
8/15
9/15
12/15
13/15
14/15
10/15
1/15
11/15
-XP1
-XP1 10 11 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
+ECC1 +ECC1
-W440 2
-W440 4
-W440 6
-W440 3
-W440 5
-W440 7
-W440 8
-W440 9
-W440 1
-X12 2
-X12 3 4 5 -X12 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
24VDC.781 -XP20:2
-XP25:2
-S1 4
EMERGENCY MODE
0V.443
E E
-W470 10
-W470 11
SELECTOR ON / OFF
-W470 2
-W470 4
-W470 6
-W470 3
-W470 5
-W470 7
-W470 8
-W470 9
3
-X12 1
+ES400
/438D7
/438E8
-W470 1
SLEW CW/CCW.438
MAIN JIB UP/DN.434
24VDC.442 -X12:1
-X12:2
-X12:3
-X12:4
-X12:5
-X12:6
KN.JIB IN/OUT.436
Slew Release.432
MW UP/DN.430
7 8 9 10 11
/412A2
/412A4
/412A2
/412A5
/412A6
/412A7
+CC100
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
4 Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 428
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 Emergency Panel 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +OP206 429
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
24VDC.891 -XP20:3 -X1 148 -W325 1
/405A6
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
0V.916 -XP25:16
/403D5
24VDC.907 -XP20:8
/405B6
L+ M -W203 2
B PE B
A B -X1 1 2
/414.C1 -X1 1 2 3 4
-D100
RD/TD-_8
GND_2
GND_5
+5V_6
NC_4
NC_7
NC_9
PE_1
-RRC97:B1 B.910
/447E2
-RRC97:A1 A.910
/447E2
-D01.0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
11
11
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12
13
14
15
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12
13
14
15
DP-address: 2 Main Jib Up/Down -HCV101.3 Winch Up/Down -HCV102.3
A1 B1 A2 B2 Slew Left/Right Knuckle Jib In/Out
10
12
13
14
15
10
12
13
14
15
C C
11
11
2
6
3
7
8
9
7
8
9
1
1
/201.C7 /201.C7
-HCV101 -HCV102
6(VP+5V)
6(VP+5V)
1(+V)
2(GND)
3(Ma)
4(Mb)
5(Md)
6(Mc)
7(NC)
8(NC)
9(NC)
10(NC)
12(NC)
13(NC)
14(NC)
15(NC)
1(+V)
2(GND)
3(Ma)
4(Mb)
5(Md)
6(Mc)
7(NC)
8(NC)
9(NC)
10(NC)
12(NC)
13(NC)
14(NC)
15(NC)
11(NC)
11(NC)
5(DGND)
5(DGND)
3(PB-B)
8(PB-A)
3(PB-B)
8(PB-A)
2(NC)
4(NC)
2(NC)
4(NC)
7(NC)
9(NC)
7(NC)
9(NC)
1(NC)
1(NC)
-HCV101.2 -HCV102.2
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
/201.C6 /201.C6
DP-address: 18 DP-address: 19
A1 B1 A2 B2 A1 B1 A2 B2
D D
-W533 RD -W532 RD
-W533 GN -W532 GN
E E
-D200:A2 A.181
/430B1
-D200:B2 B.177
/430B1
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 429
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 Profibus Joystick 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 430
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
/438.B2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and -D01
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed 0V.414 +CC100-XP25:21
RD/TD+_3
/403E5
RD/TD-_8
24VDC.413 +CC100-XP20:13
GND_2
GND_5
/405C6
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
+5V_6
NC_4
NC_7
NC_9
PE_1
L+ M L+ M
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A B A B
-D200 -D201
A2 B2 A2´B2´ IE A1 B1 A1´B1´ A2 B2 A2´B2´ IE A1 B1 A1´B1´ DP-address:
A1 B1 A2 B2
-W506 GN
-W506 RD
A.181 -D100:A2´
/429E4 +ES400
B.177 -D100:B2´
/429F4
-W511 GN -X3:4 A.909
/431B1
B -W511 RD -X3:5 B.908 B
/431B1
5
/405C6 /431B1
7
/405B5 /431B1
3
/405B5 /431B1
1
/405B6 /431C1
14
14
24VDC.890 -XP20:14 -W205 1
/405C5
-X2
0V.1028 -XP25:12 Junction Box
D /403C6 D
-W521 RD +JB202
24VDC.1029-XP20:6
/405B6
-W521 GN
0V.888 -XP25:21
/403E6
24VDC.889 -XP20:13
/405C5
-X2 -X2
12 16
13 17 -X2 3 4 -X2 1 2
+CC100 12 16 +JB201
-W523 GN
-W520 GN
-W521 GN
-W522 GN
-W523 RD
-W520 RD
-W521 RD
-W522 RD
-W206 2
-W238 2
-W207 2
-W206 1
-W238 1
-W207 1
E E
F
SLEW SLEW WINCH F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 430
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Profibus 3
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 431
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
D D
/202.B6 A-IN B-IN 10-30V 0V A-OUT B-OUT VCC1 GND1 /202.B7 A-IN B-IN 10-30V 0V A-OUT B-OUT VCC1 GND1 /202.A6 A-IN B-IN 10-30V 0V A-OUT B-OUT VCC1 GND1 /202.A7 A-IN B-IN 10-30V 0V A-OUT B-OUT VCC1 GND1
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 431
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Profibus 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: 432
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Option 5
A Option 7 A
B B
-F01
-F02
-G01
230VAC.L1.1254
+JB450-JB450:4 -W034 1 -XA 1 L 230VAC/24VDC + -XP20 1 -U65:L+ 24VDC.742
/501E5 10A /410D1
3 1
3 1
N +
4 2
4 2
230VAC.L2.1255
+JB450-JB450:5 -W034 2 2
/501E5
-
6A
10A
24VDC.902 2 24VDC.5
-
PE 24VDC.743 3 24VDC.1
C C
4 24VDC.3
D D
0V.798 3 0V.3
0V.2 4 0V.1
5
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 432
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Power Distribution 24VDC 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC300 433
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Option 5
A A
B B
C C
SPARE DRAWING
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 433
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Remote IO Configuration 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC300 434
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Option 5
A A
B B
C C
SPARE DRAWING
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 434
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Analog Input signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC300 435
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
B B
C C
SPARE DRAWING
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 435
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Analog Input signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC300 436
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Option 5
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
B B
C C
SPARE DRAWING
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 436
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 RIO Dig. Output signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC300 437
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Option 5
A A
B B
C C
SPARE DRAWING
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 437
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 RIO Dig. Input signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC300 438
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed 24VDC.897
-XP20:5
/438D7
0V.549 -XP25:4
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
/438F8
M L1+ M PE Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2 Pin Addr Ref PLC Comment 1 Comment 2
A A
2 I020.0 /439.E1 Motor Trip -M01 22 I022.0 /441.E1 Motor trip -M10 2 I024.0 /443.E1 Reserved -M21 2 Q020.0 /444.A1 Autostart -M01
3 I020.1 /439.E2 Power present -M01 23 I022.1 /441.E2 Motor running -M10 3 I024.1 /443.E2 Reserved -M21 3 Q020.1 /444.A2 Reserved -M02
4 I020.2 /439.E3 Motor Running -M01 24 I022.2 /441.E3 Remote -M10 4 I024.2 /443.E3 Reserved -M21 4 Q020.2 /444.A3 Reserved
5 I020.3 /439.E4 Remote -M01 25 I022.3 /441.E4 Motor trip -M11 5 I024.3 /443.E4 SPARE 5 Q020.3 /444.A4 Reserved
6 I020.4 /439.E5 Reserved -M02 26 I022.4 /441.E5 Motor running -M11 6 I024.4 /443.E5 SPARE 6 Q020.4 /444.A5 Autostart -M10
7 I020.5 /439.E6 Reserved -M02 27 I022.5 /441.E6 Remote -M11 7 I024.5 /443.E6 SPARE 7 Q020.5 /444.A6 Autostart -M11
8 I020.6 /439.E7 Reserved -M02 28 I022.6 /441.E7 Motor trip -M20 8 I024.6 /443.E7 SPARE 8 Q020.6 /444.A7 Autostart -M20
9 I020.7 /439.E8 Reserved -M02 29 I022.7 /441.E8 Motor running -M20 9 I024.7 /443.E8 SPARE 9 Q020.7 /444.A8 Reserved -R31
/430.
12 I021.0 /440.E1 Earth Fault Monitor CH1 32 I023.0 /442.E1 Remote -M20 12 I025.0 12 Q021.0 /445.A1 Reserved -R32
13 I021.1 /440.E2 Reserved CH2 33 I023.1 /442.E2 Remote -M31 13 I025.1 13 Q021.1 /445.A2 Autostart -M21
14 I021.2 /440.E3 Earth Fault Monitor CH3 34 I023.2 /442.E3 Motor Running -M31 14 I025.2 14 Q021.2 /445.A3 Reserved -M55
15 I021.3 /440.E4 Earth Fault Monitor CH4 35 I023.3 /442.E4 Motor Tripped -M31 15 I025.3 15 Q021.3 /445.A4 Reserved -M56
16 I021.4 /440.E5 SPARE 36 I023.4 /442.E5 Reserved -M55 16 I025.4 16 Q021.4 /445.A5 Floodlight Winch
B -D01 17 I021.5 /440.E6 Em.stop -HS117 +ES400 37 I023.5 /442.E6 Reserved -M56 17 I025.5 17 Q021.5 /445.A6 Floodlight Kn.Jib B
18 I021.6 /440.E7 Em.stop -HS116 +ES404 38 I023.6 /442.E7 Reserved -M55 18 I025.6 18 Q021.6 /445.A7 Helilight
19 I021.7 /440.E8 Reserved -R31-R32 39 I023.7 /442.E8 Reserved -M55 19 I025.7 19 Q021.7 /445.A8 Motor Autostart -M31
Address: S7-300 SM321 32DIx24VDC S7-300 SM321 DI16x24VDC S7-300 SM322 DO16x24VDC/0.5A
M M -D02 M -D03 1L+ 2L+ 1M 2M -D04
A1 B1 IE A2 B2 20 40 20 1 11 10 20
24VDC.954 -XP20:6
/438D8
0V.906 -XP25:1
/438E8
0V.905
-XP25:4
C C
/438F7
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 438
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 Remote IO Configuration 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 439
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
/510A3
/510A4
/510A4
/510A5
DI.591
DI.588
DI.735
DI.590
-P01:21
-XX2:1
-XX2:2
-S01:24
B B
C C
D D
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
E E
I020.0 I020.1 I020.2 I020.3 I020.4 I020.5 I020.6 I020.7
Motor Trip Power present Motor Running Remote Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
-M01 -M01 -M01 -M01 -M02 -M02 -M02 -M02
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 439
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 RIO Dig. Input signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 440
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
/503D5
/503D5
/503D5
/503D5
/446E4
/446F4
DI.541
DI.921
DI.922
DI.3
DI.539
DI.592
-U27:9
-U27:7
-U27:15
-U27:13
-HS117:3
-X1:12
B B
C C
D D
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
E E
I021.0 I021.1 I021.2 I021.3 I021.4 I021.5 I021.6 I021.7
Earth Fault Monitor Reserved Earth Fault Monitor Earth Fault Monitor SPARE Em.stop -HS117 Em.stop -HS116 Reserved
CH1 CH2 CH3 CH4 +ES400 +ES404 -R31-R32
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 440
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 RIO Dig. Input signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 441
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
/512A4
/511A3
/511A4
/511A5
/512A3
/512A5
/513A3
/513A4
DI.560
DI.561
DI.564
DI.563
DI.562
DI.559
DI.558
DI.557
-K14:53
-P03:21
-Q06:21
-P04:21
-K13:53
-S13:24
-S16:24
-K15:53
B B
C C
D D
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29
E E
I022.0 I022.1 I022.2 I022.3 I022.4 I022.5 I022.6 I022.7
Motor trip Motor running Remote Motor trip Motor running Remote Motor trip Motor running
-M10 -M10 -M10 -M11 -M11 -M11 -M20 -M20
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 441
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D02 RIO Dig. Input signals 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 442
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
/438D8
Option 1
24VDC.28 -XP20:3
A A
/513A5 -X1 1
DI.4
-W215 1
-S19:24
24VDC.899
B B
-X1:1
/508A3
/508A4
/508A4
/508A3
-X1:5
-X1:4
-X1:3
DI.26
DI.36
DI.8
C C
-W215 4
-W215 5
-W215 3
+ES404
D D
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
E E
I023.0 I023.1 I023.2 I023.3 I023.4 I023.5 I023.6 I023.7
Remote Remote Motor Running Motor Tripped Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
-M20 -M31 -M31 -M31 -M55 -M56 -M55 -M55
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 442
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 -D02 RIO Dig. Input signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 443
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
B B
C C
D D
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
E E
I024.0 I024.1 I024.2 I024.3 I024.4 I024.5 I024.6 I024.7
Reserved Reserved Reserved SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE
-M21 -M21 -M21
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 443
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D03 RIO Dig. Input signals 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 444
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
B B
C C
D D
A1 A1
A1 A1 A1 A1 A1 A1
Autostart Autostart -K23 -K24 Autostart Autostart Autostart
-K21 -K22 -K25 -K26 -K27 -K28
A2 A2
A2 A2 A2 A2 A2 A2
/444.E3
/444.E4
/444.E1
/444.E2
/444.E5
/444.E6
/444.E7
/444.E8
0V.542
/445E1
0V.497 -XP25:3
E /438E7 E
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 444
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D04 RIO Dig. Output signals 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 445
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
B B
-X1 6
+ES404
C C
-W215 6
DI.24
/508A5
-X1:6
/508A6
-X1:2
D D
0V.213
-W215 2
A1 A1 A1 A1 A1 A1 A1
/445.E2
/445.E3
/445.E4
/445.E5
/445.E6
/445.E7
0V.542 0V.499 -XP25:3
/444E8 /438E8
E 0V.212 -XP25:2 E
/438E7
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 445
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -D04 RIO Dig. Output signals 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 446
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed 230VAC.L2.68
-Q06:14
/512B6
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
11(2) 24VDC / SIGNAL TO +ES404
-K91 -K92
/509D5
/509D5
/509D5
/509D8
/509D8
/509D8
/509E5
/509E5
/509E5
/509E5
/509E5
-K32
/446.C7 /446.C8
A 12(3) 14(1) 14(5) 11(9) 12 8 A
/510.A6 /511.A6
/445.E4
12(1) 4
24(6) 21(10) 9 5
EM.STOP.488
EM.STOP.532
EM.STOP.530
EM.STOP.249
+ES404-X1:11 24VDC.535
DI.537
+ES404-X1:13 24VDC.603
0V.633
/513.A6
22(2) 1
34(7) 31(11) 34(7) 31(11)
/512.A6
+ES404-X1:7
+ES404-X1:8
+ES404-X1:9
+ES404-X1:10
+ES404-X1:12
+ES404-X1:14
+ES404-X1:15
+ES404-X1:16
+ES404-X1:17
32(3) 32(3)
12 8 11 7
4 3
-W215 10
-W215 12
-W215 13
-W215 14
-W215 15
-W215 16
-W215 17
-W215 11
-W215 7
-W215 8
-W215 9
A1
-K56 9A
B 24VDC B
A2 -X1 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
230VAC.L1.732
-S02:X2 -H05:X2
230VAC.L1.568 -HS117 1 11 3
/510D8 /511D7
2 12 4 A1 A1
A2 A2
/446.A7
/446.A8
0V
C C
EM.STOP.243
-X1:25 -W204 1 -X1 18
/405D3
SIGNAL TO /405D3 EM.STOP.544
-X1:26 -W204 2 19
+CC100 EM.STOP.543
-X1:27 20
-W204 3
/405D3
D EM.STOP.546
-X1:28 -W204 4 21 D
/405D3
E E
24VDC.544 -XP20:3
/438D7
DI.539 -D02:17
/440A6
24VDC.572 -XP20:4
/438D7
DI.592 -D02:18
/440A7
Option 1
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 446
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 Em.loop & Auxilliary 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 447
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
-RRC97
A A
POWER MODULE MC-RX-RLS MODULE
-A4 -K1 -K2
CONST.
MOPS TENSION
RELAY RELAY
SAFETY MONIT.
RELAY RELAY L1 L2 L3 L4
IN PUT OUT PUT D-SUB CONN. RS485
24 7,2 -A2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 PE 1A 1B 2A 2B PE 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
B B
C C
COMMON
COMMON
COMMON
COMMON
24VDC
0VDC
NO
NO
NO
NO
NC
NC
NC
NC
PE
-?
-?
DP-address:
-X1 1 2 3 A1 B1 A2 B2 -X2 -X2 -X2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
D D
A1
/447.E5
0V.930 -A35.2:X1:4 B.910 -D100:B1´ 0V.931 -XP25:7 #22724.932 -K52:A1
/403D4 /429C3 /403B6 /406D6
-K93 /406A8
24VDC MOPS.963
-K11:11
E /447.E5 E
14(5) 11(9) 24VDC.962 -K11:14
/419.B3 /406B8
12(1)
24(6) 21(10)
/405.C2
22(2)
34(7) 31(11)
/405.C3
32(3)
44(8) 41(12)
42(4)
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AB-XU 447
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Radio Remote Control -RRC97 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +CC100 501
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
F
E
B
A
D
C
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
Rev.
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
Description
+ES400
1
1
Starter Cabinet
/510E1
Slipring PE PE
2 L1 -W001.P1 1 -Q01:2
440VAC.L1.411
/510E1
L1
CRANE PEDESTAL
4 L3 -W001.P3 1 -Q01:6
440VAC.L3.413
Date
/510E1
L3
2
2
2013-10-15 ENA
5 L4
L4
Modified by
Slipring 5-7 6 L5
MSP
7 L6
L6
Approved
3
3
SP2552-2
HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2)
4
4
Date
3x440VAC+PE / 60Hz - 20kW =CRANE KING+ET440-ET440:1W
10 3 -W035 GY 440VAC.L3.1241
Drawn by
/514C2
Project rev.
3
5
ENA
4
2013-10-15
11 -W025 1
+CC300
/506E4
-W034 1 4 -XA:4
230VAC.L1.416
/432C1
230VAC.L1.1254
-XA:1 12 5 -W025 2
/506E4
5 -XA:5
230VAC.L2.417
5
5
-W034 2
/432C1
230VAC.L2.1255
-XA:2
Slipring 11-12
230VAC TO CC300
6
6
Loop diagram
30 23 -W026 1 -XA:6
230VAC.L1.409
Slipring distribution - power
/506E6
Slipring 30-31 23
24 -XA:7
230VAC.L2.408
7
7
32 25
Dwg. No.
25
33 26
SP2552-2
+JB450
26
34 27
27
Slipring 32-38 28
35
Spare 28
+AP-XU
36 29
29
37 30
8
8
30
Sheet rev.
38 31
31
502
501
Next sheet
F
E
B
A
D
C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed 230 VAC
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
1 3 5 1 3 5 1 3 1 3 1 3
-F01 32A -F02 20A -F03 16A -F04 16A -F05 10A
2 4 6 2 4 6 2 4 2 4 2 4
1 3 5
-K02 -G01:N L2.893
/404B1
-G01:L L3.892
/407.D5 2 4 6 /404B1
1 3 A1 -PB2 3
B B
Black
-K05
/502.B6
N(4)
N(4)
N(4)
L(1)
L(1)
L(1)
-K05 2 4 A2 4
-C01 -C02 -C03
/502.B6
/502.B6
/407.B3 /407.B3 /407.B4
Pulse relay
-ES189 -ES189 -ES189
U1(2)
Nreg(3)
U1(2)
Nreg(3)
U1(2)
Nreg(3)
Fan Regulator Heat Regulator Heat Regulator
-X10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
+OP105
C C
-W1200 WH
-W1200 RD
-W1200 BK
-W1210 2
-W1211 2
-W1212 2
-W1214 2
-W1215 2
-W1216 2
-W1217 2
-W1210 1
-W1211 1
-W1212 1
-W1214 1
-W1215 1
-W1216 1
-W1217 1
-W1210 3
-X10 4 5 6
-X10 7 8
-PB0 3
Black
1 3 5
2 4 SINGLE
-S01 32A 4
SOCKET OUTLET
-F01 10A
D 2 4 6 D
1 3 -R1 -R2 -XS02 L N
1 1
L /252.E3
Light switch
-X10 1 2 3 -XS01 2 2
on cabin wall
/252.E1
PE N
+CC100 L1 L1
-R1 -R2
-W101 WH
-W101 RD
Supply&Service
-W101 BK
Socket
L N N incl. in cabin
2
3
1
2x18W
-X10:1
-X10:2
-X10:3
:PE
L2 L2 Air Cond.Unit
230VAC.L1.367
230VAC.L2.893
230VAC.L3.894
L N /252.E3
E 2300W E
M
-ES10
PE.1236
Aircon
L N L
Unit
-ME1 -E05 -XS03
Cabin Defrosting Fan Cabin Heater Left Cabin Heater Right
/504E2
/504E2
/504E2
/504E2
SINGLE
272W
SOCKET OUTLET
1.31A 8.7 A 8.7 A 10 A 16 A 2 x 0.08 A
272W 2000W 2000W
=CRANE KING POWER SUPPLY
Starter Cabinet
+ES400 3x230VAC/60Hz
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 502
SP2552-2 HLA: =CRANE CABIN Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Power System Crane Cabin 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +OP105 503
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
230VAC.L1.UPS.585
-F12:2
/506E5
230VAC.L2.UPS.582
-F12:4
/506E5
24VDC.955 -XP20:4
/438D8
B B
-XX1 9
s2 s2 1S1
C 10 -XX1 8 C
11
2 6 5 4 3 14 8
A1 A2
1 2 3 4 -U27
A1
-U27 13 15 7 9
9 7 15 13
-U27
-D02:15
-D02:14
-D02:13
-D02:12
D D
DI.921
DI.541
DI.922
DI.3
/440A1
/440A4
/440A3
/440A2
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 503
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Earth Fault Monitoring 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 504
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
1 3 5 1 3 1 3 1 3
-T03 1 3 1 3 5 1 3
-F02 40A -F03 20A -F04 10A -F05 10A
-F06 6A -F07 6A -F08 16A
/503.C4 2 4 6 2 4 2 4 2 4
2 4 2 4 6 2 4
1 3 5
-F01 50A
B B
2 4 6
/445.E6
/445.E5
/445.E5
4
C C
-W114 2
-W121 2
-W115 2
-W110 2
-W114 1
-W121 1
-W115 1
-W110 1
-W115 3
-X10 3
4
+JB202
-W101 WH
-W101 RD
-W027 GY
-W027 BN
-W027 BK
-W101 BK
-W117 2
-W117 1
D D
L
-ES08
230VAC.L3.1235 =CRANE KING+ET440-ET440:2W
230VAC.L1.1249 =CRANE KING+ET440-ET440:2U
230VAC.L2.1234 =CRANE KING+ET440-ET440:2V
-X10 1 /252.C5
2
Light Main Winch
+JB203 N
PE PE
-W118 2
-W118 1
+CC100-X10:1
+CC100-X10:2
+CC100-X10:3
-UL01:N1
-UL01:L1
230VAC.181-H12:23
230VAC.535-X10:19
230VAC.537-X10:20
230VAC.180-H12:3
230VAC.L1.1253
230VAC.L2.1253
:PE
230VAC.L1.367
230VAC.L2.893
230VAC.L3.894
PE.1241 :PE
-R10:N2
-SB2:5
-SB1:5
PE.1236
-X10 1 2 3 4
E E
+JB204 L1 L4 L1 L4 L1 L4
-ES06 -ES07 -ES05
/502E1
/502E1
/502E1
/506A1
/506A1
/502E2
/507A2
/507A2
/507A3
/507A4
/507A4
/507A7
/507A7
PE PE PE
/514C8
/514C8
/514C8
/514C8
-W119 2
-W120 2
-W119 1
-W120 1
Knuckle Jib
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
1 Reissued according to change report #1 2013-11-19 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 504
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Power Distribution 230VAC 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 505
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
B B
SPARE DRAWING
D D
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 505
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Power Distribution 230VAC 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 506
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. 230VAC 230VAC UPS 230VAC UPS
60Hz 50Hz AVI-LIGHTS
-UL01 16A
A 230VAC.L1.1253
-F03:2 L1 L2 A
2 4
1 3
Input Output
/504E3
230VAC.L2.1253
-F03:4 N1 N2
/504E3
-F09
/252.C2
NRT-U3000
/445.E7
/445.F7
/445.F7
/252.C2
SPARE
RJ-45
-X34
C C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
-W706 WH/GN
-W706 WH/OR
-W706 GN
-W706 OR
-W102 2
-W025 2
-W026 2
-W112 2
-W113 2
-W102 1
-W025 1
-W026 1
-W112 1
-W113 1
-X10 1 2
D D
+JB202
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
-X33 RJ-45
PE
PE PE
-W116 1
-W116 2
ethernet.919-U61:RJ-45_4
-JB450:23
-JB450:24
-JB450:4
-JB450:5
230VAC.L2.UPS.531
230VAC.L1.UPS.527
230VAC.L1.UPS.585
230VAC.L2.UPS.582
-U27:11
-U27:10
-X10:10
-X10:9
E E
230VAC.L1.416
230VAC.L2.417
230VAC.L1.409
230VAC.L2.408
L L
-ES01 -ES02
/252.A5 /252.A7
AVI-Light AVI-Light
/403E1
/403E1
230VAC N 230VAC N
/410B7
/501B5
/501B5
/503B2
/503B2
/501B7
/501B7
+JB450
+CC100 +CC100 +JB450 Winch Skid Main Jib Fwd
SUPPLY AVI-LIGHT
UPS SUPPLY UPS SUPPLY EARTH FAULT
FROM SLIPRING
TO +CC100 TO +CC300 MONITORING
+JB450
THROUGH SLIPRING
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 506
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Power Distribution 230VAC UPS 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 507
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
/504E7
/504E7
/504E7
/504E8
/504E8
/504E8
/504E8
A A
-F08:4230VAC.181
-F08:2230VAC.180
-F08:2230VAC.535
-F08:4230VAC.537
-F07:2
-F07:4
-F07:6
-X10 19 20 21 22
Start
Start
Start
-S03 -S18 -S21
0
3 23 3 23 3 23
B B
HEATER HEATER HEATER
4 24 4 24 4 24
-XX1 4
61 61
21
-W123 2
-W123 4
-W123 1
-W123 3
-K13 -K15
C 400A C
-K01 62 62
/511.F7
/513.E7
22
/510.E6
-XX1 5
x1 x1 x1
-H12 -H16 -H18
6 5 6 5
D -SB2 -SB1 D
°C °C x2 x2 x2
4 3 4 3
230VAC.70 +ES404-X10:1
230VAC.69 +ES404-X10:2
230VAC.922+ES404-X10:3
230VAC.921+ES404-X10:4
230VAC.9 -X6:1
230VAC.10 -X6:2
230VAC.21 -X6:5
230VAC.22 -X6:6
230VAC.31 -X6:7
230VAC.32 -X6:8
/509A1
/510D3
/510D4
/511D3
/511D4
/513D3
/513D4
/509A2
/509A3
/509A3
E E
-R10 L N1 N2 N -E01.1
L1 N
-M01 -M10 -M20 EMERGENCY PUMP CABINET HEATING
MAIN PUMP 1 CIRCULATION PUMP OIL COOLER 1 HEATING +ES404
400W 400W Fan HEATING HEATING HEATING +ES404
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
1 Reissued according to change report #1 2013-11-19 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 507
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 Aux. Switchboard equipment 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 508
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and MOTOR MOTOR MOTOR MOTOR
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed +ES400
TRIP RUNNING REMOTE AUTO START
/442C4
/442C3
/442C2
/445C8
/445D8
/442B4
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
-X1:1 24VDC.899
DI.8
DI.36
DI.26
DI.24
0V.213
-X1:3
-X1:4
-X1:5
-X1:6
-X1:2
230VAC
-W215 4
-W215 6
-W215 2
-W215 1
-W215 3
-W215 5
/509.B7
12(3) 1
Auto
Auto
Man
Man
4 14
0
-X1 6 2 -K91 Em.stop
-S02 Man -S02 Auto
-X1 1 3 4 5
2
3 13
B B
44 23 A1 -S01 2
21
61 -S02 Remote -K02 Autostart
-Q01 Stop
-K01 43 24 A2 1
22
62
/508.E7
/508.C5
/508.E8
-HS116:4 24VDC.637 13 54
1 3 5
/509C6
-Q01
-Q01 -S01 4 1
13 14 -Q01 14 53
Start
-K02 Autostart
I> I> I> 21 22
50A 3 3 2
2 4 6 -K02
/508.C5
/508.E8
/508.B5
2 1
C /508.C8 C
3
13
/509D1
/509D2
-K01 14
/508.E7
1 3 5
-H02:4 230VAC.71
-H02:14 230VAC.72
-K01 50A
-Q02
/508.E7 2 4 6 11
A1 -S01
-K01 50A
XXA
/508.E8
D A2 Start D
12
/508.E7
-W030 WH
I>
-W030 RD
-W030 BK
2
-W031 GY
-W031 BN
-W031 BK
I>
3
4
-T1
690/230VAC
I>
5
6
-X6 1 2
PE MAIN MOTOR
CONTACTOR RUN
-K01
/508.D7 -S01
1 2 3 4
/508.C8
/427B1 3 4 1 2
+ES400-XA:8440VAC.924 /508.D2 /508.B8
W1
PE
V1
U1
/427B1 5 6 11 12
+ES400-XA:9440VAC.926 R1 -W032 1 /508.D8
14 13
E R2 -W032 2 /508.D7 E
M 43 44
PE
3 ~ T1 /508.B4
21 22
-X61 T2 /509.B1
1 2 3 31 32
-M31
Emergency Motor
3x440VAC/60Hz
1 2 3 PE 20kW (S1-100%)
+ECC1 -X60
2
4
3
1
/251.F6 /101.F6
EMERGENCY SUPPLY
440VAC/60Hz
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
4 Reissued according to change report #4 2014-01-22 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 508
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
1 Reissued according to change report #1 2013-11-19 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 -M31 Emergency pump 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES404 509
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
/507E7
/507E7
/507E8
/507E8
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
+ES400-X10:22230VAC.921
A A
+ES400-X10:19 230VAC.70
+ES400-X10:20 230VAC.69
+ES400-X10:21230VAC.922
-W123 2
-W123 4
-W123 1
-W123 3
B -X10 1 2 3 4 B
21
-K91
-K01 /509.C8
22 1 2
/508.B6
/508.E7
2A 2A 24VDC
1 1
-HS116 1 11 3
Start
3 13 A1
/509.B7
2 3 24VDC.637 -S02:24
/508C5
-X1 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
-W215 10
-W215 12
-W215 13
-W215 14
-W215 15
-W215 16
-W215 17
-W215 11
x1
-W215 7
-W215 8
-W215 9
-H02
x2
#21125.534 +ES400-X1:15
#21126.536 +ES400-X1:16
#21127.538 +ES400-X1:17
D D
+ES400-X1:7 EM.STOP.488
/446A6
+ES400-X1:8 EM.STOP.532
230VAC.71 -X6:1
230VAC.72 -X6:2
/446A7
/446A7
/446A7
+ES400-X1:10 EM.STOP.249
/446A6
/508D3
/508D4
L 24VDC.535 +ES400-X1:11
-R1 /446A6
CABINET HEATER DI.537 +ES400-X1:12
150W /446A6
E 24VDC.603 +ES400-X1:13 E
/446A7
EMERGENCY PUMP 0V.633 +ES400-X1:14
N
HEATING /446A7
+ES404
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
1 Reissued according to change report #1 2013-11-19 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 509
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -M31 Emergency pump Aux. 2
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES404 510
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and MOTOR POWER MOTOR MOTOR 230VAC
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
TRIP PRESENT RUNNING REMOTE
/513D2
/513D3
Auto
Man
/439B1
/439B2
/439B3
/439B4
14
Auto
Man
0
-Q14:1
440VAC.L1.892 4
0
/511A1 -S01 Auto
A -Q14:3440VAC.L2.4 11(9) -S01 Man A
/511A1 13
-Q14:5
440VAC.L3.893 3 -S01
-K91
-Q15:6230VAC.L1.1
-Q15:2230VAC.L2.2
/511A1 Em.stop
DI.591
DI.588
DI.735
DI.590
24 23
1 3 5 12(1) 14(5) /510.B5
/446.A7
/510.B6 -Q13 -S02 2
-D02:2
-D02:3
-D02:4
-D02:5
/510.B4
-U01 Stop
I> I> I> -XX1 7 1
XXA
/510.E8
2 4 6
-XX2 1 -XX2 2
L1
N
L2
L3
15
11(2)
-U01 Power -S02 4
21 13 24 Start -K21 Autostart
25 -S01 16 18
B 400A 12(3) 14(1) B
/510.A2
-P01 Therm. 3
-U01
/444.E1
Power
/510.E8
1 2 3 4 5 6 22 -K01 14 23
OFF 26 28
/510.C5
/510.E6
/510.A8
-XX1 3
/510.A2
ON
-XX1 6
S1 -XX1 10
1 -XX2 3
-T04 -P21 A
S2 -XX1 11 -P03:22 24VDC.741 13 43 -XX1 2
24VDC.578 -XP20:1
2 /511C3 Therm. 400A
24VDC.918 -S13:23
400/5A 24VDC.571 -XP20:2
-P01 14 -K01 44
-X2 /438D8
/510.C5
/510.E6
C -T01 C
A1 17
/438C8
/511C4
/503.C3 /510.C6 -K34
-X2 -P01
18 28
/510.E7
A2 T1 T2
/507E4
/507E4
31 21
-K13:A2
230VAC.L1.733
/511D7 -K02 400A -K03 250A
1 3 5 1 3 5 1 3 5 1 3 5
32 22
/510.E7
/510.E6
400A 400A 250A
A1 A1 A1 A1 2(L) X1
/510.E6 2 4 6 /510.E7 2 4 6 /510.E6 2 4 6 400A 250A 400A -P31
I> I> I> -K01 -K03 -K02 -K34
h -H01 /510.E8
400A 2 4 6 A2 A2 A2 A2
D D
/510.E7
/510.E6
/510.E6
/510.E7
3(N) X2
-X6 1 2 -X16 1 2
-XX1 1
-W001.P1 1
-W001.P2 1
-W001.P3 1
230VAC.L1.732
PE /446B1
MAIN Y D Y/D HOUR MOTOR
CONTACTOR CONTACTOR CONTACTOR CONTROL COUNTER RUN
-W001.W1 1
-W001.U1 1
-W001.V1 1
-W001.U2 1
-W001.V2 1
-W001.W2 1
PE
+JB450-JB450:L1
+JB450-JB450:L2
+JB450-JB450:L3
E R1 -W012 1 5 6 5 6 5 6 X1 X2 E
/510.D8
W1 R2 -W012 2 13 14 13 14 13 14
PE.412
M /510.B4
V1 3 ~ T1 -W013 1
/507.C4
21 22
/510.D7
21 22 21 22
U1 T2 -W013 2 31 32 31 32 31 32
/510.D6
-M01 43 44 43 44 43 44
/501B1
/501B1
/501B2
/501B2
/510.C6
Main Pump Motor I
3x440VAC/60Hz
215kW (S6-40%)
In = 340A
/251.A8
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 510
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 -M01 HPU Main Pump 1 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 511
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and MOTOR MOTOR MOTOR 230VAC
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
TRIP RUNNING REMOTE
/513D2
/513D3
/441B1
/441B2
/441B3
Auto
Auto
Man
Man
11 8 4 14
440VAC.L1.892
-Q13:1 -Q06:1440VAC.L1.1
0
/510A3 /512A1
A 440VAC.L2.4-Q13:3 -Q06:3
440VAC.L2.892 -K92 Em.stop -S13 Man -S13 Auto A
/510A3 /512A1
440VAC.L3.893
-Q13:5 -Q06:5
440VAC.L3.892 12 4 14 12 3 13
/510A3 /512A1
/446.A8
DI.564
DI.563
DI.562
230VAC.L1.584
230VAC.L2.558
24 23
/511.B5
2
-D02:22
-D02:23
-D02:24
-Q15:6
-Q15:2
1 3 5 1 3 5 -S14
-Q03 Stop
-Q14 -Q03 13 14 1
/511.E7
21 22 13
/444.E5
/511.E7
22 22 -K13 54 23 13
/511.C5
/511.E7
/511.A8
Therm.
-Q06:22 24VDC.581
/512C3 14
-P03
/511.C5
24VDC.579 -S16:23
24VDC.918 -S01:23 14
/510C5
24VDC.741 -XX2:3
9A
-K13 13
/511.E7
-P04:A1
230VAC.L2.559
/513C5
/512C4
C C
/510C4
A1
1 3 5
-K13 /511.B6
9A -P03 X1
/507E5
/507E6
-H05
/511.E7 2 4 6 A2 T1 T2
/511.E7
-P04:A2
230VAC.L1.557
/513D5 X2
/511.E7
-X44 1 2 3
PE 230VAC.L1.733
-P01:A2 -K14:A2
230VAC.L1.564
/510D6 /512D6
-W010 2
-W010 1
-W010 3
MAIN MOTOR
CONTACTOR RUN
W1
-K13
PE
V1
U1
T2 -W010 8 5 6 X1 X2
/511.C7
-M10 13 14
/511.C7
Circulation Pump Motor 53 54
3x440VAC / 60Hz /511.B4
83 84
4.3kW (S1-100%)
61 62
/507.C5
71 72
/101.D6
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 511
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -M10 Circulation Pump 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 512
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and MOTOR MOTOR MOTOR
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
TRIP RUNNING REMOTE
/441B4
/441B5
/441B6
Auto
Auto
Man
Man
31(11) 4 14
440VAC.L1.1-Q03:1 -Q04:1
440VAC.L1.731
0
/511A3 /513A1
A 440VAC.L2.892
-Q03:3 -Q04:3
440VAC.L2.733 -K92 Em.stop -S16 Man -S16 Auto A
/511A3 /513A1
440VAC.L3.892
-Q03:5 -Q04:5
440VAC.L3.735 32(3) 34(7) 3 13
/511A3 /513A1
DI.561
/446.A8
DI.559
DI.560
24 23
/512.B5
2
-D02:25
-D02:26
-D02:27
13
-S17
Stop
1
/512.E7
-Q06 14
14 11(2)
21 53 24 Start
-S17 -K26 Autostart
B -S16 230VAC.L2.68 B
-P04:14
-Q06 /446A1 13 12(3) 14(1)
230VAC.L2.910
/444.E6
/512.E7
22 -K14 54 23
/512.E7
/512.A8
-P04:22 24VDC.583
/513C3
/513C6
24VDC.581 -K13:54
24VDC.579 24VDC.956 14
/511C5 /513C4 9A
-S13:23 -S19:23
1 3 5
-K14 13
-Q06
/512.E7
/511B4
C C
-Q06 I> I> I>
13 14 1.6A X1
2 4 6 -H06
21 22
/512.E7
X2
1 3 5
230VAC.L1.567
-H05:X2 -H07:X2
230VAC.L1.566
-K14 /511D8 /513D7
9A
A1
/512.E7 2 4 6 9A
-K14
A2
D D
/512.E7
-X44 4 5 6
230VAC.L1.564
-K13:A2 -K15:A2
230VAC.L1.581
/511D7 /513D6
PE
MAIN MOTOR
CONTACTOR RUN
-W011 2
-W011 1
-W011 3
-K14
/512.D7 -H06
1 2 13 14
W1
PE
V1
U1
/512.B7
3 4 1 2
/512.D2 /512.B7
E 5 6 X1 X2 E
M /512.C7
3 ~ T1
/512.C7
13 14
T2 53 54
/512.B4
-M11 83 84
CJC Filter 61 62
3x440VAC / 60Hz 71 72
0.5kW (S1-100%)
/251.B8
+HYD
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
3 Reissued according to change report #3 2013-12-13 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 512
2 Reissued according to change report #2 2013-12-04 ENA MSP SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Project rev. 5 -M11 CJC Filter 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 513
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed MOTOR MOTOR MOTOR
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec. TRIP RUNNING REMOTE
/441B7
/441B8
/442B1
Auto
Auto
Man
Man
5 4 14
440VAC.L1.731
-Q06:1
0
A /512A2 A
440VAC.L2.733
-Q06:3 -K92 Em.stop -S19 Man -S19 Auto
/512A2
440VAC.L3.735
-Q06:5 1 9 3 13
/512A2
/446.A8
DI.558
DI.557
DI.4
24 23
/513.B5
1
-D02:28
-D02:29
-D02:32
5 3 1 -Q16 -S20
Stop
1
/513.E7
I> I> I>
6 4 2 XXA 4 11(2)
13
21 21 53 24 Start
B -S20 -K27 Autostart B
-S19
-P04 Therm. -Q04 3 12(3) 14(1)
14
/444.E7
-Q04
/513.E7
1 3 5 22 22 -K15 54 23
/511C6
/513.C5
/513.E7
/513.A8
-Q04 -Q04
13 14
400V
415V
440V
21 22
I> I> I>
440/230VAC
0V
1600VA
230VAC.L2.559
4A 2 4 6
-T07
24VDC.583 -K14:54
0V
230V
13 14
-P03:14
24VDC.956
/512C5 Therm. 9A
-S16:23
-P04 14 -K15 13
/513.D5
/513.E7
C C
/512B4
1 3 5 5 3 1 -Q15
230VAC.L2.910 X1
-K15 /512B6 -H07
9A -Q06:14
A1 /513.E7
/507E6
/507E6
/513.E7 2 4 6 I> I> I>
/513.C6 X2
6 4 2 XXA -P04
A2 T1 T2 230VAC.L1.566
/513.E7
230VAC.L2.2-P01:A1, -P01:14
230VAC.L1.1-P01:A2, -XX1:1
230VAC.L1.581
-K14:A2
-P03:A1
-P03:A2
/512D7
-W020 2
-W020 1
-W020 3
-X6 7 8 -X16 7 8
230VAC.L1.584
230VAC.L2.558
MAIN
CONTACTOR
PE
-K15
/511A5
/510A5
/510A5
/511A5
/513.D7
1 2 -H07
3 4 3 4
/513.C1 /513.B7
W1
PE
V1
U1
5 6 1 1
R1 -W020 5 /513.B7
E 13 14 X1 X2 E
R2 -W020 6 /513.C7 /513.C7
M 53 54
3 ~ T1 -W020 7 /513.B4
83 84
T2 -W020 8
61 62
-M20 /507.C6
71 72
Oil Cooler Motor 1
3x440VAC / 60Hz
3.5kW (S1-100%)
/101.E6
+HYD
F F
Cur.Rev Reissued according to change report #5 2014-01-27 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
0 Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 513
SP2552-2 HLA: Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 -M20 Oil Cooler 1 5
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ES400 514
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
This document and all data disclosed herein and herewith are the confidential and
proprietary property of Cargotec and are not to be used, reproduced or disclosed
in whole or in part by or to anyone without written permission of Cargotec.
A A
B B
440VAC 230VAC
60Hz 60Hz
C C
-ET440
440VAC.L1.1251 +JB450-JB450:1 1U 2U -W027 BN +ES400-XA:1 230VAC.L1.1249
/501B4 /504E1
440VAC.L2.1252 +JB450-JB450:2 1V 2V -W027 BK +ES400-XA:2 230VAC.L2.1234
/501B4 /504E1
440VAC.L3.1241 +JB450-JB450:3 1W 2W -W027 GY +ES400-XA:3 230VAC.L3.1235
/501B4 /504E1
PE
3x440VAC / 3x230VAC PE.1241
+ES400:PE
16kVA /504E1
D D
+ET440
E E
F F
Cur.Rev Issued for production 2013-10-15 ENA MSP Drawn by ENA Dwg. No.
Mawei Shipbuilding (MW610-2) Date 2013-10-15 Loop diagram SP2552-2 +AP-XU 514
SP2552-2 HLA: =CRANE KING Sheet rev. Next sheet
Project rev. 5 TRAFO 0
Rev. Description Date Modified by Approved HMC 2201 LKO 120-18 CT Loc: +ET440 701
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
User Manual for Crane
3. Data Sheets
Doc ID 10002392 DS
10002392
Bladder Accumulator
SH11
Page 1 of 2
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 10002392 DS
10) Fill Nitrogen on the actual accumulator until the precharge pressure is obtained in the
accumulator.
Note that prefill pressure is at T=200C
11) Mount the cover screw and cap onto the accumulator.
12) Repeat the operation 6 to 11 on each accumulator.
13) Close accu drain ball valve.
14) Restart the hydraulic system.
15) The accumulator is charged when the operator activates the AHC or AT mode on the operator
terminal in the cabin
Note: Preload pressure to be confirmed from hydraulic flow diagram for actual application.
The preload pressure stated on flow diagram referes to T=200C.
Page 2 of 2
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 10007608 DS
10007608
Hydraulic Motor
SH01
Page 1 of 1
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 11000741 DS
11000741
Valve Block
SH10
Page 1 of 1
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 11002087 DS
11002087
MOPS Emergency Pay Out Block
UH08
Page 1 of 2
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 11002087 DS
Page 2 of 2
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 11005972 DS
11005972
Gearbox
WG02
Page 1 of 1
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 11020012 DS
11020012
Hydraulic Pump
MH50
Page 1 of 2
Doc type Datasheet
Doc ID 11020012 DS
Page 2 of 2
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
1. Declaration of Conformity
Blank page.
2 Main Data
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 5
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
Blank page.
4. Main Hook
Blank page.
DET NORSKE
E VERIT
TAS
PROOF
P L
LOAD DE
ECLARAT
TION
L
LOOSE GEAR
G
Client: Ropeb
block B.V., Oldenzaal, The Neth
herlands Client reef.: R132653-1-1
DNV B.V. Orde erno: PP0633015
Supplied by: Ropeb
block B.V., Oldenzaal, The Neth
herlands Cust. POO: 378692
Intended for: Cargottec Norway ASS Project.:: 11006787
THIS IS TO C
CONFIRM THA AT the unders signed Surveyyor to this Sociiety did at the request of Meessrs.Ropeblo
ock BV, Oldenzaal,
nds, performed the verification on the follo
The Netherlan owing:
Inspection pa articulars:
Verification th
hat above men ntioned producct was built & ttested according specification as mentionned in DNV Sttandard for
Certification 2
2.22 Lifting Appliances including the Revieew of Manufacturing records & testing reccords, were performed withh
satisfactory re
esult.
Marking:
as marked by means of harrdstamping, fo
The Swivel wa or identification
n purpose only
y, as follows:
R0003 – R00004
ROT13063015.159
10 13
The undersign ned manufacturer declares that the produ uct R. Old
de Dubbelink
has been builtt in accordancce with the spe
ecification and
d QA/QC
conditions refferred to in the
e MSA R-2366 6
Place
Note: The prroduct was produced & teested withoutt the ŝŐŝƚĂůůLJ^ŝŐŶĞĚLJ͗sĞŶ͕ƌũĞŶǀĂŶĚĞƌ
presen
nce of DNV under Manufac cturing Surve ey Date
Agreemment R-2366 and Design verification
v w
was not >ŽĐĂƚŝŽŶ͗EsZŽƚƚĞƌĚĂŵ͕dŚĞEĞƚŚĞƌůĂŶĚƐ
perform
med and therrefor the use of this produ
uct for DNV Name ^ŝŐŶŝŶŐĂƚĞ͗ϮϬϭϯͲϭϬͲϯϭ
Classe
ed objects ha
ave to be take
en into consid deration.
Surveyor
If any person sufferss loss or damage which iss proved to have been ca
aused by any negligent aact or omission of Det No orske Veritas, then Det Norske Veritas shall pay ccompensation to such person for his proved directt loss or
damage. Ho owever, the compensatioon shall not exceed an ammount equal to ten timess the fee charged for the service
s in question, prov ded that the maximum ccompensation shall neverr exceed USD 2 million.
In this provision "Det Norske Veritas" shall mean the Foundation Det Nors ske Veritas as well as all its subsidiaries, directorrs, officers, employees, agents and any other actinng on behalf of Det Nors
ske Veritas.
DET NORSK
KE VERITAS AS, Veritasveienn 1, NO-1322 Høvikk, Norway, Telephoone: +47 67 57 99 00,
0 Telefax: +47 67 57 99 11, Org.No. NO
N 945 748 931 MVA
M
Form No.: 40.91a Issue: Janu
uary 2008 Page
e 1 of 1
Manufacturing Documentation
Test Report EN 10204 - 2.2
Remarks:
Date: 28-10-2013
1/1 KZ-217/1
!
# ! '( ' )
" % "#$ %&
.,,,2 %&'( % !( " ) (* ,$,/
*+,,-.,
,,0+
!"# 1 $7$/2# 8
$ 1/23242
562
;9 ! ( ( ( ( < !
ZKdϭϯ͘ϬϲϯϬϭϱ
ROT 13063015-159
SWL 15T Es^ƚ͘Ĩ͘ĞƌƚϮ͘ϮϮͲ>ŝĨƚŝŶŐƉƉůŝĂŶĐĞƐ
PL 310 KN ^ŝŐŶŝŶŐĂƚĞ͗ϮϬϭϯͲϭϬͲϯϭ
ŝŐŝƚĂůůLJ^ŝŐŶĞĚLJ͗sĞŶ͕ƌũĞŶǀĂŶĚĞƌ
On behalf of DNV, Manufacturing Survey Arrangement No. R-2366
' B 7$,$,/
0C$7-/
Product: BG 15.500.C Order No.: R132653-1-1
Customer: CARGOTEC Fabrication No.: R0004
ZKdϭϯ͘ϬϲϯϬϭϱ
Es^ƚ͘Ĩ͘ĞƌƚϮ͘ϮϮͲ>ŝĨƚŝŶŐƉƉůŝĂŶĐĞƐ
^ŝŐŶŝŶŐĂƚĞ͗ϮϬϭϯͲϭϬͲϯϭ
Proofload (kN)
ŝŐŝƚĂůůLJ^ŝŐŶĞĚLJ͗sĞŶ͕ƌũĞŶǀĂŶĚĞƌ
Elongation (mm)
Chemical analysis
C Mn Si Ni Cr S P Mo Al Cu Nb V
EN 10083-1
% % % % % % % % % % % %
Actual values 0,36 0,58 0,22 1,52 1,54 0,005 0,007 0,21 0,024
Mechanical properties
Tensile Yield Elongation Impact test ISO V
DIN 15400 RM (N / mm²) ReH / Rp0.2 (N / mm²) A (%) J T (°C)
Heat treatment
Hooks are treated to the values of solidity class: V
The heat treatment of the materials is in accordance with the applicable material specification.
NDE Examinations
Dimensional examination All measurement deviations under tolerance
Ultrasonic examination Satisfactory, free of internal seperations which may effect utilization
Magnetic Particle examination Satisfactory, free of surface cracks which may effect utilization
Remarks
The above mentioned product is in acoordance with the regulations of the EC Machine Directive 2006\42\EC.
The reported values are strictly in accordance with the original mill certificates.
Quality certificate for forged load hooks according to DIN 15404.
KZ190/0
Heat No.: 63873
Re-Marking: A201
Re-marking
R QA/QC Dept.
B Ropeblock BV
Heat No.: 52021
Re-Marking: A274
Re-marking
R QA/QC Dept.
B Ropeblock BV
Heat No.: 52021
Re-Marking: A274
User Manual for Crane
5. Slew Gear
Blank page.
6. Slew Bearing
Blank page.
Blank page.
Fou r (
4) H y
dra ul
ic Cy
li n d er
s Ouan
tit
y: One<
M
anu
fact
ure
r:HY
DRA
TECHlN
DUS
TRIE
S
FL
UID P
OWE
R(SU
ZHO
U} C
O,
LT
D
Su
rve
yLo
cat
ion
:
Equi
pmentDa
ta
see below
see below
YY251612
FUJIAN MAW
EI SH
IPBUI
LDINGLTD
MW610-2
D
esi
gnS ta
tE Des
ignAp
pro
ved
/Re
via
wed
A
BSRav
iewi
ngOrga
niz
ati
on CNSha
ngh
aiO
ED
D
raw
ingNumber saabe
low
A
ddi
tio
nalDa
ta
A
BSS
tam
pin
g .
iSQ2
620
845
-A
T
hisistoCe
rti
fyt
hatth
eun
der
sig
neds
urve
yor
(s)toth
isB
ure
aud
id,a
tth
ereq
ues
toft
hec
ust
ome
r,c
arr
you
t
t
hef
oll
owi
ngsu
rveyan
dre
por
tasf
oll
ows
:
i
edou
tasa
ppl
ica
blea
ndve
nfl
edma
cco
rda
ncew
itht
he
a p plic
able R ule s
/s p e cific
atio n s .
Testing machi
nes ar
e maint
amed i
n a sa
tisfac
tory co
nditio
n and record
s of th
eir re
check or cal
ibratio
n date
s
co
nfirme
d
F
in al m a r
kin g s for i
d e n tific atio n c o n firm ed .
1 Particulars:
No Drawing No Type Qty Serial No Desgin /Working /Test Pressure
1) 8213520 CYL200/1BOx3800 1 E5157-01 287BAR/ 221BAR/ 374BAR
2) 8213521 CYL180/140x2625 1 E5157-02 210BAR/ 161BAR/ 273BAR
3} 8213519 CYL200/1BOx3800 1 E5157-03 287BAR/ 221BAR / 374BAR
4) 8213522 CYLIB0/140x2625 1 E5157-04 210BAR/ 161BAR / 273BAR
2 Design temperature:-10 Deg C
satisfactory
aVisualexami
nation(W)
bHydros
tatictest (w
)
CUitron
sic tE
st (M)
dMagnet
ic tEs
t (M)
No
te: W- Witn
essed.M .Ma
nuf
act
ure
r'sr
epo
rt
AB Re
porl V
endo' P
age20
f2
User Manual for Crane
8. Accumulator
Blank page.
18 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS
DECLARATION DE CONFORMITE
1
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY
DC-B-1476-FY14
Fabricant
2
Manufacturer
OLAER INDUSTRIES S.A.
Nous déclarons par la présente que les produits énumérés ci-dessous ont été fabriqués conformément à la Directive Européenne des Equipements
L'équipement a été soumis aux procédures d'évaluation de conformité suivantes: Module B CE-PED-B-OLR-001-07-FRA
16
The equipment has been qualified according to the following conformity assessment:
Module D CE-PED-D-OLR-001-12-FRA
Bureau Veritas
Organisme Notifié: N° d'habilitation: Normes Applicables ou codes de conception:
17 67/71 bvd du château 18 0062 19 EN 14359
Notified Body: Clearance Nr: Standards or Design Codes:
92200 Neuilly-Sur-Seine
Nr de cylcles admissibles: La note de calcul et les essais de fatigue nous permettent de statuer sur la mention N ≥2.10x6 pour un ∆P ≤ 200 bar avec une fiabilité de 99,9%
20
Max Allowable pressure range: Calculation note and fatigue tests allow us to conclude N ≥ 2.10x6 for ∆P ≤ 200 bar with a reliability of 99.9%
Signature:
24
Signature:
10 Other
10 Other
MACGREGOR NORWAY AS 1
User Manual for Crane
Blank page.
10 Other
2 MACGREGOR NORWAY AS